Provided by: postfix_3.8.6-1build2_amd64 bug

NAME

       postconf - Postfix configuration parameters

SYNOPSIS

       postconf parameter ...

       postconf -e "parameter=value" ...

DESCRIPTION

       The  Postfix  main.cf  configuration  file specifies parameters that control the operation of the Postfix
       mail system. Typically the file contains only a small subset of all parameters; parameters not  specified
       are left at their default values.

       The general format of the main.cf file is as follows:

       •      Each  logical  line has the form "parameter = value".  Whitespace around the "=" is ignored, as is
              whitespace at the end of a logical line.

       •      Empty lines and whitespace-only lines  are  ignored,  as  are  lines  whose  first  non-whitespace
              character is a `#'.

       •      A  logical  line  starts  with non-whitespace text. A line that starts with whitespace continues a
              logical line.

       •      A parameter value may refer to other parameters.

              •      The expressions "$name" and "${name}" are recursively replaced with the value of the  named
                     parameter.  The  parameter  name must contain only characters from the set [a-zA-Z0-9_]. An
                     undefined parameter value is replaced with the empty value.

              •      The expressions "${name?value}"  and  "${name?{value}}"  are  replaced  with  "value"  when
                     "$name"  is  non-empty. The parameter name must contain only characters from the set [a-zA-
                     Z0-9_]. These forms are supported with Postfix versions >= 2.2 and >= 3.0, respectively.

              •      The expressions "${name:value}"  and  "${name:{value}}"  are  replaced  with  "value"  when
                     "$name"  is  empty.  The  parameter  name  must contain only characters from the set [a-zA-
                     Z0-9_]. These forms are supported with Postfix versions >= 2.2 and >= 3.0, respectively.

              •      The expression "${name?{value1}:{value2}}" is replaced with "value1" when "$name"  is  non-
                     empty,  and  with  "value2"  when  "$name"  is  empty.   The "{}" is required for "value1",
                     optional for "value2". The parameter name must contain only characters from the set  [a-zA-
                     Z0-9_].  This form is supported with Postfix versions >= 3.0.

              •      The  first  item  inside  "${...}" may be a relational expression of the form: "{value3} ==
                     {value4}". Besides the "==" (equality) operator Postfix supports  "!="  (inequality),  "<",
                     "<=",  ">=",  and  ">".  The  comparison  is  numerical  when both operands are all digits,
                     otherwise the comparison  is  lexicographical.  These  forms  are  supported  with  Postfix
                     versions >= 3.0.

              •      Each  "value" is subject to recursive named parameter and relational expression evaluation,
                     except where noted.

              •      Whitespace before or after each "{value}" is ignored.

              •      Specify "$$" to produce a single "$" character.

              •      The legacy form "$(...)" is equivalent to the preferred form "${...}".

       •      When the same parameter is defined multiple times, only the last instance is remembered.

       •      Otherwise, the order of main.cf parameter definitions does not matter.

       The remainder of this document is a description of all Postfix configuration parameters.  Default  values
       are shown after the parameter name in parentheses, and can be looked up with the "postconf -d" command.

       Note:  this is not an invitation to make changes to Postfix configuration parameters. Unnecessary changes
       can impair the operation of the mail system.

2bounce_notice_recipient (default: postmaster)

       The recipient of undeliverable mail that cannot be returned to the sender.  This feature is enabled  with
       the notify_classes parameter.

access_map_defer_code (default: 450)

       The  numerical  Postfix  SMTP  server  response  code  for  an  access(5)  map  "defer" action, including
       "defer_if_permit" or "defer_if_reject". Prior to Postfix 2.6, the response is hard-coded as "450".

       Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of RFC 5321.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

access_map_reject_code (default: 554)

       The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code for an access(5) map "reject" action.

       Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of RFC 5321.

address_verify_cache_cleanup_interval (default: 12h)

       The amount of time between verify(8) address verification database cleanup runs.  This  feature  requires
       that  the  database  supports  the "delete" and "sequence" operators.  Specify a zero interval to disable
       database cleanup.

       After each database cleanup run, the verify(8) daemon logs the number of entries that were  retained  and
       dropped.  A  cleanup  run is logged as "partial" when the daemon terminates early after "postfix reload",
       "postfix stop", or no requests for $max_idle seconds.

       Specify a non-negative time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter  suffix  that  specifies
       the  time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time
       unit is h (hours).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7.

address_verify_default_transport (default: $default_transport)

       Overrides the default_transport parameter setting for address verification probes.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_local_transport (default: $local_transport)

       Overrides the local_transport parameter setting for address verification probes.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_map (default: see postconf -d output)

       Lookup table for persistent address  verification  status  storage.   The  table  is  maintained  by  the
       verify(8) service, and is opened before the process releases privileges.

       The  lookup  table is persistent by default (Postfix 2.7 and later).  Specify an empty table name to keep
       the information in volatile memory which is lost after "postfix reload" or "postfix stop".  This  is  the
       default with Postfix version 2.6 and earlier.

       Specify  a  location in a file system that will not fill up. If the database becomes corrupted, the world
       comes to an end. To recover, delete (NOT: truncate) the file and do "postfix reload".

       Postfix daemon processes do not use root privileges when opening this file (Postfix 2.5 and later).   The
       file must therefore be stored under a Postfix-owned directory such as the data_directory.  As a migration
       aid,  an  attempt  to  open  the  file  under  a non-Postfix directory is redirected to the Postfix-owned
       data_directory, and a warning is logged.

       Examples:

       address_verify_map = hash:/var/lib/postfix/verify
       address_verify_map = btree:/var/lib/postfix/verify

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_negative_cache (default: yes)

       Enable caching of failed address verification probe results.  When this feature is enabled, the cache may
       pollute quickly with garbage.  When this feature is disabled, Postfix will generate an address probe  for
       every lookup.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_negative_expire_time (default: 3d)

       The time after which a failed probe expires from the address verification cache.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is d (days).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_negative_refresh_time (default: 3h)

       The time after which a failed address verification probe needs to be refreshed.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is h (hours).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_pending_request_limit (default: see postconf -d output)

       A  safety  limit  that  prevents  address  verification  requests from overwhelming the Postfix queue. By
       default,  the  number  of  pending  requests  is  limited  to  1/4  of  the  active  queue  maximum  size
       (qmgr_message_active_limit). The queue manager enforces the limit by tempfailing requests that exceed the
       limit.  This  affects  only  unknown  addresses  and  inactive  addresses  that have expired, because the
       verify(8) daemon automatically refreshes an active address before it expires.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.1 and later.

address_verify_poll_count (default: normal: 3, overload: 1)

       How many times to query the verify(8) service for the completion of an address  verification  request  in
       progress.

       By  default,  the  Postfix  SMTP  server polls the verify(8) service up to three times under non-overload
       conditions, and only once when under overload.  With Postfix version 2.5 and  earlier,  the  SMTP  server
       always polls the verify(8) service up to three times by default.

       Specify  1 to implement a crude form of greylisting, that is, always defer the first delivery request for
       a new address.

       Examples:

       # Postfix <= 2.6 default
       address_verify_poll_count = 3
       # Poor man's greylisting
       address_verify_poll_count = 1

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_poll_delay (default: 3s)

       The delay between queries for the completion of an address verification request in progress.

       The default polling delay is 3 seconds.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_positive_expire_time (default: 31d)

       The time after which a successful probe expires from the address verification cache.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is d (days).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_positive_refresh_time (default: 7d)

       The time after which a successful  address  verification  probe  needs  to  be  refreshed.   The  address
       verification status is not updated when the probe fails (optimistic caching).

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is d (days).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_relay_transport (default: $relay_transport)

       Overrides the relay_transport parameter setting for address verification probes.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_relayhost (default: $relayhost)

       Overrides the relayhost parameter setting for  address  verification  probes.  This  information  can  be
       overruled with the transport(5) table.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_sender (default: $double_bounce_sender)

       The  sender  address  to  use  in  address  verification  probes;  prior  to  Postfix 2.5 the default was
       "postmaster". To avoid problems with address probes that are sent in  response  to  address  probes,  the
       Postfix SMTP server excludes the probe sender address from all SMTPD access blocks.

       Specify  an  empty  value  (address_verify_sender  =)  or  <> if you want to use the null sender address.
       Beware, some sites reject mail from <>, even though RFCs require that such addresses be accepted.

       Examples:

       address_verify_sender = <>
       address_verify_sender = postmaster@mydomain

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_sender_dependent_default_transport_maps (default: $sender_dependent_default_transport_maps)

       Overrides the sender_dependent_default_transport_maps parameter setting for address verification probes.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7 and later.

address_verify_sender_dependent_relayhost_maps (default: $sender_dependent_relayhost_maps)

       Overrides the sender_dependent_relayhost_maps parameter setting for address verification probes.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

address_verify_sender_ttl (default: 0s)

       The time between changes in the time-dependent portion of address verification  probe  sender  addresses.
       The   time-dependent   portion   is  appended  to  the  localpart  of  the  address  specified  with  the
       address_verify_sender parameter. This feature is ignored when the probe  sender  addresses  is  the  null
       sender, i.e. the address_verify_sender value is empty or <>.

       Historically,  the  probe  sender  address was fixed. This has caused such addresses to end up on spammer
       mailing lists, and has resulted in wasted network and processing resources.

       To enable time-dependent probe sender addresses, specify a non-zero time value. Specify  a  value  of  at
       least  several hours, to avoid problems with senders that use greylisting. Avoid nice TTL values, to make
       the result less predictable.

       Specify a non-negative time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter  suffix  that  specifies
       the  time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time
       unit is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.9 and later.

address_verify_service_name (default: verify)

       The name of the verify(8) address verification service. This  service  maintains  the  status  of  sender
       and/or recipient address verification probes, and generates probes on request by other Postfix processes.

address_verify_transport_maps (default: $transport_maps)

       Overrides the transport_maps parameter setting for address verification probes.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_virtual_transport (default: $virtual_transport)

       Overrides the virtual_transport parameter setting for address verification probes.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

alias_database (default: see postconf -d output)

       The alias databases for local(8) delivery that are updated with "newaliases" or with "sendmail -bi".

       This  is a separate configuration parameter because not all the tables specified with $alias_maps have to
       be local files.

       Examples:

       alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
       alias_database = hash:/etc/mail/aliases

alias_maps (default: see postconf -d output)

       The alias databases that are used for local(8) delivery. See aliases(5) for syntax details.  Specify zero
       or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma.  Tables  will  be  searched  in  the
       specified order until a match is found.  Note: these lookups are recursive.

       The  default  list  is  system  dependent.  On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
       database, then the NIS alias database.

       If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or wherever your system stores  the  mail
       alias file), or simply run "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.

       The  local(8)  delivery agent disallows regular expression substitution of $1 etc. in alias_maps, because
       that would open a security hole.

       The local(8) delivery  agent  will  silently  ignore  requests  to  use  the  proxymap(8)  server  within
       alias_maps.  Instead  it  will open the table directly. Before Postfix version 2.2, the local(8) delivery
       agent will terminate with a fatal error.

       Examples:

       alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
       alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases

allow_mail_to_commands (default: alias, forward)

       Restrict local(8) mail delivery to external commands.  The default is to disallow delivery to  "|command"
       in :include:  files (see aliases(5) for the text that defines this terminology).

       Specify  zero  or  more of: alias, forward or include, in order to allow commands in aliases(5), .forward
       files or in :include:  files, respectively.

       Example:

       allow_mail_to_commands = alias,forward,include

allow_mail_to_files (default: alias, forward)

       Restrict local(8) mail delivery to external files. The default is to disallow  "/file/name"  destinations
       in :include:  files (see aliases(5) for the text that defines this terminology).

       Specify  zero  or  more  of:  alias,  forward  or include, in order to allow "/file/name" destinations in
       aliases(5), .forward files and in :include:  files, respectively.

       Example:

       allow_mail_to_files = alias,forward,include

allow_min_user (default: no)

       Allow a sender or recipient address to have `-' as the first character.  By default, this is not allowed,
       to avoid accidents with software that passes email addresses via the command line.  Such  software  would
       not be able to distinguish a malicious address from a bona fide command-line option. Although this can be
       prevented  by  inserting  a  "--"  option  terminator into the command line, this is difficult to enforce
       consistently and globally.

       As of Postfix version 2.5, this feature is implemented by trivial-rewrite(8).  With earlier versions this
       feature was implemented by qmgr(8) and was limited to recipient addresses only.

allow_percent_hack (default: yes)

       Enable the rewriting of the form "user%domain" to "user@domain".  This is enabled by default.

       Note: as of Postfix version 2.2, message header address rewriting happens only when one of the  following
       conditions is true:

       •      The message is received with the Postfix sendmail(1) command,

       •      The message is received from a network client that matches $local_header_rewrite_clients,

       •      The message is received from the network, and the remote_header_rewrite_domain parameter specifies
              a non-empty value.

       To get the behavior before Postfix version 2.2, specify "local_header_rewrite_clients = static:all".

       Example:

       allow_percent_hack = no

allow_srv_lookup_fallback (default: no)

       When  SRV  record  lookup  fails  or no SRV record exists, fall back to MX or IP address lookup as if SRV
       record lookup was not enabled.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.8 and later.

allow_untrusted_routing (default: no)

       Forward  mail  with  sender-specified  routing  (user[@%!]remote[@%!]site)  from  untrusted  clients   to
       destinations matching $relay_domains.

       By  default,  this feature is turned off.  This closes a nasty open relay loophole where a backup MX host
       can be tricked into forwarding junk mail to a primary MX host which then spams it out to the world.

       This parameter also controls if non-local addresses  with  sender-specified  routing  can  match  Postfix
       access  tables.  By  default,  such  addresses cannot match Postfix access tables, because the address is
       ambiguous.

alternate_config_directories (default: empty)

       A list of non-default Postfix configuration directories that may be specified with "-c  config_directory"
       on  the  command  line  (in  the  case  of  sendmail(1),  with  the  "-C" option), or via the MAIL_CONFIG
       environment parameter.

       This list must be specified in the default Postfix main.cf file, and will  be  used  by  set-gid  Postfix
       commands such as postqueue(1) and postdrop(1).

       Specify absolute pathnames, separated by comma or space. Note: $name expansion is not supported.

always_add_missing_headers (default: no)

       Always  add  (Resent-)  From:, To:, Date: or Message-ID: headers when not present.  Postfix 2.6 and later
       add these headers only when clients match the local_header_rewrite_clients  parameter  setting.   Earlier
       Postfix  versions  always  add  these  headers;  this  may  break DKIM signatures that cover non-existent
       headers.  The undisclosed_recipients_header parameter setting determines whether a  To:  header  will  be
       added.

always_bcc (default: empty)

       Optional address that receives a "blind carbon copy" of each message that is received by the Postfix mail
       system.

       Note:  with  Postfix  2.3 and later the BCC address is added as if it was specified with NOTIFY=NONE. The
       sender will not be notified when the BCC address is undeliverable, as long as  all  down-stream  software
       implements RFC 3461.

       Note: with Postfix 2.2 and earlier the sender will be notified when the BCC address is undeliverable.

       Note:  automatic  BCC  recipients  are  produced only for new mail.  To avoid mailer loops, automatic BCC
       recipients are not generated after Postfix forwards mail internally,  or  after  Postfix  generates  mail
       itself.

anvil_rate_time_unit (default: 60s)

       The time unit over which client connection rates and other rates are calculated.

       This feature is implemented by the anvil(8) service which is available in Postfix version 2.2 and later.

       The  default  interval is relatively short. Because of the high frequency of updates, the anvil(8) server
       uses volatile memory only. Thus, information is lost whenever the process terminates.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

anvil_status_update_time (default: 600s)

       How frequently the anvil(8) connection and rate limiting server logs peak usage information.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

append_at_myorigin (default: yes)

       With locally submitted mail, append the string "@$myorigin" to mail addresses without domain information.
       With remotely submitted mail, append the string "@$remote_header_rewrite_domain" instead.

       Note 1: this feature is enabled by default and  must  not  be  turned  off.   Postfix  does  not  support
       domain-less addresses.

       Note 2: with Postfix version 2.2, message header address rewriting happens only when one of the following
       conditions is true:

       •      The message is received with the Postfix sendmail(1) command,

       •      The message is received from a network client that matches $local_header_rewrite_clients,

       •      The message is received from the network, and the remote_header_rewrite_domain parameter specifies
              a non-empty value.

       To get the behavior before Postfix version 2.2, specify "local_header_rewrite_clients = static:all".

append_dot_mydomain (default: Postfix >= 3.0: no, Postfix < 3.0: yes)

       With  locally  submitted  mail,  append  the  string  ".$mydomain"  to  addresses  that have no ".domain"
       information. With remotely submitted mail, append the string ".$remote_header_rewrite_domain" instead.

       Note  1:  When  disabled  (Postfix  3.0  and  later),  users  will  not  be  able   to   send   mail   to
       "user@partialdomainname" but will have to specify full domain names instead.

       Note 2: with Postfix version 2.2, message header address rewriting happens only when one of the following
       conditions is true:

       •      The message is received with the Postfix sendmail(1) command,

       •      The message is received from a network client that matches $local_header_rewrite_clients,

       •      The message is received from the network, and the remote_header_rewrite_domain parameter specifies
              a non-empty value.

       To get the behavior before Postfix version 2.2, specify "local_header_rewrite_clients = static:all".

application_event_drain_time (default: 100s)

       How  long  the  postkick(1)  command waits for a request to enter the Postfix daemon process input buffer
       before giving up.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

authorized_flush_users (default: static:anyone)

       List of users who are authorized to flush the queue.

       By  default,  all users are allowed to flush the queue.  Access is always granted if the invoking user is
       the super-user or the $mail_owner user.  Otherwise, the real UID of the  process  is  looked  up  in  the
       system  password  file, and access is granted only if the corresponding login name is on the access list.
       The username "unknown" is used for processes whose real UID is not found in the password file.

       Specify a list of  user  names,  "/file/name"  or  "type:table"  patterns,  separated  by  commas  and/or
       whitespace.  The  list  is matched left to right, and the search stops on the first match. A "/file/name"
       pattern is replaced by its contents; a "type:table" lookup table is matched when a name matches a  lookup
       key  (the  lookup  result  is  ignored).   Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
       Specify "!pattern" to exclude a name from the list. The form "!/file/name" is supported only  in  Postfix
       version 2.4 and later.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

authorized_mailq_users (default: static:anyone)

       List of users who are authorized to view the queue.

       By  default,  all  users are allowed to view the queue.  Access is always granted if the invoking user is
       the super-user or the $mail_owner user.  Otherwise, the real UID of the  process  is  looked  up  in  the
       system  password  file, and access is granted only if the corresponding login name is on the access list.
       The username "unknown" is used for processes whose real UID is not found in the password file.

       Specify a list of  user  names,  "/file/name"  or  "type:table"  patterns,  separated  by  commas  and/or
       whitespace.  The  list  is matched left to right, and the search stops on the first match. A "/file/name"
       pattern is replaced by its contents; a "type:table" lookup table is matched when a name matches a  lookup
       key  (the  lookup  result  is  ignored).   Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
       Specify "!pattern" to exclude a user name from the list. The form  "!/file/name"  is  supported  only  in
       Postfix version 2.4 and later.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

authorized_submit_users (default: static:anyone)

       List  of  users  who  are authorized to submit mail with the sendmail(1) command (and with the privileged
       postdrop(1) helper command).

       By default, all users are allowed to submit mail.  Otherwise, the real UID of the process is looked up in
       the system password file, and access is granted only if the corresponding login name  is  on  the  access
       list.   The username "unknown" is used for processes whose real UID is not found in the password file. To
       deny mail submission access to all users specify an empty list.

       Specify a list of  user  names,  "/file/name"  or  "type:table"  patterns,  separated  by  commas  and/or
       whitespace.  The  list  is matched left to right, and the search stops on the first match. A "/file/name"
       pattern is replaced by its contents; a "type:table" lookup table is matched when a name matches a  lookup
       key  (the  lookup  result  is  ignored).   Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
       Specify "!pattern" to exclude a user name from the list. The form  "!/file/name"  is  supported  only  in
       Postfix version 2.4 and later.

       Example:

       authorized_submit_users = !www, static:all

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

authorized_verp_clients (default: $mynetworks)

       What  remote  SMTP  clients are allowed to specify the XVERP command.  This command requests that mail be
       delivered one recipient at a time with a per recipient return address.

       By default, only trusted clients are allowed to specify XVERP.

       This parameter was introduced with Postfix version 1.1.  Postfix version 2.1 renamed  this  parameter  to
       smtpd_authorized_verp_clients and changed the default to none.

       Specify a list of network/netmask patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. The mask specifies the
       number  of  bits  in  the network part of a host address. You can also specify hostnames or .domain names
       (the initial dot causes the domain to match any name below it),  "/file/name" or  "type:table"  patterns.
       A  "/file/name"  pattern is replaced by its contents; a "type:table" lookup table is matched when a table
       entry matches a lookup string (the lookup result is ignored).  Continue long lines by starting  the  next
       line  with  whitespace. Specify "!pattern" to exclude an address or network block from the list. The form
       "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later.

       Note: IP version 6 address information must be specified inside [] in the authorized_verp_clients  value,
       and  in  files  specified with "/file/name".  IP version 6 addresses contain the ":" character, and would
       otherwise be confused with a "type:table" pattern.

backwards_bounce_logfile_compatibility (default: yes)

       Produce additional bounce(8) logfile records that can be read by Postfix versions before 2.0. The current
       and more  extensible  "name  =  value"  format  is  needed  in  order  to  implement  more  sophisticated
       functionality.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

berkeley_db_create_buffer_size (default: 16777216)

       The  per-table I/O buffer size for programs that create Berkeley DB hash or btree tables.  Specify a byte
       count.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

berkeley_db_read_buffer_size (default: 131072)

       The per-table I/O buffer size for programs that read Berkeley DB hash or btree tables.   Specify  a  byte
       count.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

best_mx_transport (default: empty)

       Where  the  Postfix  SMTP  client should deliver mail when it detects a "mail loops back to myself" error
       condition. This happens when the local MTA is the best SMTP mail exchanger for a destination  not  listed
       in      $mydestination,      $inet_interfaces,      $proxy_interfaces,     $virtual_alias_domains,     or
       $virtual_mailbox_domains.  By default, the Postfix SMTP client returns such mail as undeliverable.

       Specify, for example, "best_mx_transport = local" to pass the mail from the Postfix SMTP  client  to  the
       local(8)  delivery agent. You can specify any message delivery "transport" or "transport:nexthop" that is
       defined in the master.cf file. See the transport(5) manual page for the syntax and meaning of "transport"
       or "transport:nexthop".

       However, this feature is expensive because it ties up a Postfix SMTP client process  while  the  local(8)
       delivery  agent  is  doing  its  work. It is more efficient (for Postfix) to list all hosted domains in a
       table or database.

biff (default: yes)

       Whether or not to use the local biff service.  This service sends "new mail" notifications to  users  who
       have requested new mail notification with the UNIX command "biff y".

       For  compatibility reasons this feature is on by default.  On systems with lots of interactive users, the
       biff service can be a performance drain.  Specify "biff = no" in main.cf to disable.

body_checks (default: empty)

       Optional lookup tables for content inspection as specified in the body_checks(5) manual page.

       Note: with Postfix versions before 2.0, these  rules  inspect  all  content  after  the  primary  message
       headers.

body_checks_size_limit (default: 51200)

       How  much  text in a message body segment (or attachment, if you prefer to use that term) is subjected to
       body_checks inspection.  The amount of text is limited to avoid scanning huge attachments.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

bounce_notice_recipient (default: postmaster)

       The recipient of postmaster notifications with the message headers of mail that Postfix did  not  deliver
       and  of SMTP conversation transcripts of mail that Postfix did not receive.  This feature is enabled with
       the notify_classes parameter.

bounce_queue_lifetime (default: 5d)

       Consider a bounce message as undeliverable, when delivery fails with a temporary error, and the  time  in
       the queue has reached the bounce_queue_lifetime limit.  By default, this limit is the same as for regular
       mail.

       Specify  a  non-negative  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies
       the time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default  time
       unit is d (days).

       Specify 0 when mail delivery should be tried only once.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

bounce_service_name (default: bounce)

       The  name  of  the  bounce(8)  service.  This  service maintains a record of failed delivery attempts and
       generates non-delivery notifications.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

bounce_size_limit (default: 50000)

       The maximal amount of original message text that is sent in a non-delivery notification. Specify  a  byte
       count.   A message is returned as either message/rfc822 (the complete original) or as text/rfc822-headers
       (the headers only).  With Postfix version 2.4 and earlier, a message is always returned as message/rfc822
       and is truncated when it exceeds the size limit.

       Notes:

       •      If you increase this limit, then you should increase the mime_nesting_limit value proportionally.

       •      Be careful when making changes.  Excessively large values will result in the loss of  non-delivery
              notifications, when a bounce message size exceeds a local or remote MTA's message size limit.

bounce_template_file (default: empty)

       Pathname of a configuration file with bounce message templates.  These override the built-in templates of
       delivery status notification (DSN) messages for undeliverable mail, delayed mail, successful delivery, or
       delivery verification. The bounce(5) manual page describes how to edit and test template files.

       Template  message  body text may contain $name references to Postfix configuration parameters. The result
       of $name expansion can be previewed with "postconf -b file_name" before  the  file  is  placed  into  the
       Postfix configuration directory.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

broken_sasl_auth_clients (default: no)

       Enable  interoperability  with remote SMTP clients that implement an obsolete version of the AUTH command
       (RFC 4954). Examples of such clients are MicroSoft Outlook  Express  version  4  and  MicroSoft  Exchange
       version 5.0.

       Specify "broken_sasl_auth_clients = yes" to have Postfix advertise AUTH support in a non-standard way.

canonical_classes (default: envelope_sender, envelope_recipient, header_sender, header_recipient)

       What addresses are subject to canonical_maps address mapping.  By default, canonical_maps address mapping
       is  applied  to  envelope  sender  and  recipient  addresses,  and  to header sender and header recipient
       addresses.

       Specify one or more of: envelope_sender, envelope_recipient, header_sender, header_recipient

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

canonical_maps (default: empty)

       Optional address mapping lookup tables for message headers and envelopes. The mapping is applied to  both
       sender   and   recipient   addresses,   in  both  envelopes  and  in  headers,  as  controlled  with  the
       canonical_classes parameter. This is typically used to clean up dirty addresses from legacy mail systems,
       or to replace login names by  Firstname.Lastname.   The  table  format  and  lookups  are  documented  in
       canonical(5). For an overview of Postfix address manipulations see the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma. Tables will be searched
       in the specified order until a match is found.  Note: these lookups are recursive.

       If you use this feature, run "postmap /etc/postfix/canonical" to build the necessary DBM or DB file after
       every  change.  The  changes will become visible after a minute or so.  Use "postfix reload" to eliminate
       the delay.

       Note: with Postfix version 2.2, message header address mapping happens only when message  header  address
       rewriting is enabled:

       •      The message is received with the Postfix sendmail(1) command,

       •      The message is received from a network client that matches $local_header_rewrite_clients,

       •      The message is received from the network, and the remote_header_rewrite_domain parameter specifies
              a non-empty value.

       To get the behavior before Postfix version 2.2, specify "local_header_rewrite_clients = static:all".

       Examples:

       canonical_maps = dbm:/etc/postfix/canonical
       canonical_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/canonical

cleanup_replace_stray_cr_lf (default: yes)

       Replace  each stray <CR> or <LF> character in message content with a space character, to prevent outbound
       SMTP smuggling, and to make the evaluation of Postfix-added DKIM or other signatures independent from how
       a remote mail server handles such characters.

       SMTP does not allow such characters unless they are part of  a  <CR><LF>  sequence,  and  different  mail
       systems handle such stray characters in an implementation-dependent manner. Stray <CR> or <LF> characters
       could  be  used  for  outbound  SMTP  smuggling,  where an attacker uses a Postfix server to send message
       content with a non-standard End-of-DATA sequence that triggers inbound SMTP smuggling at  a  remote  SMTP
       server.

       The  replacement  happens  before  all  other  content management, and before Postfix may add a DKIM etc.
       signature; if the signature were created first, the replacement could invalidate the signature.

       In addition to preventing SMTP smuggling, replacing stray <CR> or <LF> characters ensures that the result
       of signature validation by later mail system will not depend on how that mail system handles those  stray
       characters in an implementation-dependent manner.

       This feature is available in Postfix >= 3.9, 3.8.5, 3.7.10, 3.6.14, and 3.5.24.

cleanup_service_name (default: cleanup)

       The  name of the cleanup(8) service. This service rewrites addresses into the standard form, and performs
       canonical(5) address mapping and virtual(5) aliasing.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

command_directory (default: see postconf -d output)

       The location of all postfix administrative commands.

command_execution_directory (default: empty)

       The local(8) delivery agent working directory for delivery  to  external  commands.   Failure  to  change
       directory causes the delivery to be deferred.

       The  command_execution_directory value is not subject to Postfix configuration parameter $name expansion.
       Instead, the following $name expansions are done on command_execution_directory before the  directory  is
       used.  Expansion  happens  in  the  context  of  the  delivery request.  The result of $name expansion is
       filtered  with  the  character  set  that  is  specified  with  the  execution_directory_expansion_filter
       parameter.

       $user  The recipient's username.

       $shell The recipient's login shell pathname.

       $home  The recipient's home directory.

       $recipient
              The full recipient address.

       $extension
              The optional recipient address extension.

       $domain
              The recipient domain.

       $local The entire recipient localpart.

       $recipient_delimiter
              The  address extension delimiter that was found in the recipient address (Postfix 2.11 and later),
              or the system-wide recipient address extension delimiter (Postfix 2.10 and earlier).

       ${name?value}

       ${name?{value}} (Postfix >= 3.0)
              Expands to value when $name is non-empty.

       ${name:value}

       ${name:{value}} (Postfix >= 3.0)
              Expands to value when $name is empty.

       ${name?{value1}:{value2}} (Postfix >= 3.0)
              Expands to value1 when $name is non-empty, value2 otherwise.

       Instead of $name you can also specify ${name} or $(name).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

command_expansion_filter (default: see postconf -d output)

       Restrict the characters that the local(8) delivery agent allows in $name expansions  of  $mailbox_command
       and $command_execution_directory.  Characters outside the allowed set are replaced by underscores.

command_time_limit (default: 1000s)

       Time  limit  for delivery to external commands. This limit is used by the local(8) delivery agent, and is
       the default time limit for delivery by the pipe(8) delivery agent.

       Note: if you set this time limit to a large value you must update the  global  ipc_timeout  parameter  as
       well.

compatibility_level (default: 0)

       A  safety net that causes Postfix to run with backwards-compatible default settings after an upgrade to a
       newer Postfix version.

       With backwards compatibility turned on (the main.cf compatibility_level value is less  than  the  Postfix
       built-in  value),  Postfix  looks  for settings that are left at their implicit default value, and logs a
       message when a backwards-compatible default setting is required.

           using backwards-compatible default setting name=value
               to [accept a specific client request]

           using backwards-compatible default setting name=value
               to [enable specific Postfix behavior]

       See COMPATIBILITY_README for specific message details. If such a message is logged in the  context  of  a
       legitimate  request,  the  system administrator should make the backwards-compatible setting permanent in
       main.cf or master.cf, for example:

           # postconf name=value
           # postfix reload

       When no more backwards-compatible settings need to be made permanent, the administrator should  turn  off
       backwards compatibility by updating the compatibility_level setting in main.cf:

           # postconf compatibility_level=N
           # postfix reload

       For N specify the number that is logged in your postfix(1) warning message:

           warning: To disable backwards compatibility use "postconf
               compatibility_level=N" and "postfix reload"

       Starting  with  Postfix  version 3.6, the compatibility level in the above warning message is the Postfix
       version that introduced the last incompatible change. The level is formatted as major.minor.patch,  where
       patch is usually omitted and defaults to zero. Earlier compatibility levels are 0, 1 and 2.

       NOTE:  this  also  introduces  support  for  the  "<level",  "<=level",  and  other  operators to compare
       compatibility levels.  With the standard operators "<", "<=", etc., compatibility level "3.10"  would  be
       smaller than "3.9" which is undesirable.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

config_directory (default: see postconf -d output)

       The  default location of the Postfix main.cf and master.cf configuration files. This can be overruled via
       the following mechanisms:

       •      The MAIL_CONFIG environment variable (daemon processes and commands).

       •      The "-c" command-line option (commands only).

       With Postfix commands that run with set-gid privileges, a config_directory override either requires  root
       privileges,  or  it requires that the directory is listed with the alternate_config_directories parameter
       in the default main.cf file.

confirm_delay_cleared (default: no)

       After sending a "your message is delayed" notification, inform the sender when the delay clears up.  This
       can  result in a sudden burst of notifications at the end of a prolonged network outage, and is therefore
       disabled by default.

       See also: delay_warning_time.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

connection_cache_protocol_timeout (default: 5s)

       Time limit for connection cache connect, send or receive operations.  The time limit is enforced  in  the
       client.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

connection_cache_service_name (default: scache)

       The  name  of  the  scache(8)  connection cache service.  This service maintains a limited pool of cached
       sessions.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

connection_cache_status_update_time (default: 600s)

       How frequently the scache(8) server logs usage statistics with connection cache hit and  miss  rates  for
       logical destinations and for physical endpoints.

connection_cache_ttl_limit (default: 2s)

       The maximal time-to-live value that the scache(8) connection cache server allows. Requests that specify a
       larger  TTL  will  be  stored  with the maximum allowed TTL. The purpose of this additional control is to
       protect the infrastructure against careless people. The cache TTL is already bounded by $max_idle.

content_filter (default: empty)

       After the message is queued,  send  the  entire  message  to  the  specified  transport:destination.  The
       transport  name specifies the first field of a mail delivery agent definition in master.cf; the syntax of
       the next-hop destination is described in the manual page  of  the  corresponding  delivery  agent.   More
       information about external content filters is in the Postfix FILTER_README file.

       Notes:

       •      This  setting  has  lower  precedence  than  a  FILTER  action  that is specified in an access(5),
              header_checks(5) or body_checks(5) table.

       •      The meaning of an empty next-hop filter destination is version dependent.  Postfix 2.7  and  later
              will   use   the   recipient   domain;   earlier   versions   will   use   $myhostname.    Specify
              "default_filter_nexthop = $myhostname" for compatibility with Postfix 2.6 or earlier, or specify a
              content_filter value with an explicit next-hop destination.

cyrus_sasl_config_path (default: empty)

       Search path  for  Cyrus  SASL  application  configuration  files,  currently  used  only  to  locate  the
       $smtpd_sasl_path.conf file.  Specify zero or more directories separated by a colon character, or an empty
       value to use Cyrus SASL's built-in search path.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later when compiled with Cyrus SASL 2.1.22 or later.

daemon_directory (default: see postconf -d output)

       The directory with Postfix support programs and daemon programs.  These should not be invoked directly by
       humans. The directory must be owned by root.

daemon_table_open_error_is_fatal (default: no)

       How a Postfix daemon process handles errors while opening lookup tables: gradual degradation or immediate
       termination.

        no  (default)
              Gradual  degradation: a daemon process logs a message of type "error" and continues execution with
              reduced functionality. Features that do not depend on the unavailable table  will  work  normally,
              while features that depend on the table will result in a type "warning" message.
              When  the  notify_classes  parameter  value contains the "data" class, the Postfix SMTP server and
              client will report transcripts of sessions with an error because a table is unavailable.

        yes  (historical behavior)
              Immediate termination: a daemon process logs a type "fatal" message  and  terminates  immediately.
              This  option  reduces  the  number  of  possible  code paths through Postfix, and may therefore be
              slightly more secure than the default.

       For the sake of sanity, the number of type "error" messages is limited to  13  over  the  lifetime  of  a
       daemon process.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.9 and later.

daemon_timeout (default: 18000s)

       How much time a Postfix daemon process may take to handle a request before it is terminated by a built-in
       watchdog timer.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

data_directory (default: see postconf -d output)

       The directory with Postfix-writable data  files  (for  example:  caches,  pseudo-random  numbers).   This
       directory must be owned by the mail_owner account, and must not be shared with non-Postfix software.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

debug_peer_level (default: 2)

       The  increment  in  verbose  logging  level  when  a nexthop destination, remote client or server name or
       network address matches a pattern given with the debug_peer_list parameter.

       Per-nexthop debug logging is available in Postfix 3.6 and later.

debug_peer_list (default: empty)

       Optional list of nexthop destination, remote client or server name or network address patterns  that,  if
       matched, cause the verbose logging level to increase by the amount specified in $debug_peer_level.

       Per-nexthop debug logging is available in Postfix 3.6 and later.

       Specify  domain names, network/netmask patterns, "/file/name" patterns or "type:table" lookup tables. The
       right-hand side result from "type:table" lookups is ignored.

       Pattern matching of domain names is controlled by the presence or absence  of  "debug_peer_list"  in  the
       parent_domain_matches_subdomains parameter value.

       Examples:

       debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
       debug_peer_list = example.com

debugger_command (default: empty)

       The external command to execute when a Postfix daemon program is invoked with the -D option.

       Use  "command  .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before the process marches on. If you use an
       X-based debugger, be sure to set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.

       Note: the command is subject to $name expansion, before it is passed to the default command  interpreter.
       Specify "$$" to produce a single "$" character.

       Example:

       debugger_command =
           PATH=/usr/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
           ddd $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5

default_database_type (default: see postconf -d output)

       The  default  database  type for use in newaliases(1), postalias(1) and postmap(1) commands. On many UNIX
       systems the default type is either dbm or hash. The default setting is frozen when the Postfix system  is
       built.

       Examples:

       default_database_type = hash
       default_database_type = dbm

default_delivery_slot_cost (default: 5)

       How  often  the  Postfix  queue  manager's  scheduler  is allowed to preempt delivery of one message with
       another.

       Each transport maintains a so-called "available delivery slot counter" for each message. One message  can
       be  preempted  by another one when the other message can be delivered using no more delivery slots (i.e.,
       invocations of delivery agents) than the current message counter  has  accumulated  (or  will  eventually
       accumulate  - see about slot loans below). This parameter controls how often the counter is incremented -
       it happens after each default_delivery_slot_cost recipients have been delivered.

       The cost of 0 is used to disable the preempting scheduling completely.  The minimum value the  scheduling
       algorithm can use is 2 - use it if you want to maximize the message throughput rate. Although there is no
       maximum, it doesn't make much sense to use values above say 50.

       The  only  reason why the value of 2 is not the default is the way this parameter affects the delivery of
       mailing-list mail. In the worst case, delivery can take somewhere between (cost+1/cost) and (cost/cost-1)
       times more than if the preemptive scheduler was disabled. The default value of 5  turns  out  to  provide
       reasonable  message response times while making sure the mailing-list deliveries are not extended by more
       than 20-25 percent even in the worst case.

       Use transport_delivery_slot_cost to  specify  a  transport-specific  override,  where  transport  is  the
       master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       Examples:

       default_delivery_slot_cost = 0
       default_delivery_slot_cost = 2

default_delivery_slot_discount (default: 50)

       The default value for transport-specific _delivery_slot_discount settings.

       This  parameter  speeds  up the moment when a message preemption can happen. Instead of waiting until the
       full  amount  of   delivery   slots   required   is   available,   the   preemption   can   happen   when
       transport_delivery_slot_discount  percent  of the required amount plus transport_delivery_slot_loan still
       remains to be accumulated.  Note that the full amount will still have to be  accumulated  before  another
       preemption can take place later.

       Use  transport_delivery_slot_discount  to  specify  a transport-specific override, where transport is the
       master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

default_delivery_slot_loan (default: 3)

       The default value for transport-specific _delivery_slot_loan settings.

       This parameter speeds up the moment when a message preemption can happen. Instead of  waiting  until  the
       full   amount   of   delivery   slots   required   is   available,   the   preemption   can  happen  when
       transport_delivery_slot_discount percent of the required amount plus  transport_delivery_slot_loan  still
       remains  to  be  accumulated.  Note that the full amount will still have to be accumulated before another
       preemption can take place later.

       Use transport_delivery_slot_loan to  specify  a  transport-specific  override,  where  transport  is  the
       master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

default_delivery_status_filter (default: empty)

       Optional  filter  to  replace  the delivery status code or explanatory text of successful or unsuccessful
       deliveries.  This does not allow the replacement of a successful status code (2.X.X) with an unsuccessful
       status code (4.X.X or 5.X.X) or vice versa.

       Note: the (smtp|lmtp)_delivery_status_filter is  applied  only  once  per  recipient:  when  delivery  is
       successful, when delivery is rejected with 5XX, or when there are no more alternate MX or A destinations.
       Use smtp_reply_filter or lmtp_reply_filter to inspect responses for all delivery attempts.

       The   following   parameters   can   be  used  to  implement  a  filter  for  specific  delivery  agents:
       lmtp_delivery_status_filter,          local_delivery_status_filter,          pipe_delivery_status_filter,
       smtp_delivery_status_filter  or  virtual_delivery_status_filter. These parameters support the same filter
       syntax as described here.

       Specify zero or more "type:table" lookup  table  names,  separated  by  comma  or  whitespace.  For  each
       successful  or  unsuccessful  delivery to a recipient, the tables are queried in the specified order with
       one line of text that is structured as follows:

           enhanced-status-code SPACE explanatory-text

       The first table match wins. The lookup result must have the same structure as  the  query,  a  successful
       status code (2.X.X) must be replaced with a successful status code, an unsuccessful status code (4.X.X or
       5.X.X)  must  be  replaced  with  an  unsuccessful  status  code,  and the explanatory text field must be
       non-empty. Other results will result in a warning.

       Example 1: convert specific soft TLS errors into hard errors, by  overriding  the  first  number  in  the
       enhanced status code.

           /etc/postfix/main.cf:
               smtp_delivery_status_filter = pcre:/etc/postfix/smtp_dsn_filter

           /etc/postfix/smtp_dsn_filter:
               /^4(\.\d+\.\d+ TLS is required, but host \S+ refused to start TLS: .+)/
                   5$1
               /^4(\.\d+\.\d+ TLS is required, but was not offered by host .+)/
                   5$1
               # Do not change the following into hard bounces. They may
               # result from a local configuration problem.
               # 4.\d+.\d+ TLS is required, but our TLS engine is unavailable
               # 4.\d+.\d+ TLS is required, but unavailable
               # 4.\d+.\d+ Cannot start TLS: handshake failure

       Example  2:  censor  the  per-recipient  delivery  status text so that it does not reveal the destination
       command or filename when a remote sender requests confirmation of successful delivery.

           /etc/postfix/main.cf:
               local_delivery_status_filter = pcre:/etc/postfix/local_dsn_filter

           /etc/postfix/local_dsn_filter:
               /^(2\S+ delivered to file).+/    $1
               /^(2\S+ delivered to command).+/ $1

       Notes:

       •      This feature will NOT override the soft_bounce safety net.

       •      This feature will change the enhanced status code and text that is logged to the maillog file, and
              that is reported to the sender in delivery confirmation or non-delivery notifications.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

default_destination_concurrency_failed_cohort_limit (default: 1)

       How many pseudo-cohorts must suffer connection or handshake failure  before  a  specific  destination  is
       considered  unavailable  (and  further  delivery  is  suspended). Specify zero to disable this feature. A
       destination's pseudo-cohort failure count is reset each time a delivery completes without  connection  or
       handshake failure for that specific destination.

       A pseudo-cohort is the number of deliveries equal to a destination's delivery concurrency.

       Use transport_destination_concurrency_failed_cohort_limit to specify a transport-specific override, where
       transport is the master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       This  feature  is  available  in  Postfix  2.5.  The  default  setting is compatible with earlier Postfix
       versions.

default_destination_concurrency_limit (default: 20)

       The default maximal number of parallel deliveries to the same destination.  This is the default limit for
       delivery via the lmtp(8), pipe(8), smtp(8)  and  virtual(8)  delivery  agents.   With  a  per-destination
       recipient limit > 1, a destination is a domain, otherwise it is a recipient.

       Use  transport_destination_concurrency_limit to specify a transport-specific override, where transport is
       the master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

default_destination_concurrency_negative_feedback (default: 1)

       The per-destination amount of delivery concurrency negative feedback, after a delivery completes  with  a
       connection or handshake failure. Feedback values are in the range 0..1 inclusive. With negative feedback,
       concurrency  is  decremented at the beginning of a sequence of length 1/feedback. This is unlike positive
       feedback, where concurrency is incremented at the end of a sequence of length 1/feedback.

       As of Postfix version 2.5, negative feedback cannot reduce delivery  concurrency  to  zero.   Instead,  a
       destination  is  marked  dead  (further  delivery suspended) after the failed pseudo-cohort count reaches
       $default_destination_concurrency_failed_cohort_limit                                                  (or
       $transport_destination_concurrency_failed_cohort_limit).   To  make  the  scheduler  completely immune to
       connection or handshake failures, specify a zero feedback value and a zero failed pseudo-cohort limit.

       Specify one of the following forms:

       number

       number / number
              Constant feedback. The value must be in the range 0..1 inclusive.  The default setting of  "1"  is
              compatible  with  Postfix  versions  before  2.5,  where  a  destination's delivery concurrency is
              throttled down to zero (and further delivery suspended) after a single failed pseudo-cohort.

       number / concurrency
              Variable feedback of "number / (delivery concurrency)".  The number must  be  in  the  range  0..1
              inclusive.  With  number  equal  to  "1", a destination's delivery concurrency is decremented by 1
              after each failed pseudo-cohort.

       A pseudo-cohort is the number of deliveries equal to a destination's delivery concurrency.

       Use transport_destination_concurrency_negative_feedback to specify a transport-specific  override,  where
       transport is the master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       This  feature  is  available  in  Postfix  2.5.  The  default  setting is compatible with earlier Postfix
       versions.

default_destination_concurrency_positive_feedback (default: 1)

       The per-destination amount of delivery concurrency positive feedback, after a delivery completes  without
       connection  or  handshake  failure.  Feedback  values  are  in the range 0..1 inclusive.  The concurrency
       increases until it reaches  the  per-destination  maximal  concurrency  limit.  With  positive  feedback,
       concurrency  is  incremented  at  the  end  of a sequence with length 1/feedback. This is unlike negative
       feedback, where concurrency is decremented at the start of a sequence of length 1/feedback.

       Specify one of the following forms:

       number

       number / number
              Constant feedback.  The value must be in the range 0..1 inclusive. The default setting of  "1"  is
              compatible  with  Postfix  versions before 2.5, where a destination's delivery concurrency doubles
              after each successful pseudo-cohort.

       number / concurrency
              Variable feedback of "number / (delivery concurrency)".  The number must  be  in  the  range  0..1
              inclusive.  With  number  equal  to  "1", a destination's delivery concurrency is incremented by 1
              after each successful pseudo-cohort.

       A pseudo-cohort is the number of deliveries equal to a destination's delivery concurrency.

       Use transport_destination_concurrency_positive_feedback to specify a transport-specific  override,  where
       transport is the master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

default_destination_rate_delay (default: 0s)

       The  default  amount  of  delay  that  is  inserted  between  individual  message  deliveries to the same
       destination and over the same message delivery transport. Specify a non-zero value  to  rate-limit  those
       message deliveries to at most one per $default_destination_rate_delay.

       The resulting behavior depends on the value of the corresponding per-destination recipient limit.

       •      With  a  corresponding  per-destination  recipient  limit  >  1, the rate delay specifies the time
              between deliveries to the same domain.  Different domains are delivered in  parallel,  subject  to
              the process limits specified in master.cf.

       •      With a corresponding per-destination recipient limit equal to 1, the rate delay specifies the time
              between  deliveries to the same recipient. Different recipients are delivered in parallel, subject
              to the process limits specified in master.cf.

       To enable the delay, specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter  suffix
       that specifies the time unit).

       Time  units:  s  (seconds),  m  (minutes),  h  (hours),  d  (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s
       (seconds).

       NOTE: the delay is enforced by the queue manager. The delay timer state does not survive "postfix reload"
       or "postfix stop".

       Use transport_destination_rate_delay to specify a transport-specific override,  where  transport  is  the
       master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       NOTE:          with         a         non-zero         _destination_rate_delay,         specify         a
       transport_destination_concurrency_failed_cohort_limit of 10 or more to prevent Postfix from deferring all
       mail for the same destination after only one connection or handshake error.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

default_destination_recipient_limit (default: 50)

       The default maximal number of recipients per message delivery.  This is the default  limit  for  delivery
       via the lmtp(8), pipe(8), smtp(8) and virtual(8) delivery agents.

       Setting this parameter to a value of 1 affects email deliveries as follows:

       •      It changes the meaning of the corresponding per-destination concurrency limit, from concurrency of
              deliveries  to  the  same  domain into concurrency of deliveries to the same recipient.  Different
              recipients are delivered in parallel, subject to the process limits specified in master.cf.

       •      It changes the meaning of the corresponding per-destination rate delay,  from  the  delay  between
              deliveries  to  the  same  domain into the delay between deliveries to the same recipient.  Again,
              different recipients are delivered in  parallel,  subject  to  the  process  limits  specified  in
              master.cf.

       •      It  changes  the meaning of other corresponding per-destination settings in a similar manner, from
              settings for delivery to the same domain into settings for delivery to the same recipient.

       Use transport_destination_recipient_limit to specify a transport-specific override,  where  transport  is
       the master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

default_extra_recipient_limit (default: 1000)

       The  default value for the extra per-transport limit imposed on the number of in-memory recipients.  This
       extra recipient space is reserved for the cases when the Postfix queue manager's scheduler  preempts  one
       message  with  another  and  suddenly needs some extra recipient slots for the chosen message in order to
       avoid performance degradation.

       Use transport_extra_recipient_limit to specify a transport-specific  override,  where  transport  is  the
       master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

default_filter_nexthop (default: empty)

       When   a   content_filter   or   FILTER   request   specifies   no  explicit  next-hop  destination,  use
       $default_filter_nexthop instead; when that value is empty, use  the  domain  in  the  recipient  address.
       Specify "default_filter_nexthop = $myhostname" for compatibility with Postfix version 2.6 and earlier, or
       specify an explicit next-hop destination with each content_filter value or FILTER action.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7 and later.

default_minimum_delivery_slots (default: 3)

       How  many  recipients  a  message  must  have  in  order to invoke the Postfix queue manager's scheduling
       algorithm at all.  Messages which would never accumulate at least this many delivery  slots  (subject  to
       slot cost parameter as well) are never preempted.

       Use  transport_minimum_delivery_slots  to  specify  a transport-specific override, where transport is the
       master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

default_privs (default: nobody)

       The default rights used by the local(8) delivery agent for delivery  to  an  external  file  or  command.
       These  rights  are used when delivery is requested from an aliases(5) file that is owned by root, or when
       delivery is done on behalf of root. DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.

default_process_limit (default: 100)

       The default maximal number of Postfix child processes that provide a given service.  This  limit  can  be
       overruled for specific services in the master.cf file.

default_rbl_reply (default: see postconf -d output)

       The  default  Postfix  SMTP  server  response  template  for  a  request that is rejected by an RBL-based
       restriction. This template can be overruled by specific entries in  the  optional  rbl_reply_maps  lookup
       table.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

       The  template  does  not support Postfix configuration parameter $name substitution. Instead, it supports
       exactly one level of $name substitution for the following attributes:

       $client
              The client hostname and IP address, formatted as name[address].

       $client_address
              The client IP address.

       $client_name
              The client hostname or "unknown". See reject_unknown_client_hostname for more details.

       $reverse_client_name
              The     client     hostname     from     address->name     lookup,     or     "unknown".       See
              reject_unknown_reverse_client_hostname for more details.

       $helo_name
              The hostname given in HELO or EHLO command or empty string.

       $rbl_class
              The denylisted entity type: Client host, Helo command, Sender address, or Recipient address.

       $rbl_code
              The  numerical  SMTP  response  code,  as  specified  with  the maps_rbl_reject_code configuration
              parameter. Note: The numerical SMTP response code is required, and must appear at the start of the
              reply. With Postfix version 2.3 and later this information may be followed by an RFC 3463 enhanced
              status code.

       $rbl_domain
              The RBL domain where $rbl_what is denylisted.

       $rbl_reason
              The reason why $rbl_what is denylisted, or an empty string.

       $rbl_what
              The entity that is denylisted (an IP address, a hostname, a domain name, or an email address whose
              domain was denylisted).

       $recipient
              The recipient address or <> in case of the null address.

       $recipient_domain
              The recipient domain or empty string.

       $recipient_name
              The recipient address localpart or <> in case of null address.

       $sender
              The sender address or <> in case of the null address.

       $sender_domain
              The sender domain or empty string.

       $sender_name
              The sender address localpart or <> in case of the null address.

       ${name?value}

       ${name?{value}} (Postfix >= 3.0)
              Expands to value when $name is non-empty.

       ${name:value}

       ${name:{value}} (Postfix >= 3.0)
              Expands to value when $name is empty.

       ${name?{value1}:{value2}} (Postfix >= 3.0)
              Expands to value1 when $name is non-empty, value2 otherwise.

       Instead of $name you can also specify ${name} or $(name).

       Note: when an enhanced status code is specified in an RBL reply template, it is subject to  modification.
       The  following  transformations  are  needed  when  the same RBL reply template is used for client, helo,
       sender, or recipient access restrictions.

       •      When rejecting a sender address, the Postfix SMTP server will transform  a  recipient  DSN  status
              (e.g., 4.1.1-4.1.6) into the corresponding sender DSN status, and vice versa.

       •      When  rejecting  non-address  information  (such  as  the  HELO  command  argument  or  the client
              hostname/address), the Postfix SMTP server will transform a sender or recipient DSN status into  a
              generic non-address DSN status (e.g., 4.0.0).

default_recipient_limit (default: 20000)

       The  default per-transport upper limit on the number of in-memory recipients.  These limits take priority
       over the global qmgr_message_recipient_limit after the  message  has  been  assigned  to  the  respective
       transports.  See also default_extra_recipient_limit and qmgr_message_recipient_minimum.

       Use  transport_recipient_limit to specify a transport-specific override, where transport is the master.cf
       name of the message delivery transport.

default_recipient_refill_delay (default: 5s)

       The default per-transport maximum delay between refilling recipients.  When not  all  message  recipients
       fit  into  memory at once, keep loading more of them at least once every this many seconds.  This is used
       to make sure the recipients are refilled in a timely manner even when $default_recipient_refill_limit  is
       too high for too slow deliveries.

       Use  transport_recipient_refill_delay  to  specify  a transport-specific override, where transport is the
       master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.4 and later.

default_recipient_refill_limit (default: 100)

       The default per-transport limit on the number of recipients refilled  at  once.   When  not  all  message
       recipients fit into memory at once, keep loading more of them in batches of at least this many at a time.
       See also $default_recipient_refill_delay, which may result in recipient batches lower than this when this
       limit is too high for too slow deliveries.

       Use  transport_recipient_refill_limit  to  specify  a transport-specific override, where transport is the
       master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.4 and later.

default_transport (default: smtp)

       The default mail delivery  transport  and  next-hop  destination  for  destinations  that  do  not  match
       $mydestination, $inet_interfaces, $proxy_interfaces, $virtual_alias_domains, $virtual_mailbox_domains, or
       $relay_domains.   This  information  can  be  overruled  with the sender_dependent_default_transport_maps
       parameter and with the transport(5) table.

       In    order    of    decreasing    precedence,    the    nexthop    destination     is     taken     from
       $sender_dependent_default_transport_maps,      $default_transport,      $sender_dependent_relayhost_maps,
       $relayhost, or from the recipient domain.

       Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is the name of a mail delivery  transport
       defined  in master.cf.  The :nexthop destination is optional; its syntax is documented in the manual page
       of the corresponding delivery agent. In the case of SMTP  or  LMTP,  specify  one  or  more  destinations
       separated by comma or whitespace (with Postfix 3.5 and later).

       Example:

       default_transport = uucp:relayhostname

default_transport_rate_delay (default: 0s)

       The  default amount of delay that is inserted between individual message deliveries over the same message
       delivery transport, regardless of destination. Specify a  non-zero  value  to  rate-limit  those  message
       deliveries to at most one per $default_transport_rate_delay.

       Use  transport_transport_rate_delay to specify a transport-specific override, where the initial transport
       is the master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       Example: throttle outbound SMTP mail to at most 3 deliveries per minute.

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
           smtp_transport_rate_delay = 20s

       To enable the delay, specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter  suffix
       that specifies the time unit).

       Time  units:  s  (seconds),  m  (minutes),  h  (hours),  d  (days), w (weeks). The default time unit is s
       (seconds).

       NOTE: the delay is enforced by the queue manager.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.1 and later.

default_verp_delimiters (default: +=)

       The two default VERP delimiter characters. These are used when no explicit delimiters are specified  with
       the  SMTP  XVERP  command  or  with the "sendmail -XV" command-line option (Postfix 2.2 and earlier: -V).
       Specify characters that are allowed by the verp_delimiter_filter setting.

       This feature is available in Postfix 1.1 and later.

defer_code (default: 450)

       The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when a remote SMTP client  request  is  rejected  by  the
       "defer" restriction.

       Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of RFC 5321.

defer_service_name (default: defer)

       The name of the defer service. This service is implemented by the bounce(8) daemon and maintains a record
       of failed delivery attempts and generates non-delivery notifications.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

defer_transports (default: empty)

       The names of message delivery transports that should not deliver mail unless someone issues "sendmail -q"
       or  equivalent.  Specify  zero  or  more  mail delivery transport names that appear in the first field of
       master.cf.

       Example:

       defer_transports = smtp

delay_logging_resolution_limit (default: 2)

       The maximal number of digits after the decimal point when logging sub-second  delay  values.   Specify  a
       number in the range 0..6.

       Large  delay  values  are  rounded  off  to  an  integral  number  of  seconds;  delay  values  below the
       delay_logging_resolution_limit are logged as "0", and delay values under 100s are  logged  with  at  most
       two-digit precision.

       The format of the "delays=a/b/c/d" logging is as follows:

       •      a = time from message arrival to last active queue entry

       •      b = time from last active queue entry to connection setup

       •      c = time in connection setup, including DNS, EHLO and STARTTLS

       •      d = time in message transmission

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

delay_notice_recipient (default: postmaster)

       The  recipient  of  postmaster  notifications  with  the message headers of mail that cannot be delivered
       within $delay_warning_time time units.

       See also: delay_warning_time, notify_classes.

delay_warning_time (default: 0h)

       The time after which the sender receives a copy of the message headers of mail that is still queued.  The
       confirm_delay_cleared parameter controls sender notification when the delay clears up.

       To  enable  this  feature,  specify  a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter
       suffix that specifies the time unit).

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days),  w  (weeks).   The  default  time  unit  is  h
       (hours).

       See also: delay_notice_recipient, notify_classes, confirm_delay_cleared.

deliver_lock_attempts (default: 20)

       The maximal number of attempts to acquire an exclusive lock on a mailbox file or bounce(8) logfile.

deliver_lock_delay (default: 1s)

       The time between attempts to acquire an exclusive lock on a mailbox file or bounce(8) logfile.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

destination_concurrency_feedback_debug (default: no)

       Make the queue manager's feedback algorithm verbose for performance analysis purposes.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

detect_8bit_encoding_header (default: yes)

       Automatically detect 8BITMIME body content by  looking  at  Content-Transfer-Encoding:  message  headers;
       historically, this behavior was hard-coded to be "always on".

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

disable_dns_lookups (default: no)

       Disable  DNS  lookups  in  the Postfix SMTP and LMTP clients. When disabled, hosts are looked up with the
       getaddrinfo() system library routine which normally also looks in /etc/hosts.  As of Postfix  2.11,  this
       parameter is deprecated; use smtp_dns_support_level instead.

       DNS lookups are enabled by default.

disable_mime_input_processing (default: no)

       Turn  off  MIME  processing  while  receiving  mail.  This  means  that  no special treatment is given to
       Content-Type: message headers, and that all text after the initial message headers is  considered  to  be
       part of the message body.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

       Mime  input processing is enabled by default, and is needed in order to recognize MIME headers in message
       content.

disable_mime_output_conversion (default: no)

       Disable the conversion of 8BITMIME format to 7BIT format.  Mime output  conversion  is  needed  when  the
       destination does not advertise 8BITMIME support.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

disable_verp_bounces (default: no)

       Disable sending one bounce report per recipient.

       The default, one per recipient, is what ezmlm needs.

       This feature is available in Postfix 1.1 and later.

disable_vrfy_command (default: no)

       Disable the SMTP VRFY command. This stops some techniques used to harvest email addresses.

       Example:

       disable_vrfy_command = no

dns_ncache_ttl_fix_enable (default: no)

       Enable  a  workaround  for  future  libc incompatibility. The Postfix implementation of RFC 2308 negative
       reply caching relies on the promise that res_query() and res_search() invoke  res_send(),  which  returns
       the server response in an application buffer even if the requested record does not exist. If this promise
       is broken, specify "yes" to enable a  workaround for DNS reputation lookups.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.1 and later.

dnsblog_reply_delay (default: 0s)

       A debugging aid to artificially delay DNS responses.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

dnsblog_service_name (default: dnsblog)

       The name of the dnsblog(8) service entry in master.cf. This service performs DNS allow/denylist lookups.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

dnssec_probe (default: ns:.)

       The  DNS  query  type (default: "ns") and DNS query name (default: ".") that Postfix may use to determine
       whether DNSSEC validation is available.

       Background: DNSSEC validation is needed for Postfix DANE support; this ensures that Postfix receives TLSA
       records with secure TLS server certificate info. When DNSSEC validation is unavailable,  mail  deliveries
       using  opportunistic  DANE  will  not  be  protected by server certificate info in TLSA records, and mail
       deliveries using mandatory DANE will not be made at all.

       By default, a Postfix process will send a DNSSEC probe after  1)  the  process  made  a  DNS  query  that
       requested  DNSSEC validation, 2) the process did not receive a DNSSEC validated response to this query or
       to an earlier query, and 3) the process did not already send a DNSSEC probe.

       When the DNSSEC probe has no response, or when the response is  not  DNSSEC  validated,  Postfix  logs  a
       warning that DNSSEC validation may be unavailable.

       Example:

       warning: DNSSEC validation may be unavailable
       warning: reason: dnssec_probe 'ns:.' received a response that is not DNSSEC validated
       warning: reason: dnssec_probe 'ns:.' received no response: Server failure

       Possible reasons why DNSSEC validation may be unavailable:

       •      The  local /etc/resolv.conf file specifies a DNS resolver that does not validate DNSSEC signatures
              (that's $queue_directory/etc/resolv.conf when a Postfix daemon runs in a chroot jail).

       •      The local system library does not pass on the "DNSSEC validated" bit to Postfix, or  Postfix  does
              not know how to ask the library to do that.

       By  default, the DNSSEC probe asks for the DNS root zone NS records, because resolvers should always have
       that information cached. If Postfix runs on a network where the DNS root zone is not reachable, specify a
       different probe, or specify an empty dnssec_probe value to disable the feature.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.6 and later. It was backported to Postfix versions 3.5.9,  3.4.19,
       3.3.16. 3.2.21.

dont_remove (default: 0)

       Don't  remove  queue files and save them to the "saved" mail queue.  This is a debugging aid.  To inspect
       the envelope information and content of a Postfix queue file, use the postcat(1) command.

double_bounce_sender (default: double-bounce)

       The sender address of postmaster notifications that are generated by the mail system. All  mail  to  this
       address is silently discarded, in order to terminate mail bounce loops.

duplicate_filter_limit (default: 1000)

       The  maximal  number of addresses remembered by the address duplicate filter for aliases(5) or virtual(5)
       alias expansion, or for showq(8) queue displays.

empty_address_default_transport_maps_lookup_key (default: <>)

       The sender_dependent_default_transport_maps search string that will be used instead of  the  null  sender
       address.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7 and later.

empty_address_local_login_sender_maps_lookup_key (default: <>)

       The lookup key to be used in local_login_sender_maps tables, instead of the null sender address.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.6 and later.

empty_address_recipient (default: MAILER-DAEMON)

       The  recipient  of  mail  addressed  to the null address.  Postfix does not accept such addresses in SMTP
       commands, but they may still be created locally as the result of configuration or software error.

empty_address_relayhost_maps_lookup_key (default: <>)

       The sender_dependent_relayhost_maps search string that will be used instead of the null sender address.

       This   feature   is    available    in    Postfix    2.5    and    later.    With    earlier    versions,
       sender_dependent_relayhost_maps lookups were skipped for the null sender address.

enable_errors_to (default: no)

       Report  mail  delivery  errors  to the address specified with the non-standard Errors-To: message header,
       instead of the envelope sender address (this feature is removed with Postfix version 2.2, is  turned  off
       by default with Postfix version 2.1, and is always turned on with older Postfix versions).

enable_idna2003_compatibility (default: no)

       Enable  'transitional'  compatibility  between  IDNA2003 and IDNA2008, when converting UTF-8 domain names
       to/from the ASCII form that is used for DNS lookups. Specify "yes" for compatibility with Postfix <=  3.1
       (not recommended). This affects the conversion of domain names that contain for example the German sz and
       the Greek zeta.  See http://unicode.org/cldr/utility/idna.jsp for more examples.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.2 and later.

enable_long_queue_ids (default: no)

       Enable  long, non-repeating, queue IDs (queue file names).  The benefit of non-repeating names is simpler
       logfile analysis and easier queue migration (there is no need to run "postsuper"  to  change  queue  file
       names that don't match their message file inode number).

       Note: see below for how to convert long queue file names to Postfix <= 2.8.

       Changing the parameter value to "yes" has the following effects:

       •      Existing queue file names are not affected.

       •      New  queue  files  are  created  with  names  such  as  3Pt2mN2VXxznjll.   These  are encoded in a
              52-character alphabet that contains digits (0-9), upper-case letters (B-Z) and lower-case  letters
              (b-z). For safety reasons the vowels (AEIOUaeiou) are excluded from the alphabet.  The name format
              is:  6  or more characters for the time in seconds, 4 characters for the time in microseconds, the
              'z'; the remainder is the file inode number encoded in the first 51 characters of the 52-character
              alphabet.

       •      New messages have a Message-ID header with queueID@myhostname.

       •      The mailq (postqueue -p) output has a wider Queue ID column.  The number  of  whitespace-separated
              fields is not changed.

       •      The  hash_queue_depth  algorithm  uses  the  first  characters  of the queue file creation time in
              microseconds, after conversion into hexadecimal  representation.  This  produces  the  same  queue
              hashing behavior as if the queue file name was created with "enable_long_queue_ids = no".

       Changing the parameter value to "no" has the following effects:

       •      Existing  long  queue  file names are renamed to the short form (while running "postfix reload" or
              "postsuper").

       •      New queue files are created with names such  as  C3CD21F3E90  from  a  hexadecimal  alphabet  that
              contains  digits (0-9) and upper-case letters (A-F). The name format is: 5 characters for the time
              in microseconds; the remainder is the file inode number.

       •      New messages have a Message-ID header with YYYYMMDDHHMMSS.queueid@myhostname, where YYYYMMDDHHMMSS
              are the year, month, day, hour, minute and second.

       •      The mailq (postqueue -p) output has the same format as with Postfix <= 2.8.

       •      The hash_queue_depth algorithm uses the  first  characters  of  the  queue  file  name,  with  the
              hexadecimal representation of the file creation time in microseconds.

       Before  migration to Postfix <= 2.8, the following commands are required to convert long queue file names
       into short names:

       # postfix stop
       # postconf enable_long_queue_ids=no
       # postsuper

       Repeat the postsuper command until it reports no more queue file name changes.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.9 and later.

enable_original_recipient (default: yes)

       Enable support for the original recipient address after an address is rewritten to  a  different  address
       (for example with aliasing or with canonical mapping).

       The original recipient address is used as follows:

       Final delivery
              With  "enable_original_recipient  =  yes",  the  original  recipient  address  is  stored  in  the
              X-Original-To message header. This header may be used to distinguish between different  recipients
              that share the same mailbox.

       Recipient deduplication
              With  "enable_original_recipient  =  yes",  the  cleanup(8)  daemon  performs  duplicate recipient
              elimination based on  the  content  of  (original  recipient,  maybe-rewritten  recipient)  pairs.
              Otherwise,  the  cleanup(8)  daemon  performs  duplicate  recipient  elimination based only on the
              maybe-rewritten recipient address.

       Note: with Postfix <= 3.2 the "setting enable_original_recipient = no" breaks  address  verification  for
       addresses  that  are  aliased or otherwise rewritten (Postfix is unable to store the address verification
       result under the original probe destination address; instead, it can store  the  result  only  under  the
       rewritten address).

       This  feature  is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. Postfix version 2.0 behaves as if this parameter is
       always set to yes.  Postfix versions before 2.0 have no support for the original recipient address.

enable_threaded_bounces (default: no)

       Enable non-delivery, success, and delay notifications that link to the original message  by  including  a
       References:  and  In-Reply-To:  header  with  the  original  Message-ID  value.  There are advantages and
       disadvantages to consider.

        advantage
              This allows mail readers to present a delivery status notification in the same email thread as the
              original message.

        disadvantage
              This makes it easy for users to mistakenly delete the whole email thread (all  related  messages),
              instead of deleting only the non-delivery notification.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.6 and later.

error_notice_recipient (default: postmaster)

       The  recipient  of  postmaster  notifications  about  mail  delivery  problems that are caused by policy,
       resource, software  or  protocol  errors.   These  notifications  are  enabled  with  the  notify_classes
       parameter.

error_service_name (default: error)

       The name of the error(8) pseudo delivery agent. This service always returns mail as undeliverable.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

execution_directory_expansion_filter (default: see postconf -d output)

       Restrict   the   characters   that   the   local(8)   delivery   agent  allows  in  $name  expansions  of
       $command_execution_directory.  Characters outside the allowed set are replaced by underscores.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

expand_owner_alias (default: no)

       When delivering to an alias "aliasname" that has an "owner-aliasname" companion alias, set  the  envelope
       sender  address  to  the  expansion  of the "owner-aliasname" alias.  Normally, Postfix sets the envelope
       sender address to the name of the "owner-aliasname" alias.

export_environment (default: see postconf -d output)

       The list of environment variables that a Postfix process will export to  non-Postfix  processes.  The  TZ
       variable is needed for sane time keeping on System-V-ish systems.

       Specify  a list of names and/or name=value pairs, separated by whitespace or comma. Specify "{ name=value
       }" to protect whitespace or comma in parameter values (whitespace after the opening "{"  and  before  the
       closing  "}" is ignored). The form name=value is supported with Postfix version 2.1 and later; the use of
       {} is supported with Postfix 3.0 and later.

       Example:

       export_environment = TZ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin

extract_recipient_limit (default: 10240)

       The maximal number of recipient addresses that Postfix will extract from message  headers  when  mail  is
       submitted with "sendmail -t".

       This feature was removed in Postfix version 2.1.

fallback_relay (default: empty)

       Optional  list  of  relay  hosts  for SMTP destinations that can't be found or that are unreachable. With
       Postfix 2.3 this parameter is renamed to smtp_fallback_relay.

       By default, mail is returned to the sender when a destination is not found, and delivery is deferred when
       a destination is unreachable.

       The fallback relays must be SMTP destinations. Specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,  [address]
       or  [address]:port;  the  form  [host]  turns off MX lookups.  If you specify multiple SMTP destinations,
       Postfix will try them in the specified order.

       Note: before Postfix 2.2, do not use the fallback_relay feature  when  relaying  mail  for  a  backup  or
       primary MX domain. Mail would loop between the Postfix MX host and the fallback_relay host when the final
       destination is unavailable.

       •      In main.cf specify "relay_transport = relay",

       •      In master.cf specify "-o fallback_relay =" (i.e., empty) at the end of the relay entry.

       •      In  transport  maps,  specify  "relay:nexthop..."  as the right-hand side for backup or primary MX
              domain entries.

       Postfix version 2.2 and later will not use the fallback_relay feature for destinations that it is MX host
       for.

fallback_transport (default: empty)

       Optional message delivery transport that the local(8) delivery agent should use for names  that  are  not
       found in the aliases(5) or UNIX password database.

       The   precedence   of  local(8)  delivery  features  from  high  to  low  is:  aliases,  .forward  files,
       mailbox_transport_maps,   mailbox_transport,   mailbox_command_maps,    mailbox_command,    home_mailbox,
       mail_spool_directory, fallback_transport_maps, fallback_transport and luser_relay.

fallback_transport_maps (default: empty)

       Optional  lookup  tables  with per-recipient message delivery transports for recipients that the local(8)
       delivery agent could not find in the aliases(5) or UNIX password database.

       The  precedence  of  local(8)  delivery  features  from  high  to  low  is:  aliases,   .forward   files,
       mailbox_transport_maps,    mailbox_transport,    mailbox_command_maps,   mailbox_command,   home_mailbox,
       mail_spool_directory, fallback_transport_maps, fallback_transport and luser_relay.

       For safety reasons, this feature does not allow $number substitutions in regular expression maps.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

fast_flush_domains (default: $relay_domains)

       Optional list of destinations that are eligible for per-destination logfiles with mail that is queued  to
       those destinations.

       By default, Postfix maintains "fast flush" logfiles only for destinations that the Postfix SMTP server is
       willing  to  relay  to (i.e. the default is: "fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains"; see the relay_domains
       parameter in the postconf(5) manual).

       Specify a list of hosts or domains, "/file/name" patterns or "type:table"  lookup  tables,  separated  by
       commas  and/or whitespace.  Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A "/file/name"
       pattern is replaced by its contents; a "type:table" lookup table is matched when the domain or its parent
       domain appears as lookup key.

       Pattern matching of domain names is controlled by the presence or absence of "fast_flush_domains" in  the
       parent_domain_matches_subdomains parameter value.

       Specify "fast_flush_domains =" (i.e., empty) to disable the feature altogether.

fast_flush_purge_time (default: 7d)

       The time after which an empty per-destination "fast flush" logfile is deleted.

       You  can  specify the time as a number, or as a number followed by a letter that indicates the time unit:
       s=seconds, m=minutes, h=hours, d=days, w=weeks.  The default time unit is days.

fast_flush_refresh_time (default: 12h)

       The time after which a non-empty but unread per-destination "fast flush" logfile needs to  be  refreshed.
       The contents of a logfile are refreshed by requesting delivery of all messages listed in the logfile.

       You  can  specify the time as a number, or as a number followed by a letter that indicates the time unit:
       s=seconds, m=minutes, h=hours, d=days, w=weeks.  The default time unit is hours.

fault_injection_code (default: 0)

       Force specific internal tests to fail, to test the handling of errors that  are  difficult  to  reproduce
       otherwise.

flush_service_name (default: flush)

       The  name  of  the  flush(8) service. This service maintains per-destination logfiles with the queue file
       names of mail that is queued for those destinations.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

fork_attempts (default: 5)

       The maximal number of attempts to fork() a child process.

fork_delay (default: 1s)

       The delay between attempts to fork() a child process.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

forward_expansion_filter (default: see postconf -d output)

       Restrict  the  characters  that  the local(8) delivery agent allows in $name expansions of $forward_path.
       Characters outside the allowed set are replaced by underscores.

forward_path (default: see postconf -d output)

       The local(8) delivery agent search list for finding a .forward file with user-specified delivery methods.
       The first file that is found is used.

       The forward_path value is not subject to Postfix configuration parameter $name  expansion.  Instead,  the
       following  $name  expansions  are done on forward_path before the search actually happens.  The result of
       $name expansion is filtered with the character set that is specified  with  the  forward_expansion_filter
       parameter.

       $user  The recipient's username.

       $shell The recipient's login shell pathname.

       $home  The recipient's home directory.

       $recipient
              The full recipient address.

       $extension
              The optional recipient address extension.

       $domain
              The recipient domain.

       $local The entire recipient localpart.

       $recipient_delimiter
              The  address extension delimiter that was found in the recipient address (Postfix 2.11 and later),
              or the 'first' delimiter specified with the  system-wide  recipient  address  extension  delimiter
              (Postfix  3.5.22,  3.5.12,  3.7.8, 3.8.3 and later). Historically, this was always the system-wide
              recipient address extension delimiter (Postfix 2.10 and earlier).

       ${name?value}

       ${name?{value}} (Postfix >= 3.0)
              Expands to value when $name is non-empty.

       ${name:value}

       ${name:{value}} (Postfix >= 3.0)
              Expands to value when $name is empty.

       ${name?{value1}:{value2}} (Postfix >= 3.0)
              Expands to value1 when $name is non-empty, value2 otherwise.

       Instead of $name you can also specify ${name} or $(name).

       Examples:

       forward_path = /var/forward/$user
       forward_path =
           /var/forward/$user/.forward$recipient_delimiter$extension,
           /var/forward/$user/.forward

frozen_delivered_to (default: yes)

       Update the local(8) delivery agent's idea of the  Delivered-To:  address  (see  prepend_delivered_header)
       only  once,  at  the start of a delivery attempt; do not update the Delivered-To: address while expanding
       aliases or .forward files.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. With older Postfix releases, the behavior  is  as  if
       this  parameter  is  set to "no". The old setting can be expensive with deeply nested aliases or .forward
       files. When an alias or .forward file changes the Delivered-To: address, it ties up one  queue  file  and
       one cleanup process instance while mail is being forwarded.

hash_queue_depth (default: 1)

       The number of subdirectory levels for queue directories listed with the hash_queue_names parameter. Queue
       hashing  is  implemented  by  creating  one  or  more  levels  of  directories  with one-character names.
       Originally, these directory names were equal to the first characters of the queue  file  name,  with  the
       hexadecimal representation of the file creation time in microseconds.

       With  long  queue  file  names,  queue  hashing  produces  the same results as with short names. The file
       creation time in microseconds is converted into hexadecimal form before the  result  is  used  for  queue
       hashing.   The  base  16  encoding gives finer control over the number of subdirectories than is possible
       with the base 52 encoding of long queue file names.

       After changing the hash_queue_names or hash_queue_depth parameter, execute the command "postfix reload".

hash_queue_names (default: deferred, defer)

       The names of queue directories that are split across multiple subdirectory levels.

       Before Postfix version 2.2, the default list of hashed queues  was  significantly  larger.  Claims  about
       improvements  in  file  system  technology  suggest  that hashing of the incoming and active queues is no
       longer needed. Fewer hashed directories speed up the time needed to restart Postfix.

       After changing the hash_queue_names or hash_queue_depth parameter, execute the command "postfix reload".

header_address_token_limit (default: 10240)

       The maximal number of address tokens are allowed in an address message header. Information  that  exceeds
       the limit is discarded.  The limit is enforced by the cleanup(8) server.

header_checks (default: empty)

       Optional  lookup  tables  for content inspection of primary non-MIME message headers, as specified in the
       header_checks(5) manual page.

header_from_format (default: standard)

       The format of the Postfix-generated From: header. This setting affects  the  appearance  of  'full  name'
       information  when  a local program such as /bin/mail submits a message without a From: header through the
       Postfix sendmail(1) command.

       Specify one of the following:

       standard (default)
              Produce a header formatted as "From: name <address>".  This is the default as of Postfix 3.3.

       obsolete
              Produce a header formatted as "From: address (name)". This is the behavior prior to Postfix 3.3.

       Notes:

       •      Postfix generates the format "From: address" when name information is unavailable or the  envelope
              sender address is empty. This is the same behavior as prior to Postfix 3.3.

       •      In  the  standard form, the name will be quoted if it contains specials as defined in RFC 5322, or
              the "!%" address operators.

       •      The Postfix sendmail(1) command gets name information from the -F command-line  option,  from  the
              NAME environment variable, or from the UNIX password file.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.3 and later.

header_size_limit (default: 102400)

       The maximal amount of memory in bytes for storing a message header.  If a header is larger, the excess is
       discarded.  The limit is enforced by the cleanup(8) server.

helpful_warnings (default: yes)

       Log warnings about problematic configuration settings, and provide helpful suggestions.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

home_mailbox (default: empty)

       Optional pathname of a mailbox file relative to a local(8) user's home directory.

       Specify a pathname ending in "/" for qmail-style delivery.

       The   precedence   of  local(8)  delivery  features  from  high  to  low  is:  aliases,  .forward  files,
       mailbox_transport_maps,   mailbox_transport,   mailbox_command_maps,    mailbox_command,    home_mailbox,
       mail_spool_directory, fallback_transport_maps, fallback_transport and luser_relay.

       Examples:

       home_mailbox = Mailbox
       home_mailbox = Maildir/

hopcount_limit (default: 50)

       The  maximal  number  of  Received:   message  headers  that is allowed in the primary message headers. A
       message that exceeds the limit is bounced, in order to stop a mailer loop.

html_directory (default: see postconf -d output)

       The location of Postfix HTML files that describe how to build, configure or operate  a  specific  Postfix
       subsystem or feature.

ignore_mx_lookup_error (default: no)

       Ignore  DNS MX lookups that produce no response.  By default, the Postfix SMTP client defers delivery and
       tries again after some delay.  This behavior is required by the SMTP standard.

       Specify "ignore_mx_lookup_error = yes" to force a DNS A record lookup instead.  This  violates  the  SMTP
       standard and can result in mis-delivery of mail.

ignore_srv_lookup_error (default: no)

       When  SRV  record  lookup  fails,  fall  back  to MX or IP address lookup as if SRV record lookup was not
       enabled.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.8 and later.

import_environment (default: see postconf -d output)

       The list of environment variables that a privileged Postfix process will import from a non-Postfix parent
       process, or name=value  environment  overrides.   Unprivileged  utilities  will  enforce  the  name=value
       overrides,  but  otherwise  will  not change their process environment.  Examples of relevant environment
       variables:

       TZ     May be needed for sane time keeping on most System-V-ish systems.

       DISPLAY
              Needed for debugging Postfix daemons with an X-windows debugger.

       XAUTHORITY
              Needed for debugging Postfix daemons with an X-windows debugger.

       MAIL_CONFIG
              Needed to make "postfix -c" work.

       POSTLOG_SERVICE
              Needed to make "maillog_file" work during daemon process initialization.

       POSTLOG_HOSTNAME
              Needed to make "maillog_file" work during daemon process initialization.

       Specify a list of names and/or name=value pairs, separated by whitespace or comma. Specify "{  name=value
       }"  to  protect  whitespace or comma in environment variable values (whitespace after the opening "{" and
       before the closing "}" is ignored). The form name=value is supported with Postfix version 2.1 and  later;
       the use of {} is supported with Postfix 3.0 and later.

in_flow_delay (default: 1s)

       Time  to pause before accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the message delivery
       rate. This feature is turned on by default (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due to an SCO bug).

       With the default 100 Postfix SMTP server process limit, "in_flow_delay = 1s" limits the  mail  inflow  to
       100 messages per second above the number of messages delivered per second.

       Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.

inet_interfaces (default: all)

       The  local  network  interface addresses that this mail system receives mail on. Specify "all" to receive
       mail on all network interfaces (default),  and  "loopback-only"  to  receive  mail  on  loopback  network
       interfaces  only  (Postfix  version  2.2  and  later).   The  parameter also controls delivery of mail to
       user@[ip.address].

       Note 1: you need to stop and start Postfix when this parameter changes.

       Note 2: address information may be enclosed inside [], but this form is not required here.

       When inet_interfaces specifies just one IPv4 and/or IPv6 address that is  not  a  loopback  address,  the
       Postfix SMTP client will use this address as the IP source address for outbound mail. Support for IPv6 is
       available in Postfix version 2.2 and later.

       On  a  multi-homed  firewall  with  separate  Postfix  instances  listening on the "inside" and "outside"
       interfaces, this can prevent each instance from being able to reach remote SMTP  servers  on  the  "other
       side"  of  the  firewall. Setting smtp_bind_address to 0.0.0.0 avoids the potential problem for IPv4, and
       setting smtp_bind_address6 to :: solves the problem for IPv6.

       A better solution for multi-homed firewalls is to leave inet_interfaces at the default value and  instead
       use  explicit  IP  addresses  in  the master.cf SMTP server definitions.  This preserves the Postfix SMTP
       client's loop detection, by ensuring that each side of the firewall knows that the other  IP  address  is
       still  the  same  host. Setting $inet_interfaces to a single IPv4 and/or IPV6 address is primarily useful
       with virtual hosting of domains on secondary IP addresses, when each IP address serves a different domain
       (and has a different $myhostname setting).

       See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that are forwarded to Postfix by way of  a
       proxy or address translator.

       Examples:

       inet_interfaces = all (DEFAULT)
       inet_interfaces = loopback-only (Postfix version 2.2 and later)
       inet_interfaces = 127.0.0.1
       inet_interfaces = 127.0.0.1, [::1] (Postfix version 2.2 and later)
       inet_interfaces = 192.168.1.2, 127.0.0.1

inet_protocols (default: see 'postconf -d output')

       The  Internet  protocols Postfix will attempt to use when making or accepting connections. Specify one or
       more of "ipv4" or "ipv6", separated by whitespace or commas. The form "all" is equivalent to "ipv4, ipv6"
       or "ipv4", depending on whether the operating system implements IPv6.

       With Postfix 2.8 and earlier the default is "ipv4". For backwards compatibility with these releases,  the
       Postfix  2.9  and  later upgrade procedure appends an explicit "inet_protocols = ipv4" setting to main.cf
       when no explicit setting is present. This compatibility workaround will be phased out as IPv6  deployment
       becomes more common.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

       Note: you MUST stop and start Postfix after changing this parameter.

       On  systems  that  pre-date  IPV6_V6ONLY  support  (RFC  3493),  an  IPv6  server  will  also accept IPv4
       connections, even when IPv4 is turned off with the inet_protocols parameter.  On systems with IPV6_V6ONLY
       support, Postfix will use separate  server  sockets  for  IPv6  and  IPv4,  and  each  will  accept  only
       connections for the corresponding protocol.

       When  IPv4  support is enabled via the inet_protocols parameter, Postfix will look up DNS type A records,
       and will convert IPv4-in-IPv6 client IP addresses (::ffff:1.2.3.4) to their original IPv4 form (1.2.3.4).
       The latter is needed on hosts that pre-date IPV6_V6ONLY support (RFC 3493).

       When IPv6 support is enabled via the inet_protocols parameter, Postfix  will  do  DNS  type  AAAA  record
       lookups.

       When  both  IPv4  and  IPv6  support  are  enabled,  the  Postfix SMTP client will choose the protocol as
       specified with the smtp_address_preference parameter. Postfix versions before 2.8 attempt to connect  via
       IPv6 before attempting to use IPv4.

       Examples:

       inet_protocols = ipv4
       inet_protocols = all (DEFAULT)
       inet_protocols = ipv6
       inet_protocols = ipv4, ipv6

info_log_address_format (default: external)

       The  email  address  form that will be used in non-debug logging (info, warning, etc.). As of Postfix 3.5
       when an address localpart contains spaces or other special characters, the localpart will be quoted,  for
       example:

               from=<"name with spaces"@example.com>

       Older Postfix versions would log the internal (unquoted) form:

               from=<name with spaces@example.com>

       The  external  and  internal forms are identical for the vast majority of email addresses that contain no
       spaces or other special characters in the localpart.

       The logging in external form is consistent with the address form that Postfix 3.2 and  later  prefer  for
       most table lookups. This is therefore the more useful form for non-debug logging.

       Specify "info_log_address_format = internal" for backwards compatibility.

       Postfix  uses the unquoted form internally, because an attacker can specify an email address in different
       forms by playing games with quotes and backslashes. An attacker should not be able to use such  games  to
       circumvent Postfix access policies.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.5 and later.

initial_destination_concurrency (default: 5)

       The  initial  per-destination  concurrency  level  for  parallel  delivery to the same destination.  With
       per-destination recipient limit > 1, a destination is a domain, otherwise it is a recipient.

       Use transport_initial_destination_concurrency to specify a transport-specific override,  where  transport
       is the master.cf name of the message delivery transport (Postfix 2.5 and later).

       Warning: with concurrency of 1, one bad message can be enough to block all mail to a site.

internal_mail_filter_classes (default: empty)

       What   categories   of   Postfix-generated  mail  are  subject  to  before-queue  content  inspection  by
       non_smtpd_milters, header_checks and body_checks.  Specify zero or more of the  following,  separated  by
       whitespace or comma.

       bounce Inspect the content of delivery status notifications.

       notify Inspect the content of postmaster notifications by the smtp(8) and smtpd(8) processes.

       NOTE:  It's generally not safe to enable content inspection of Postfix-generated email messages. The user
       is warned.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

invalid_hostname_reject_code (default: 501)

       The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when  the  client  HELO  or  EHLO  command  parameter  is
       rejected by the reject_invalid_helo_hostname restriction.

       Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of RFC 5321.

ipc_idle (default: version dependent)

       The  time  after  which  a client closes an idle internal communication channel.  The purpose is to allow
       Postfix daemon processes to terminate voluntarily after they become idle. This is used, for  example,  by
       the Postfix address resolving and rewriting clients.

       With Postfix 2.4 the default value was reduced from 100s to 5s.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

ipc_timeout (default: 3600s)

       The time limit for sending or receiving information over an internal communication channel.  The  purpose
       is  to  break  out of deadlock situations. If the time limit is exceeded the software aborts with a fatal
       error.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

ipc_ttl (default: 1000s)

       The  time  after which a client closes an active internal communication channel.  The purpose is to allow
       Postfix daemon processes to terminate voluntarily after reaching their client limit.  This is  used,  for
       example, by the Postfix address resolving and rewriting clients.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

known_tcp_ports (default: lmtp=24, smtp=25, smtps=submissions=465, submission=587)

       Optional setting that avoids lookups in the  services(5)  database.   This  feature  was  implemented  to
       address inconsistencies in the name of the port "465" service. The ABNF is:

           known_tcp_ports = empty | name-to-port *("," name-to-port)
           name-to-port = 1*(service-name "=') port-number

       The comma is required. Whitespace is optional but it cannot appear inside a service name or port number.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.6 and later.

line_length_limit (default: 2048)

       Upon  input,  long lines are chopped up into pieces of at most this length; upon delivery, long lines are
       reconstructed.

lmdb_map_size (default: 16777216)

       The initial OpenLDAP LMDB database size limit in bytes.  Each time a  database  becomes  full,  its  size
       limit is doubled.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.11 and later.

lmtp_address_preference (default: ipv6)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_address_preference configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

lmtp_address_verify_target (default: rcpt)

       The  LMTP-specific  version  of  the  smtp_address_verify_target  configuration parameter.  See there for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

lmtp_assume_final (default: no)

       When a remote LMTP server announces no DSN support, assume that the server performs final  delivery,  and
       send  "delivered"  delivery  status  notifications instead of "relayed". The default setting is backwards
       compatible to avoid the infinitesimal possibility of breaking existing LMTP-based content filters.

lmtp_balance_inet_protocols (default: yes)

       The LMTP-specific version of the  smtp_balance_inet_protocols  configuration  parameter.  See  there  for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.3 and later.

lmtp_bind_address (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_bind_address configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_bind_address6 (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_bind_address6 configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_bind_address_enforce (default: empty)

       The  LMTP-specific  version  of  the  smtp_bind_address_enforce  configuration  parameter.  See there for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.7 and later.

lmtp_body_checks (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_body_checks configuration parameter. See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

lmtp_cache_connection (default: yes)

       Keep Postfix LMTP client connections open for up to $max_idle seconds. When the LMTP  client  receives  a
       request for the same connection the connection is reused.

       This  parameter is available in Postfix version 2.2 and earlier.  With Postfix version 2.3 and later, see
       lmtp_connection_cache_on_demand, lmtp_connection_cache_destinations, or lmtp_connection_reuse_time_limit.

       The effectiveness of cached connections will be determined by the number of remote LMTP servers  in  use,
       and  the concurrency limit specified for the Postfix LMTP client. Cached connections are closed under any
       of the following conditions:

       •      The Postfix LMTP client idle time limit is reached.  This limit  is  specified  with  the  Postfix
              max_idle configuration parameter.

       •      A delivery request specifies a different destination than the one currently cached.

       •      The per-process limit on the number of delivery requests is reached.  This limit is specified with
              the Postfix max_use configuration parameter.

       •      Upon  the  onset  of  another delivery request, the remote LMTP server associated with the current
              session does not respond to the RSET command.

       Most of these limitations have been with the Postfix connection cache that is shared among multiple  LMTP
       client programs.

lmtp_cname_overrides_servername (default: yes)

       The  LMTP-specific version of the smtp_cname_overrides_servername configuration parameter.  See there for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_connect_timeout (default: 0s)

       The Postfix LMTP client time limit for completing a TCP connection, or zero  (use  the  operating  system
       built-in time limit).  When no connection can be made within the deadline, the LMTP client tries the next
       address on the mail exchanger list.

       Specify  a  non-negative  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies
       the time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default  time
       unit is s (seconds).

       Example:

       lmtp_connect_timeout = 30s

lmtp_connection_cache_destinations (default: empty)

       The  LMTP-specific  version of the smtp_connection_cache_destinations configuration parameter.  See there
       for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_connection_cache_on_demand (default: yes)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_connection_cache_on_demand configuration parameter.  See there  for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_connection_cache_time_limit (default: 2s)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_connection_cache_time_limit configuration parameter.  See there for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_connection_reuse_count_limit (default: 0)

       The  LMTP-specific  version  of the smtp_connection_reuse_count_limit configuration parameter.  See there
       for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.11 and later.

lmtp_connection_reuse_time_limit (default: 300s)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_connection_reuse_time_limit configuration parameter.  See there for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_data_done_timeout (default: 600s)

       The Postfix LMTP client time limit for sending the LMTP ".", and for receiving  the  remote  LMTP  server
       response.   When  no  response  is received within the deadline, a warning is logged that the mail may be
       delivered multiple times.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

lmtp_data_init_timeout (default: 120s)

       The  Postfix  LMTP client time limit for sending the LMTP DATA command, and for receiving the remote LMTP
       server response.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

lmtp_data_xfer_timeout (default: 180s)

       The  Postfix LMTP client time limit for sending the LMTP message content.  When the connection stalls for
       more than $lmtp_data_xfer_timeout the LMTP client terminates the transfer.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

lmtp_defer_if_no_mx_address_found (default: no)

       The  LMTP-specific  version  of the smtp_defer_if_no_mx_address_found configuration parameter.  See there
       for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_delivery_status_filter (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_delivery_status_filter  configuration  parameter.   See  there  for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

lmtp_destination_concurrency_limit (default: $default_destination_concurrency_limit)

       The  maximal  number  of  parallel  deliveries  to  the  same  destination  via the lmtp message delivery
       transport. This limit is enforced by the queue manager. The message delivery transport name is the  first
       field in the entry in the master.cf file.

lmtp_destination_recipient_limit (default: $default_destination_recipient_limit)

       The  maximal  number  of  recipients  per  message for the lmtp message delivery transport. This limit is
       enforced by the queue manager. The message delivery transport name is the first field in the entry in the
       master.cf file.

       Setting this parameter to a value of 1 changes the  meaning  of  lmtp_destination_concurrency_limit  from
       concurrency per domain into concurrency per recipient.

lmtp_discard_lhlo_keyword_address_maps (default: empty)

       Lookup  tables,  indexed  by the remote LMTP server address, with case insensitive lists of LHLO keywords
       (pipelining, starttls, auth, etc.) that the Postfix LMTP client will ignore in the LHLO response  from  a
       remote  LMTP server. See lmtp_discard_lhlo_keywords for details. The table is not indexed by hostname for
       consistency with smtpd_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_discard_lhlo_keywords (default: empty)

       A case insensitive list of LHLO keywords (pipelining, starttls, auth, etc.) that the Postfix LMTP  client
       will ignore in the LHLO response from a remote LMTP server.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

       Notes:

       •      Specify the silent-discard pseudo keyword to prevent this action from being logged.

       •      Use the lmtp_discard_lhlo_keyword_address_maps feature to discard LHLO keywords selectively.

lmtp_dns_reply_filter (default: empty)

       Optional  filter  for  Postfix  LMTP  client  DNS  lookup results.  See smtp_dns_reply_filter for details
       including an example.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

lmtp_dns_resolver_options (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of  the  smtp_dns_resolver_options  configuration  parameter.   See  there  for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

lmtp_dns_support_level (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_dns_support_level configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.11 and later.

lmtp_enforce_tls (default: no)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_enforce_tls configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_fallback_relay (default: empty)

       Optional  list  of  relay  hosts  for  LMTP destinations that can't be found or that are unreachable.  In
       main.cf elements are separated by whitespace or commas.

       By default, mail is returned to the sender when a destination is not found, and delivery is deferred when
       a destination is unreachable.

       The fallback relays must be TCP destinations, specified without a leading "inet:" prefix.  Specify a host
       or host:port.  Since MX lookups do not apply with  LMTP,  there  is  no  need  to  use  the  "[host]"  or
       "[host]:port"  forms.   If you specify multiple LMTP destinations, Postfix will try them in the specified
       order.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.1 and later.

lmtp_generic_maps (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_generic_maps configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_header_checks (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_header_checks configuration parameter. See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

lmtp_host_lookup (default: dns)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_host_lookup configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_lhlo_name (default: $myhostname)

       The hostname to send in the LMTP LHLO command.

       The default value is the machine hostname.  Specify a hostname or [ip.add.re.ss] or [ip:v6:add:re::ss].

       This information can be specified in the main.cf file for all LMTP clients, or it can be specified in the
       master.cf file for a specific client, for example:

           /etc/postfix/master.cf:
               mylmtp ... lmtp -o lmtp_lhlo_name=foo.bar.com

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_lhlo_timeout (default: 300s)

       The Postfix LMTP client time limit for sending the LHLO command, and for  receiving  the  initial  remote
       LMTP server response.

       Time  units:  s  (seconds),  m  (minutes),  h  (hours),  d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit is s
       (seconds).

lmtp_line_length_limit (default: 998)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_line_length_limit configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_mail_timeout (default: 300s)

       The Postfix LMTP client time limit for sending the MAIL FROM command, and for receiving the  remote  LMTP
       server response.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

lmtp_mime_header_checks (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_mime_header_checks configuration parameter. See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

lmtp_min_data_rate (default: 500)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_min_data_rate configuration parameter. See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.7 and later.

lmtp_mx_address_limit (default: 5)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_mx_address_limit configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_mx_session_limit (default: 2)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_mx_session_limit configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_nested_header_checks (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version  of  the  smtp_nested_header_checks  configuration  parameter.  See  there  for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

lmtp_per_record_deadline (default: no)

       The  LMTP-specific  version  of  the  smtp_per_record_deadline  configuration  parameter.   See there for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.9 and later.

lmtp_per_request_deadline (default: no)

       The LMTP-specific version  of  the  smtp_per_request_deadline  configuration  parameter.  See  there  for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.7 and later.

lmtp_pix_workaround_delay_time (default: 10s)

       The  LMTP-specific  version of the smtp_pix_workaround_delay_time configuration parameter.  See there for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_pix_workaround_maps (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version  of  the  smtp_pix_workaround_maps  configuration  parameter.   See  there  for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.4 and later.

lmtp_pix_workaround_threshold_time (default: 500s)

       The  LMTP-specific  version of the smtp_pix_workaround_threshold_time configuration parameter.  See there
       for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_pix_workarounds (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_pix_workaround configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.4 and later.

lmtp_quit_timeout (default: 300s)

       The Postfix LMTP client time limit for sending the QUIT command, and for receiving the remote LMTP server
       response.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

lmtp_quote_rfc821_envelope (default: yes)

       The  LMTP-specific  version  of  the  smtp_quote_rfc821_envelope  configuration parameter.  See there for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_randomize_addresses (default: yes)

       The LMTP-specific version  of  the  smtp_randomize_addresses  configuration  parameter.   See  there  for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_rcpt_timeout (default: 300s)

       The  Postfix  LMTP  client  time limit for sending the RCPT TO command, and for receiving the remote LMTP
       server response.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

lmtp_reply_filter (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_reply_filter configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7 and later.

lmtp_rset_timeout (default: 20s)

       The Postfix LMTP client time limit for sending the RSET command, and for receiving the remote LMTP server
       response.  The  LMTP  client sends RSET in order to finish a recipient address probe, or to verify that a
       cached connection is still alive.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

lmtp_sasl_auth_cache_name (default: empty)

       The  LMTP-specific  version  of  the  smtp_sasl_auth_cache_name  configuration  parameter.  See there for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

lmtp_sasl_auth_cache_time (default: 90d)

       The LMTP-specific version of  the  smtp_sasl_auth_cache_time  configuration  parameter.   See  there  for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

lmtp_sasl_auth_enable (default: no)

       Enable SASL authentication in the Postfix LMTP client.

lmtp_sasl_auth_soft_bounce (default: yes)

       The  LMTP-specific  version  of  the  smtp_sasl_auth_soft_bounce  configuration parameter.  See there for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

lmtp_sasl_mechanism_filter (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the  smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter  configuration  parameter.   See  there  for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_sasl_password_maps (default: empty)

       Optional  Postfix  LMTP  client  lookup tables with one username:password entry per host or domain.  If a
       remote host or domain has no username:password entry, then the Postfix LMTP client will  not  attempt  to
       authenticate to the remote host.

lmtp_sasl_path (default: empty)

       Implementation-specific  information  that  is  passed through to the SASL plug-in implementation that is
       selected with lmtp_sasl_type.  Typically this specifies the name of a configuration  file  or  rendezvous
       point.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_sasl_security_options (default: noplaintext, noanonymous)

       SASL  security  options;  as  of  Postfix  2.3  the list of available features depends on the SASL client
       implementation that is selected with lmtp_sasl_type.

       The following security features are defined for the cyrus client SASL implementation:

       noplaintext
              Disallow authentication methods that use plaintext passwords.

       noactive
              Disallow authentication methods that are vulnerable to non-dictionary active attacks.

       nodictionary
              Disallow authentication methods that are vulnerable to passive dictionary attacks.

       noanonymous
              Disallow anonymous logins.

       Example:

       lmtp_sasl_security_options = noplaintext

lmtp_sasl_tls_security_options (default: $lmtp_sasl_security_options)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_sasl_tls_security_options configuration parameter.  See  there  for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_sasl_tls_verified_security_options (default: $lmtp_sasl_tls_security_options)

       The  LMTP-specific  version  of the smtp_sasl_tls_verified_security_options configuration parameter.  See
       there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_sasl_type (default: cyrus)

       The SASL plug-in type that the Postfix LMTP client should use for authentication.   The  available  types
       are listed with the "postconf -A" command.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_send_dummy_mail_auth (default: no)

       The  LMTP-specific  version  of  the  smtp_send_dummy_mail_auth  configuration  parameter.  See there for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.9 and later.

lmtp_send_xforward_command (default: no)

       Send an XFORWARD command to the remote LMTP server when the LMTP LHLO server response announces  XFORWARD
       support.   This  allows  an lmtp(8) delivery agent, used for content filter message injection, to forward
       the name, address, protocol and HELO name of the original client to the  content  filter  and  downstream
       LMTP  server.   Before  you  change  the  value  to yes, it is best to make sure that your content filter
       supports this command.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

lmtp_sender_dependent_authentication (default: no)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_sender_dependent_authentication configuration parameter.  See there
       for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_skip_5xx_greeting (default: yes)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_skip_5xx_greeting configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_skip_quit_response (default: no)

       Wait for the response to the LMTP QUIT command.

lmtp_starttls_timeout (default: 300s)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_starttls_timeout configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tcp_port (default: 24)

       The default TCP port that the Postfix LMTP client connects to.  Specify a symbolic name (see services(5))
       or a numeric port.

lmtp_tls_CAfile (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_CAfile configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_CApath (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_CApath configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_block_early_mail_reply (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_block_early_mail_reply configuration parameter.  See there  for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7 and later.

lmtp_tls_cert_file (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_cert_file configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_chain_files (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_chain_files configuration parameter. See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

lmtp_tls_ciphers (default: medium)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_ciphers configuration parameter. See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

lmtp_tls_connection_reuse (default: no)

       The  LMTP-specific  version  of  the  smtp_tls_connection_reuse  configuration  parameter.  See there for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

lmtp_tls_dcert_file (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_dcert_file configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_dkey_file (default: $lmtp_tls_dcert_file)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_dkey_file configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_eccert_file (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_eccert_file configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later, when Postfix is  compiled  and  linked  with  OpenSSL
       1.0.0 or later.

lmtp_tls_eckey_file (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_eckey_file configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This  feature  is  available  in  Postfix 2.6 and later, when Postfix is compiled and linked with OpenSSL
       1.0.0 or later.

lmtp_tls_enforce_peername (default: yes)

       The LMTP-specific version of  the  smtp_tls_enforce_peername  configuration  parameter.   See  there  for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_exclude_ciphers (default: empty)

       The  LMTP-specific  version  of  the  smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers  configuration  parameter.   See there for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_fingerprint_cert_match (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_fingerprint_cert_match configuration parameter.  See there  for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

lmtp_tls_fingerprint_digest (default: see postconf -d output)

       The  LMTP-specific  version  of  the  smtp_tls_fingerprint_digest configuration parameter.  See there for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

lmtp_tls_force_insecure_host_tlsa_lookup (default: no)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_force_insecure_host_tlsa_lookup configuration  parameter.   See
       there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.11 and later.

lmtp_tls_key_file (default: $lmtp_tls_cert_file)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_key_file configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_loglevel (default: 0)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_loglevel configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers (default: medium)

       The  LMTP-specific  version  of  the  smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers  configuration parameter.  See there for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers configuration parameter.   See  there
       for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_mandatory_protocols (default: see postconf -d output)

       The  LMTP-specific  version  of  the  smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols configuration parameter. See there for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_note_starttls_offer (default: no)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_note_starttls_offer configuration  parameter.   See  there  for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_per_site (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_per_site configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_policy_maps (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_policy_maps configuration parameter. See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_protocols (default: see postconf -d output)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_protocols configuration parameter. See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

lmtp_tls_scert_verifydepth (default: 9)

       The  LMTP-specific  version  of  the  smtp_tls_scert_verifydepth  configuration parameter.  See there for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_secure_cert_match (default: nexthop)

       The LMTP-specific version of  the  smtp_tls_secure_cert_match  configuration  parameter.  See  there  for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_security_level (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_security_level configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_servername (default: empty)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_servername configuration parameter. See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

lmtp_tls_session_cache_database (default: empty)

       The  LMTP-specific  version of the smtp_tls_session_cache_database configuration parameter. See there for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_session_cache_timeout (default: 3600s)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_session_cache_timeout configuration parameter.  See  there  for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_trust_anchor_file (default: empty)

       The  LMTP-specific  version  of  the  smtp_tls_trust_anchor_file  configuration parameter.  See there for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.11 and later.

lmtp_tls_verify_cert_match (default: hostname)

       The LMTP-specific version of  the  smtp_tls_verify_cert_match  configuration  parameter.  See  there  for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_wrappermode (default: no)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_wrappermode configuration parameter. See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

lmtp_use_tls (default: no)

       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_use_tls configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_xforward_timeout (default: 300s)

       The  Postfix  LMTP  client time limit for sending the XFORWARD command, and for receiving the remote LMTP
       server response.

       In case of problems the client does NOT try the next address on the mail exchanger list.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

local_command_shell (default: empty)

       Optional  shell  program for local(8) delivery to non-Postfix commands.  By default, non-Postfix commands
       are executed directly; commands are given to the  default  shell  (typically,  /bin/sh)  only  when  they
       contain shell meta characters or shell built-in commands.

       "sendmail's restricted shell" (smrsh) is what most people will use in order to restrict what programs can
       be run from e.g. .forward files (smrsh is part of the Sendmail distribution).

       Note:  when  a shell program is specified, it is invoked even when the command contains no shell built-in
       commands or meta characters.

       Example:

       local_command_shell = /some/where/smrsh -c
       local_command_shell = /bin/bash -c

local_delivery_status_filter (default: $default_delivery_status_filter)

       Optional filter for the local(8) delivery agent  to  change  the  status  code  or  explanatory  text  of
       successful or unsuccessful deliveries.  See default_delivery_status_filter for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

local_destination_concurrency_limit (default: 2)

       The  maximal  number  of  parallel deliveries via the local mail delivery transport to the same recipient
       (when "local_destination_recipient_limit = 1") or the maximal number of parallel deliveries to  the  same
       local domain (when "local_destination_recipient_limit > 1"). This limit is enforced by the queue manager.
       The message delivery transport name is the first field in the entry in the master.cf file.

       A  low  limit of 2 is recommended, just in case someone has an expensive shell command in a .forward file
       or in an alias (e.g., a mailing list manager).  You don't want to run lots of those at the same time.

local_destination_recipient_limit (default: 1)

       The maximal number of recipients per message delivery via the local mail delivery transport.  This  limit
       is  enforced by the queue manager. The message delivery transport name is the first field in the entry in
       the master.cf file.

       Setting this parameter to a value > 1 changes the  meaning  of  local_destination_concurrency_limit  from
       concurrency per recipient into concurrency per domain.

local_header_rewrite_clients (default: permit_inet_interfaces)

       Rewrite  or add message headers in mail from these clients, updating incomplete addresses with the domain
       name in $myorigin or $mydomain, and adding missing headers.

       See the append_at_myorigin and append_dot_mydomain  parameters  for  details  of  how  domain  names  are
       appended to incomplete addresses.

       See remote_header_rewrite_domain to optionally rewrite or add message headers in mail from other clients.

       Specify a list of zero or more of the following:

       permit_inet_interfaces
              Append   the   domain  name  in  $myorigin  or  $mydomain  when  the  client  IP  address  matches
              $inet_interfaces. This is enabled by default.

       permit_mynetworks
              Append the domain name in $myorigin or $mydomain when the client IP address matches any network or
              network address listed in $mynetworks. This setting will not prevent remote  mail  header  address
              rewriting when mail from a remote client is forwarded by a neighboring system.

       permit_sasl_authenticated
              Append the domain name in $myorigin or $mydomain when the client is successfully authenticated via
              the RFC 4954 (AUTH) protocol.

       permit_tls_clientcerts
              Append  the  domain  name  in  $myorigin  or $mydomain when the remote SMTP client TLS certificate
              fingerprint or public key fingerprint (Postfix 2.9 and later)  is  listed  in  $relay_clientcerts.
              The  fingerprint  digest  algorithm is configurable via the smtpd_tls_fingerprint_digest parameter
              (hard-coded as md5 prior to Postfix version 2.5).
              The default algorithm is sha256 with Postfix >= 3.6 and the  compatibility_level  set  to  3.6  or
              higher.  With  Postfix  <=  3.5, the default algorithm is md5.  The best-practice algorithm is now
              sha256. Recent advances in hash function cryptanalysis have led to md5 and sha1  being  deprecated
              in favor of sha256.  However, as long as there are no known "second pre-image" attacks against the
              older algorithms, their use in this context, though not recommended, is still likely safe.

       permit_tls_all_clientcerts
              Append  the  domain  name in $myorigin or $mydomain when the remote SMTP client TLS certificate is
              successfully verified, regardless of whether it is listed on the server,  and  regardless  of  the
              certifying authority.

       check_address_map type:table

       type:table
              Append  the domain name in $myorigin or $mydomain when the client IP address matches the specified
              lookup table.  The lookup result is ignored, and no subnet lookup is done. This is  suitable  for,
              e.g., pop-before-smtp lookup tables.

       Examples:

       The  Postfix < 2.2 backwards compatible setting: always rewrite message headers, and always append my own
       domain to incomplete header addresses.

           local_header_rewrite_clients = static:all

       The purist (and default) setting: rewrite headers only in mail from Postfix sendmail  and  in  SMTP  mail
       from this machine.

           local_header_rewrite_clients = permit_inet_interfaces

       The  intermediate  setting:  rewrite  header addresses and append $myorigin or $mydomain information only
       with mail from Postfix sendmail, from local clients, or from authorized SMTP clients.

       Note: this setting will not prevent remote mail header address rewriting when mail from a  remote  client
       is forwarded by a neighboring system.

           local_header_rewrite_clients = permit_mynetworks,
               permit_sasl_authenticated permit_tls_clientcerts
               check_address_map hash:/etc/postfix/pop-before-smtp

local_login_sender_maps (default: static:*)

       A  list  of  lookup  tables  that  are searched by the UNIX login name, and that return a list of allowed
       envelope sender patterns separated by space or comma. These sender patterns are enforced by  the  Postfix
       postdrop(1)  command.  The  default  is  backwards-compatible: every user may specify any sender envelope
       address.

       When no UNIX login name is available, the postdrop(1) command will prepend "uid:" to  the  numerical  UID
       and use that instead.

       This feature ignores address extensions in the user-specified envelope sender address.

       The following sender patterns are special; these cannot be used as part of a longer pattern.

        *     This pattern allows any envelope sender address.

        <>    This     pattern     allows     the     empty     envelope     sender     address.     See     the
              empty_address_local_login_sender_maps_lookup_key configuration parameter.

        @domain
              This pattern allows an envelope sender address when the '@' and domain part match.

       Examples:

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
           # Allow root and postfix full control, anyone else can only
           # send mail as themselves. Use "uid:" followed by the numerical
           # UID when the UID has no entry in the UNIX password file.
           local_login_sender_maps =
               inline:{ { root = * }, { postfix = * } },
               pcre:/etc/postfix/login_senders

       /etc/postfix/login_senders:
          # Allow both the bare username and the user@domain forms.
           /(.+)/ $1 $1@example.com

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.6 and later.

local_recipient_maps (default: proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps)

       Lookup tables with all names or addresses of local recipients: a recipient  address  is  local  when  its
       domain matches $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.  Specify @domain as a wild-card for
       domains  that  do not have a valid recipient list.  Technically, tables listed with $local_recipient_maps
       are used as lists: Postfix needs to know only if a lookup string is found or not, but it does not use the
       result from table lookup.

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma. Tables will be searched
       in the specified order until a match is found.

       If this parameter is non-empty (the default), then the Postfix SMTP server will reject mail  for  unknown
       local users.

       To  turn  off local recipient checking in the Postfix SMTP server, specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e.
       empty).

       The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local delivery agent for local delivery. You
       need to update the local_recipient_maps setting if:

       •      You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.

       •      You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.

       •      You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"  feature  of  the  Postfix
              local(8) delivery agent.

       Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.

       Beware:  if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you need to access the passwd file via the proxymap(8)
       service, in order to overcome chroot access restrictions. The alternative,  maintaining  a  copy  of  the
       system password file in the chroot jail is not practical.

       Examples:

       local_recipient_maps =

local_transport (default: local:$myhostname)

       The  default  mail  delivery transport and next-hop destination for final delivery to domains listed with
       mydestination, and for [ipaddress] destinations that match $inet_interfaces or  $proxy_interfaces.   This
       information can be overruled with the transport(5) table.

       By  default, local mail is delivered to the transport called "local", which is just the name of a service
       that is defined the master.cf file.

       Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is the name of a mail delivery  transport
       defined  in master.cf.  The :nexthop destination is optional; its syntax is documented in the manual page
       of the corresponding delivery agent.

       Beware:  if  you  override  the  default  local  delivery   agent   then   you   need   to   review   the
       LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README document, otherwise the SMTP server may reject mail for local recipients.

luser_relay (default: empty)

       Optional  catch-all destination for unknown local(8) recipients.  By default, mail for unknown recipients
       in domains that match $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces is returned as undeliverable.

       The luser_relay value is not subject to Postfix configuration parameter  $name  expansion.  Instead,  the
       following $name expansions are done:

       $domain
              The recipient domain.

       $extension
              The recipient address extension.

       $home  The recipient's home directory.

       $local The entire recipient address localpart.

       $recipient
              The full recipient address.

       $recipient_delimiter
              The  address extension delimiter that was found in the recipient address (Postfix 2.11 and later),
              or the system-wide recipient address extension delimiter (Postfix 2.10 and earlier).

       $shell The recipient's login shell.

       $user  The recipient username.

       ${name?value}

       ${name?{value}} (Postfix >= 3.0)
              Expands to value when $name is non-empty.

       ${name:value}

       ${name:{value}} (Postfix >= 3.0)
              Expands to value when $name is empty.

       ${name?{value1}:{value2}} (Postfix >= 3.0)
              Expands to value1 when $name is non-empty, value2 otherwise.

       Instead of $name you can also specify ${name} or $(name).

       Note: luser_relay works only for the Postfix local(8) delivery agent.

       Note: if you use this feature for accounts  not  in  the  UNIX  password  file,  then  you  must  specify
       "local_recipient_maps  =" (i.e. empty) in the main.cf file, otherwise the Postfix SMTP server will reject
       mail for non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".

       Examples:

       luser_relay = $user@other.host
       luser_relay = $local@other.host
       luser_relay = admin+$local

mail_name (default: Postfix)

       The mail system name that is displayed in Received: headers, in the SMTP greeting banner, and in  bounced
       mail.

mail_owner (default: postfix)

       The  UNIX system account that owns the Postfix queue and most Postfix daemon processes.  Specify the name
       of an unprivileged user account that does not share a user or group ID with other accounts, and that owns
       no other files or processes on the system.  In particular, don't specify nobody or daemon.  PLEASE USE  A
       DEDICATED USER ID AND GROUP ID.

       When  this  parameter value is changed you need to re-run "postfix set-permissions" (with Postfix version
       2.0 and earlier: "/etc/postfix/post-install set-permissions".

mail_release_date (default: see postconf -d output)

       The Postfix release date, in "YYYYMMDD" format.

mail_spool_directory (default: see postconf -d output)

       The directory where local(8) UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting  depends  on  the  system
       type. Specify a name ending in / for maildir-style delivery.

       Note: maildir delivery is done with the privileges of the recipient.  If you use the mail_spool_directory
       setting  for  maildir  style  delivery,  then you must create the top-level maildir directory in advance.
       Postfix will not create it.

       Examples:

       mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
       mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail

mail_version (default: see postconf -d output)

       The version of the mail system. Stable releases are named major.minor.patchlevel.  Experimental  releases
       also include the release date. The version string can be used in, for example, the SMTP greeting banner.

mailbox_command (default: empty)

       Optional  external command that the local(8) delivery agent should use for mailbox delivery.  The command
       is run with the user ID and the primary  group  ID  privileges  of  the  recipient.   Exception:  command
       delivery  for  root  executes with $default_privs privileges.  This is not a problem, because 1) mail for
       root should always be aliased to a real user and 2) don't log in as root, use "su" instead.

       The following environment variables are exported to the command:

       CLIENT_ADDRESS
              Remote client network address. Available in Postfix version 2.2 and later.

       CLIENT_HELO
              Remote client EHLO command parameter. Available in Postfix version 2.2 and later.

       CLIENT_HOSTNAME
              Remote client hostname. Available in Postfix version 2.2 and later.

       CLIENT_PROTOCOL
              Remote client protocol. Available in Postfix version 2.2 and later.

       DOMAIN The domain part of the recipient address.

       EXTENSION
              The optional address extension.

       HOME   The recipient home directory.

       LOCAL  The recipient address localpart.

       LOGNAME
              The recipient's username.

       ORIGINAL_RECIPIENT
              The entire recipient address, before any address rewriting or aliasing.

       RECIPIENT
              The full recipient address.

       SASL_METHOD
              SASL authentication method specified in the remote  client  AUTH  command.  Available  in  Postfix
              version 2.2 and later.

       SASL_SENDER
              SASL sender address specified in the remote client MAIL FROM command. Available in Postfix version
              2.2 and later.

       SASL_USER
              SASL  username  specified in the remote client AUTH command.  Available in Postfix version 2.2 and
              later.

       SENDER The full sender address.

       SHELL  The recipient's login shell.

       USER   The recipient username.

       Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command parameter is not  subjected  to  $name
       substitutions. This is to make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).

       If  you  can,  avoid  shell  meta  characters  because  they will force Postfix to run an expensive shell
       process. If you're delivering via "procmail" then running a shell won't make a noticeable  difference  in
       the total cost.

       Note:  if  you use the mailbox_command feature to deliver mail system-wide, you must set up an alias that
       forwards mail for root to a real user.

       The  precedence  of  local(8)  delivery  features  from  high  to  low  is:  aliases,   .forward   files,
       mailbox_transport_maps,    mailbox_transport,    mailbox_command_maps,   mailbox_command,   home_mailbox,
       mail_spool_directory, fallback_transport_maps, fallback_transport and luser_relay.

       Examples:

       mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail
       mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
       mailbox_command = /some/where/maildrop -d "$USER"
               -f "$SENDER" "$EXTENSION"

mailbox_command_maps (default: empty)

       Optional lookup tables with per-recipient  external  commands  to  use  for  local(8)  mailbox  delivery.
       Behavior is as with mailbox_command.

       The   precedence   of  local(8)  delivery  features  from  high  to  low  is:  aliases,  .forward  files,
       mailbox_transport_maps,   mailbox_transport,   mailbox_command_maps,    mailbox_command,    home_mailbox,
       mail_spool_directory, fallback_transport_maps, fallback_transport and luser_relay.

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma. Tables will be searched
       in the specified order until a match is found.

mailbox_delivery_lock (default: see postconf -d output)

       How  to  lock  a  UNIX-style  local(8)  mailbox before attempting delivery.  For a list of available file
       locking methods, use the "postconf -l" command.

       This setting is ignored with maildir style delivery, because such deliveries are  safe  without  explicit
       locks.

       Note:  The dotlock method requires that the recipient UID or GID has write access to the parent directory
       of the mailbox file.

       Note: the default setting of this parameter is system dependent.

mailbox_size_limit (default: 51200000)

       The maximal size of any local(8) individual mailbox or maildir file, or zero (no limit).  In  fact,  this
       limits  the  size of any file that is written to upon local delivery, including files written by external
       commands that are executed by the local(8) delivery agent. The value cannot exceed LONG_MAX (typically, a
       32-bit or 64-bit signed integer).

       This limit must not be smaller than the message size limit.

mailbox_transport (default: empty)

       Optional message delivery transport that the local(8) delivery agent should use for mailbox  delivery  to
       all local recipients, whether or not they are found in the UNIX passwd database.

       The   precedence   of  local(8)  delivery  features  from  high  to  low  is:  aliases,  .forward  files,
       mailbox_transport_maps,   mailbox_transport,   mailbox_command_maps,    mailbox_command,    home_mailbox,
       mail_spool_directory, fallback_transport_maps, fallback_transport and luser_relay.

mailbox_transport_maps (default: empty)

       Optional  lookup  tables  with  per-recipient  message  delivery  transports  to use for local(8) mailbox
       delivery, whether or not the recipients are found in the UNIX passwd database.

       The  precedence  of  local(8)  delivery  features  from  high  to  low  is:  aliases,   .forward   files,
       mailbox_transport_maps,    mailbox_transport,    mailbox_command_maps,   mailbox_command,   home_mailbox,
       mail_spool_directory, fallback_transport_maps, fallback_transport and luser_relay.

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma. Tables will be searched
       in the specified order until a match is found.

       For safety reasons, this feature does not allow $number substitutions in regular expression maps.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

maillog_file (default: empty)

       The name of an optional logfile that is written by  the  Postfix  postlogd(8)  service.  An  empty  value
       selects  logging  to  syslogd(8).   Specify  "/dev/stdout"  to  select logging to standard output. Stdout
       logging requires that Postfix is started with "postfix start-fg".

       Note  1:  The  maillog_file  parameter  value  must  contain  a  prefix  that  is  specified   with   the
       maillog_file_prefixes parameter.

       Note  2:  Some  Postfix  non-daemon  programs  may  still log information to syslogd(8), before they have
       processed their configuration parameters and command-line options.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

maillog_file_compressor (default: gzip)

       The program to run after rotating $maillog_file with "postfix logrotate". The command  is  run  with  the
       rotated logfile name as its first argument.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

maillog_file_prefixes (default: /var, /dev/stdout)

       A  list of allowed prefixes for a maillog_file value. This is a safety feature to contain the damage from
       a single configuration mistake. Specify one or more prefix strings, separated by comma or whitespace.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

maillog_file_rotate_suffix (default: %Y%m%d-%H%M%S)

       The format of the suffix to append to $maillog_file while rotating the file with "postfix logrotate". See
       strftime(3) for syntax. The default suffix, YYYYMMDD-HHMMSS, allows logs to be rotated frequently.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

mailq_path (default: see postconf -d output)

       Sendmail compatibility feature that specifies where the  Postfix  mailq(1)  command  is  installed.  This
       command can be used to list the Postfix mail queue.

manpage_directory (default: see postconf -d output)

       Where the Postfix manual pages are installed.

maps_rbl_domains (default: empty)

       Obsolete feature: use the reject_rbl_client feature instead.

maps_rbl_reject_code (default: 554)

       The  numerical  Postfix  SMTP  server  response  code when a remote SMTP client request is blocked by the
       reject_rbl_client,    reject_rhsbl_client,    reject_rhsbl_reverse_client,     reject_rhsbl_sender     or
       reject_rhsbl_recipient restriction.

       Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of RFC 5321.

masquerade_classes (default: envelope_sender, header_sender, header_recipient)

       What addresses are subject to address masquerading.

       By default, address masquerading is limited to envelope sender addresses, and to header sender and header
       recipient  addresses.   This  allows  you to use address masquerading on a mail gateway while still being
       able to forward mail to users on individual machines.

       Specify zero or more of: envelope_sender, envelope_recipient, header_sender, header_recipient

masquerade_domains (default: empty)

       Optional list of domains whose subdomain structure will be stripped off in email addresses.

       The list is processed left to right, and processing stops at the first match.  Thus,

           masquerade_domains = foo.example.com example.com

       strips      "user@any.thing.foo.example.com"      to       "user@foo.example.com",       but       strips
       "user@any.thing.else.example.com" to "user@example.com".

       A domain name prefixed with ! means do not masquerade this domain or its subdomains. Thus,

           masquerade_domains = !foo.example.com example.com

       does    not    change    "user@any.thing.foo.example.com"    or    "user@foo.example.com",   but   strips
       "user@any.thing.else.example.com" to "user@example.com".

       Note: with Postfix version 2.2, message header address masquerading  happens  only  when  message  header
       address rewriting is enabled:

       •      The message is received with the Postfix sendmail(1) command,

       •      The message is received from a network client that matches $local_header_rewrite_clients,

       •      The message is received from the network, and the remote_header_rewrite_domain parameter specifies
              a non-empty value.

       To get the behavior before Postfix version 2.2, specify "local_header_rewrite_clients = static:all".

       Example:

       masquerade_domains = $mydomain

masquerade_exceptions (default: empty)

       Optional  list  of  user  names that are not subjected to address masquerading, even when their addresses
       match $masquerade_domains.

       By default, address masquerading makes no exceptions.

       Specify a list of  user  names,  "/file/name"  or  "type:table"  patterns,  separated  by  commas  and/or
       whitespace.  The  list  is matched left to right, and the search stops on the first match. A "/file/name"
       pattern is replaced by its contents; a "type:table" lookup table is matched when a name matches a  lookup
       key  (the  lookup  result  is  ignored).   Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
       Specify "!pattern" to exclude a name from the list. The form "!/file/name" is supported only  in  Postfix
       version 2.4 and later.

       Examples:

       masquerade_exceptions = root, mailer-daemon
       masquerade_exceptions = root

master_service_disable (default: empty)

       Selectively disable master(8) listener ports by service type or by service name and type.  Specify a list
       of  service  types  ("inet",  "unix", "fifo", or "pass") or "name/type" tuples, where "name" is the first
       field of a master.cf entry and "type" is a service type. As with other Postfix matchlists, a search stops
       at the first match.  Specify "!pattern" to exclude a service from the list.  By  default,  all  master(8)
       listener ports are enabled.

       Note:  this feature does not support "/file/name" or "type:table" patterns, nor does it support wildcards
       such as "*" or "all". This is intentional.

       Examples:

       # With Postfix 2.6..2.10 use '.' instead of '/'.
       # Turn on all master(8) listener ports (the default).
       master_service_disable =
       # Turn off only the main SMTP listener port.
       master_service_disable = smtp/inet
       # Turn off all TCP/IP listener ports.
       master_service_disable = inet
       # Turn off all TCP/IP listener ports except "foo".
       master_service_disable = !foo/inet, inet

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

max_idle (default: 100s)

       The maximum amount of time that an idle Postfix daemon process waits for an  incoming  connection  before
       terminating  voluntarily.  This parameter is ignored by the Postfix queue manager and by other long-lived
       Postfix daemon processes.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

max_use (default: 100)

       The  maximal number of incoming connections that a Postfix daemon process will service before terminating
       voluntarily.  This parameter is ignored by the Postfix queue manager  and  by  other  long-lived  Postfix
       daemon processes.

maximal_backoff_time (default: 4000s)

       The maximal time between attempts to deliver a deferred message.

       This  parameter  should  be  set  to  a  value  greater  than or equal to $minimal_backoff_time. See also
       $queue_run_delay.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

maximal_queue_lifetime (default: 5d)

       Consider  a  message  as  undeliverable,  when delivery fails with a temporary error, and the time in the
       queue has reached the maximal_queue_lifetime limit.

       Specify a non-negative time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter  suffix  that  specifies
       the  time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time
       unit is d (days).

       Specify 0 when mail delivery should be tried only once.

message_drop_headers (default: bcc, content-length, resent-bcc, return-path)

       Names of message headers that the cleanup(8) daemon  will  remove  after  applying  header_checks(5)  and
       before invoking Milter applications.  The default setting is compatible with Postfix < 3.0.

       Specify  a  list  of  header names, separated by comma or space.  Names are matched in a case-insensitive
       manner.  The list of supported header names is limited only by available memory.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

message_reject_characters (default: empty)

       The set of characters that Postfix will reject in message content.  The usual C-like escape sequences are
       recognized: \a \b \f \n \r \t \v \ddd (up to three octal digits) and \\.

       Note 1: this feature does not recognize text  that  requires  MIME  decoding.  It  inspects  raw  message
       content, just like header_checks and body_checks.

       Note 2: this feature is disabled with "receive_override_options = no_header_body_checks".

       Example:

       message_reject_characters = \0

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

message_size_limit (default: 10240000)

       The maximal size in bytes of a message, including envelope information.  The value cannot exceed LONG_MAX
       (typically, a 32-bit or 64-bit signed integer).

       Note:  be  careful when making changes.  Excessively small values will result in the loss of non-delivery
       notifications, when a bounce message size exceeds the local or remote MTA's message size limit.

message_strip_characters (default: empty)

       The set of characters that Postfix will remove from message content.  The usual C-like  escape  sequences
       are recognized: \a \b \f \n \r \t \v \ddd (up to three octal digits) and \\.

       Note  1:  this  feature  does  not  recognize  text  that requires MIME decoding. It inspects raw message
       content, just like header_checks and body_checks.

       Note 2: this feature is disabled with "receive_override_options = no_header_body_checks".

       Example:

       message_strip_characters = \0

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

meta_directory (default: see 'postconf -d' output)

       The location of  non-executable  files  that  are  shared  among  multiple  Postfix  instances,  such  as
       postfix-files,  dynamicmaps.cf,  and the multi-instance template files main.cf.proto and master.cf.proto.
       This directory should contain only Postfix-related files.  Typically, the  meta_directory  parameter  has
       the same default as the config_directory parameter (/etc/postfix or /usr/local/etc/postfix).

       For backwards compatibility with Postfix versions 2.6..2.11, specify "meta_directory = $daemon_directory"
       in  main.cf before installing or upgrading Postfix, or specify "meta_directory = /path/name" on the "make
       makefiles", "make install" or "make upgrade" command line.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

milter_command_timeout (default: 30s)

       The time limit for sending an SMTP command to a Milter (mail filter) application, and for  receiving  the
       response.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_connect_macros (default: see postconf -d output)

       The macros that are sent to Milter (mail filter) applications after completion of an SMTP connection. See
       MILTER_README for a list of available macro names and their meanings.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_connect_timeout (default: 30s)

       The time limit for connecting to a  Milter  (mail  filter)  application,  and  for  negotiating  protocol
       options.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_content_timeout (default: 300s)

       The time limit for sending message content to a Milter (mail filter) application, and for  receiving  the
       response.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_data_macros (default: see postconf -d output)

       The macros that are sent to version 4 or higher Milter (mail filter) applications  after  the  SMTP  DATA
       command. See MILTER_README for a list of available macro names and their meanings.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_default_action (default: tempfail)

       The  default  action  when  a  Milter  (mail  filter)  response  is unavailable (for example, bad Postfix
       configuration or Milter failure). Specify one of the following:

       accept Proceed as if the mail filter was not present.

       reject Reject all further commands in this session with a permanent status code.

       tempfail
              Reject all further commands in this session with a temporary status code.

       quarantine
              Like "accept", but freeze the message in the "hold" queue. Available with Postfix 2.6 and later.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_end_of_data_macros (default: see postconf -d output)

       The macros that are sent to  Milter  (mail  filter)  applications  after  the  message  end-of-data.  See
       MILTER_README for a list of available macro names and their meanings.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_end_of_header_macros (default: see postconf -d output)

       The  macros  that  are sent to Milter (mail filter) applications after the end of the message header. See
       MILTER_README for a list of available macro names and their meanings.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

milter_header_checks (default: empty)

       Optional  lookup  tables  for  content  inspection  of  message  headers  that  are  produced  by  Milter
       applications.   See  the  header_checks(5)  manual  page  available  actions.  Currently,  PREPEND is not
       implemented.

       The following example sends all mail that is marked as SPAM to a spam handling machine. Note that matches
       are case-insensitive by default.

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
           milter_header_checks = pcre:/etc/postfix/milter_header_checks

       /etc/postfix/milter_header_checks:
           /^X-SPAM-FLAG:\s+YES/ FILTER mysmtp:sanitizer.example.com:25

       The milter_header_checks mechanism could also be used for allowlisting. For example it could be  used  to
       skip heavy content inspection for DKIM-signed mail from known friendly domains.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7, and as an optional patch for Postfix 2.6.

milter_helo_macros (default: see postconf -d output)

       The  macros  that  are sent to Milter (mail filter) applications after the SMTP HELO or EHLO command. See
       MILTER_README for a list of available macro names and their meanings.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_macro_daemon_name (default: $myhostname)

       The {daemon_name} macro value for Milter (mail filter) applications.  See MILTER_README  for  a  list  of
       available macro names and their meanings.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_macro_defaults (default: empty)

       Optional  list of name=value pairs that specify default values for arbitrary macros that Postfix may send
       to Milter applications.  These defaults are used when there is  no  corresponding  information  from  the
       message delivery context.

       Specify name=value or {name=value} pairs separated by comma or whitespace.  Enclose a pair in "{}" when a
       value contains comma or whitespace (this form ignores whitespace after the enclosing "{", around the "=",
       and before the enclosing "}").

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.1 and later.

milter_macro_v (default: $mail_name $mail_version)

       The  {v}  macro  value  for Milter (mail filter) applications.  See MILTER_README for a list of available
       macro names and their meanings.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_mail_macros (default: see postconf -d output)

       The macros that are sent to Milter (mail filter) applications after  the  SMTP  MAIL  FROM  command.  See
       MILTER_README for a list of available macro names and their meanings.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_protocol (default: 6)

       The  mail  filter  protocol  version  and  optional  protocol  extensions for communication with a Milter
       application; prior to Postfix 2.6 the default protocol is 2. Postfix sends this version number during the
       initial protocol handshake.  It should match the version number that  is  expected  by  the  mail  filter
       application (or by its Milter library).

       Protocol versions:

       2      Use  Sendmail  8  mail  filter  protocol version 2 (default with Sendmail version 8.11 .. 8.13 and
              Postfix version 2.3 ..  2.5).

       3      Use Sendmail 8 mail filter protocol version 3.

       4      Use Sendmail 8 mail filter protocol version 4.

       6      Use Sendmail 8 mail filter protocol version 6 (default with  Sendmail  version  8.14  and  Postfix
              version 2.6).

       Protocol extensions:

       no_header_reply
              Specify this when the Milter application will not reply for each individual message header.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_rcpt_macros (default: see postconf -d output)

       The  macros  that  are  sent  to  Milter  (mail  filter) applications after the SMTP RCPT TO command. See
       MILTER_README for a list of available macro names and their meanings.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_unknown_command_macros (default: see postconf -d output)

       The macros that are sent to version 3 or higher Milter (mail filter) applications after an  unknown  SMTP
       command.  See MILTER_README for a list of available macro names and their meanings.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

mime_boundary_length_limit (default: 2048)

       The  maximal  length  of  MIME  multipart  boundary  strings. The MIME processor is unable to distinguish
       between boundary strings that do not differ in the first $mime_boundary_length_limit characters.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

mime_header_checks (default: $header_checks)

       Optional lookup tables for content inspection of MIME  related  message  headers,  as  described  in  the
       header_checks(5) manual page.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

mime_nesting_limit (default: 100)

       The  maximal  recursion  level  that the MIME processor will handle.  Postfix refuses mail that is nested
       deeper than the specified limit.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

minimal_backoff_time (default: 300s)

       The minimal time between attempts to deliver a deferred message; prior to Postfix 2.4 the  default  value
       was 1000s.

       This  parameter  also  limits  the  time an unreachable destination is kept in the short-term, in-memory,
       destination status cache.

       This parameter should be set greater than or equal to $queue_run_delay. See also $maximal_backoff_time.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

multi_instance_directories (default: empty)

       An optional list of non-default Postfix configuration directories; these directories belong to additional
       Postfix  instances  that  share  the  Postfix executable files and documentation with the default Postfix
       instance, and that are started, stopped, etc., together with the default  Postfix  instance.   Specify  a
       list of pathnames separated by comma or whitespace.

       When  $multi_instance_directories  is  empty,  the  postfix(1)  command  runs in single-instance mode and
       operates on a single Postfix instance only. Otherwise, the postfix(1) command runs in multi-instance mode
       and  invokes  the  multi-instance  manager  specified  with  the  multi_instance_wrapper  parameter.  The
       multi-instance  manager in turn executes postfix(1) commands for the default instance and for all Postfix
       instances in $multi_instance_directories.

       Currently, this parameter setting is ignored except for the default main.cf file.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

multi_instance_enable (default: no)

       Allow this Postfix instance to be started, stopped, etc., by a multi-instance manager.  By  default,  new
       instances  are  created  in  a  safe  state  that  prevents  them from being started inadvertently.  This
       parameter is reserved for the multi-instance manager.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

multi_instance_group (default: empty)

       The optional instance group name of this Postfix instance. A  group  identifies  closely-related  Postfix
       instances  that  the multi-instance manager can start, stop, etc., as a unit.  This parameter is reserved
       for the multi-instance manager.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

multi_instance_name (default: empty)

       The optional instance name of this Postfix instance. This name becomes also the  default  value  for  the
       syslog_name parameter.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

multi_instance_wrapper (default: empty)

       The  pathname  of  a  multi-instance  manager  command  that  the  postfix(1)  command  invokes  when the
       multi_instance_directories parameter value is non-empty. The pathname may be followed by initial  command
       arguments separated by whitespace; shell metacharacters such as quotes are not supported in this context.

       The  postfix(1)  command  invokes the manager command with the postfix(1) non-option command arguments on
       the manager command line, and with all installation configuration parameters exported  into  the  manager
       command  process  environment.  The manager command in turn invokes the postfix(1) command for individual
       Postfix instances as "postfix -c config_directory command".

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

multi_recipient_bounce_reject_code (default: 550)

       The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when a remote SMTP  client  request  is  blocked  by  the
       reject_multi_recipient_bounce restriction.

       Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of RFC 5321.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

mydestination (default: $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost)

       The  list of domains that are delivered via the $local_transport mail delivery transport. By default this
       is the Postfix local(8) delivery agent which looks up all recipients in /etc/passwd and /etc/aliases. The
       SMTP server validates recipient addresses with $local_recipient_maps and rejects non-existent recipients.
       See also the local domain class in the ADDRESS_CLASS_README file.

       The default mydestination value specifies names for the local machine only.  On a  mail  domain  gateway,
       you should also include $mydomain.

       The  $local_transport  delivery method is also selected for mail addressed to user@[the.net.work.address]
       of the mail system (the IP addresses specified with the inet_interfaces and proxy_interfaces parameters).

       Warnings:

       •      Do not specify the names  of  virtual  domains  -  those  domains  are  specified  elsewhere.  See
              VIRTUAL_README for more information.

       •      Do   not   specify   the  names  of  domains  that  this  machine  is  backup  MX  host  for.  See
              STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README for how to set up backup MX hosts.

       •      By  default,  the  Postfix  SMTP  server  rejects  mail  for  recipients  not  listed   with   the
              local_recipient_maps   parameter.    See   the   postconf(5)  manual  for  a  description  of  the
              local_recipient_maps and unknown_local_recipient_reject_code parameters.

       Specify a list of host or domain names, "/file/name" or "type:table" patterns, separated by commas and/or
       whitespace. A "/file/name" pattern is replaced by its contents; a "type:table" lookup  table  is  matched
       when  a  name  matches  a lookup key (the lookup result is ignored).  Continue long lines by starting the
       next line with whitespace.

       Examples:

       mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain $mydomain
       mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain

mydomain (default: see postconf -d output)

       The internet domain name of this mail system.   The  default  is  to  use  $myhostname  minus  the  first
       component, or "localdomain" (Postfix 2.3 and later).  $mydomain is used as a default value for many other
       configuration parameters.

       Example:

       mydomain = domain.tld

myhostname (default: see postconf -d output)

       The  internet  hostname of this mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name (FQDN)
       from  gethostname(),  or  to  use  the  non-FQDN  result  from  gethostname()  and  append  ".$mydomain".
       $myhostname is used as a default value for many other configuration parameters.

       Example:

       myhostname = host.example.com

mynetworks (default: see postconf -d output)

       The list of "trusted" remote SMTP clients that have more privileges than "strangers".

       In   particular,   "trusted"   SMTP  clients  are  allowed  to  relay  mail  through  Postfix.   See  the
       smtpd_relay_restrictions parameter description in the postconf(5) manual.

       You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand or you can let  Postfix  do  it  for  you
       (which is the default).  See the description of the mynetworks_style parameter for more information.

       If you specify the mynetworks list by hand, Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.

       Specify  a  list of network addresses or network/netmask patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace.
       Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.

       The netmask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host address.   You  can  also  specify
       "/file/name"  or  "type:table"  patterns.   A  "/file/name"  pattern  is  replaced  by  its  contents;  a
       "type:table" lookup table is matched when a table entry matches a lookup string  (the  lookup  result  is
       ignored).

       The  list  is  matched  left  to  right,  and the search stops on the first match.  Specify "!pattern" to
       exclude an address or network block from the list. The form "!/file/name" is supported  only  in  Postfix
       version 2.4 and later.

       Note  1: Pattern matching of domain names is controlled by the presence or absence of "mynetworks" in the
       parent_domain_matches_subdomains parameter value.

       Note 2: IP version 6 address information must be specified inside [] in  the  mynetworks  value,  and  in
       files specified with "/file/name".  IP version 6 addresses contain the ":" character, and would otherwise
       be confused with a "type:table" pattern.

       Note 3: CIDR ranges cannot be specified in hash tables.  Use cidr tables if CIDR ranges are used.

       Examples:

       mynetworks = 127.0.0.0/8 168.100.189.0/28
       mynetworks = !192.168.0.1, 192.168.0.0/28
       mynetworks = 127.0.0.0/8 168.100.189.0/28 [::1]/128 [2001:240:587::]/64
       mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
       mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
       mynetworks = cidr:/etc/postfix/network_table.cidr

mynetworks_style (default: Postfix >= 3.0: host, Postfix < 3.0: subnet)

       The  method  to  generate  the  default  value for the mynetworks parameter.  This is the list of trusted
       networks for relay access control etc.

       •      Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust" only the local machine.

       •      Specify "mynetworks_style = subnet" when Postfix should "trust" remote SMTP clients in the same IP
              subnetworks as the local machine.  On Linux, this works correctly only with  interfaces  specified
              with the "ifconfig" or "ip" command.

       •      Specify  "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" remote SMTP clients in the same IP
              class A/B/C networks as the local machine.  Caution: this may cause Postfix to "trust" your entire
              provider's network.  Instead, specify an explicit mynetworks list by hand, as described  with  the
              mynetworks configuration parameter.

myorigin (default: $myhostname)

       The  domain name that locally-posted mail appears to come from, and that locally posted mail is delivered
       to. The default, $myhostname, is adequate for small sites.  If you run a domain with  multiple  machines,
       you  should  (1)  change  this to $mydomain and (2) set up a domain-wide alias database that aliases each
       user to user@that.users.mailhost.

       Example:

       myorigin = $mydomain

nested_header_checks (default: $header_checks)

       Optional lookup tables for content inspection of  non-MIME  message  headers  in  attached  messages,  as
       described in the header_checks(5) manual page.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

newaliases_path (default: see postconf -d output)

       Sendmail compatibility feature that specifies the location of the newaliases(1) command. This command can
       be used to rebuild the local(8) aliases(5) database.

non_fqdn_reject_code (default: 504)

       The   numerical   Postfix   SMTP   server   reply   code  when  a  client  request  is  rejected  by  the
       reject_non_fqdn_helo_hostname, reject_non_fqdn_sender or reject_non_fqdn_recipient restriction.

non_smtpd_milters (default: empty)

       A list of Milter (mail filter) applications for new mail that does not arrive via  the  Postfix  smtpd(8)
       server.  This  includes  local submission via the sendmail(1) command line, new mail that arrives via the
       Postfix qmqpd(8) server, and old mail that is re-injected into the queue with  "postsuper  -r".   Specify
       space or comma as a separator. See the MILTER_README document for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

notify_classes (default: resource, software)

       The  list  of  error  classes  that are reported to the postmaster. These postmaster notifications do not
       replace user notifications. The default is to report only the most serious  problems.  The  paranoid  may
       wish to turn on the policy (UCE and mail relaying) and protocol error (broken mail software) reports.

       NOTE:  postmaster  notifications  may  contain confidential information such as SASL passwords or message
       content.  It is the system administrator's responsibility to treat such information with care.

       The error classes are:

       bounce (also implies 2bounce)
              Send the postmaster copies of the headers of bounced mail, and send transcripts of  SMTP  sessions
              when  Postfix  rejects  mail.  The  notification  is  sent  to  the  address  specified  with  the
              bounce_notice_recipient configuration parameter (default: postmaster).

       2bounce
              Send undeliverable bounced mail to the  postmaster.  The  notification  is  sent  to  the  address
              specified with the 2bounce_notice_recipient configuration parameter (default: postmaster).

       data   Send  the  postmaster  a transcript of the SMTP session with an error because a critical data file
              was unavailable. The notification is sent to the address specified with the error_notice_recipient
              configuration parameter (default: postmaster).
              This feature is available in Postfix 2.9 and later.

       delay  Send the  postmaster  copies  of  the  headers  of  delayed  mail  (see  delay_warning_time).  The
              notification  is  sent  to  the  address  specified  with the delay_notice_recipient configuration
              parameter (default: postmaster).

       policy Send the postmaster a transcript of the SMTP session when a client request was rejected because of
              (UCE) policy. The notification is sent to the address specified  with  the  error_notice_recipient
              configuration parameter (default: postmaster).

       protocol
              Send  the postmaster a transcript of the SMTP session in case of client or server protocol errors.
              The notification is sent to the address specified with  the  error_notice_recipient  configuration
              parameter (default: postmaster).

       resource
              Inform the postmaster of mail not delivered due to resource problems.  The notification is sent to
              the   address   specified   with  the  error_notice_recipient  configuration  parameter  (default:
              postmaster).

       software
              Inform the postmaster of mail not delivered due to software problems.  The notification is sent to
              the  address  specified  with  the  error_notice_recipient   configuration   parameter   (default:
              postmaster).

       Examples:

       notify_classes = bounce, delay, policy, protocol, resource, software
       notify_classes = 2bounce, resource, software

openssl_path (default: openssl)

       The  location  of the OpenSSL command line program openssl(1).  This is used by the "postfix tls" command
       to create private keys, certificate signing requests, self-signed certificates, and to compute public key
       digests for DANE TLSA records.  In multi-instance environments, this parameter is always determined  from
       the configuration of the default Postfix instance.

       Example:

           /etc/postfix/main.cf:
               # NetBSD pkgsrc:
               openssl_path = /usr/pkg/bin/openssl
               # Local build:
               openssl_path = /usr/local/bin/openssl

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.1 and later.

owner_request_special (default: yes)

       Enable   special   treatment  for  owner-listname  entries  in  the  aliases(5)  file,  and  don't  split
       owner-listname and listname-request address localparts when the recipient_delimiter is set to "-".   This
       feature is useful for mailing lists.

parent_domain_matches_subdomains (default: see postconf -d output)

       A  list  of  Postfix  features  where  the  pattern "example.com" also matches subdomains of example.com,
       instead of requiring an explicit  ".example.com"  pattern.   This  is  planned  backwards  compatibility:
       eventually,  all Postfix features are expected to require explicit ".example.com" style patterns when you
       really want to match subdomains.

       The following Postfix feature names are supported.

       Postfix version 1.0 and later
              debug_peer_list,   fast_flush_domains,   mynetworks,   permit_mx_backup_networks,   relay_domains,
              transport_maps

       Postfix version 1.1 and later
              qmqpd_authorized_clients, smtpd_access_maps,

       Postfix version 2.8 and later
              postscreen_access_list

       Postfix version 3.0 and later
              smtpd_client_event_limit_exceptions

permit_mx_backup_networks (default: empty)

       Restrict the use of the permit_mx_backup SMTP access feature to only domains whose primary MX hosts match
       the  listed  networks.   The  parameter  value syntax is the same as with the mynetworks parameter; note,
       however, that the default value is empty.

       Pattern matching of domain names is controlled by the presence or absence of  "permit_mx_backup_networks"
       in the parent_domain_matches_subdomains parameter value.

pickup_service_name (default: pickup)

       The name of the pickup(8) service. This service picks up local mail submissions from the Postfix maildrop
       queue.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

pipe_delivery_status_filter (default: $default_delivery_status_filter)

       Optional  filter for the pipe(8) delivery agent to change the delivery status code or explanatory text of
       successful or unsuccessful deliveries.  See default_delivery_status_filter for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

plaintext_reject_code (default: 450)

       The  numerical  Postfix   SMTP   server   response   code   when   a   request   is   rejected   by   the
       reject_plaintext_session restriction.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

postlog_service_name (default: postlog)

       The name of the postlogd(8) service entry in master.cf.  This service appends logfile records to the file
       specified with the maillog_file parameter.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

postlogd_watchdog_timeout (default: 10s)

       How  much  time a postlogd(8) process may take to process a request before it is terminated by a built-in
       watchdog timer. This is a safety mechanism that prevents postlogd(8) from becoming non-responsive due  to
       a bug in Postfix itself or in system software. This limit cannot be set under 10s.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

postmulti_control_commands (default: reload flush)

       The postfix(1) commands that the postmulti(1) instance manager treats as "control" commands, that operate
       on running instances. For these commands, disabled instances are skipped.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

postmulti_start_commands (default: start)

       The postfix(1) commands that the postmulti(1) instance manager treats  as  "start"  commands.  For  these
       commands,  disabled  instances  are  "checked"  rather  than  "started",  and failure to "start" a member
       instance of an instance group will abort the start-up of later instances.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

postmulti_stop_commands (default: see postconf -d output)

       The postfix(1) commands that the postmulti(1) instance manager  treats  as  "stop"  commands.  For  these
       commands, disabled instances are skipped, and enabled instances are processed in reverse order.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

postscreen_access_list (default: permit_mynetworks)

       Permanent  allow/denylist  for  remote  SMTP  client  IP  addresses.   postscreen(8)  searches  this list
       immediately after a remote SMTP client connects.   Specify  a  comma-  or  whitespace-separated  list  of
       commands  (in  upper  or lower case) or lookup tables. The search stops upon the first command that fires
       for the client IP address.

        permit_mynetworks
              Allowlist the client and terminate the search if the client IP address  matches  $mynetworks.   Do
              not subject the client to any before/after 220 greeting tests.  Pass the connection immediately to
              a Postfix SMTP server process.
              Pattern   matching   of   domain   names   is   controlled   by   the   presence   or  absence  of
              "postscreen_access_list" in the parent_domain_matches_subdomains parameter value.

        type:table
              Query the specified lookup table. Each table lookup result is an access list, except  that  access
              lists inside a table cannot specify type:table entries.
              To discourage the use of hash, btree, etc. tables, there is no support for substring matching like
              smtpd(8). Use CIDR tables instead.

        permit
              Allowlist  the  client and terminate the search. Do not subject the client to any before/after 220
              greeting tests. Pass the connection immediately to a Postfix SMTP server process.

        reject
              Denylist the client and terminate the search. Subject the client to the action configured with the
              postscreen_denylist_action configuration parameter.

        dunno All postscreen(8) access lists implicitly have this command at the end.
              When  dunno is executed inside a lookup table, return from the lookup table and evaluate the  next
              command.
              When   dunno   is executed outside a lookup table, terminate the search, and subject the client to
              the configured before/after 220 greeting tests.

       Example:

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
           postscreen_access_list = permit_mynetworks,
               cidr:/etc/postfix/postscreen_access.cidr
           # Postfix < 3.6 use postscreen_blacklist_action.
           postscreen_denylist_action = enforce

       /etc/postfix/postscreen_access.cidr:
           # Rules are evaluated in the order as specified.
           # Denylist 192.168.* except 192.168.0.1.
           192.168.0.1         dunno
           192.168.0.0/16      reject

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_allowlist_interfaces (default: static:all)

       A list of local postscreen(8) server IP addresses where a non-allowlisted remote SMTP client  can  obtain
       postscreen(8)'s  temporary  allowlist  status.  This  status  is required before the client can talk to a
       Postfix SMTP server process.  By default, a client can obtain postscreen(8)'s  allowlist  status  on  any
       local postscreen(8) server IP address.

       When  postscreen(8)  listens on both primary and backup MX addresses, the postscreen_allowlist_interfaces
       parameter can be configured to give the temporary allowlist status only  when  a  client  connects  to  a
       primary  MX  address.  Once  a client is allowlisted it can talk to a Postfix SMTP server on any address.
       Thus, clients that connect only to backup MX addresses will never become allowlisted, and will  never  be
       allowed to talk to a Postfix SMTP server process.

       Specify  a  list of network addresses or network/netmask patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace.
       The netmask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host address. Continue  long  lines  by
       starting the next line with whitespace.

       You  can  also  specify "/file/name" or "type:table" patterns.  A "/file/name" pattern is replaced by its
       contents; a "type:table" lookup table is matched when a table entry matches a lookup string  (the  lookup
       result is ignored).

       The list is matched left to right, and the search stops on the first match. Specify "!pattern" to exclude
       an address or network block from the list.

       Note: IP version 6 address information must be specified inside [] in the postscreen_allowlist_interfaces
       value,  and  in files specified with "/file/name".  IP version 6 addresses contain the ":" character, and
       would otherwise be confused with a "type:table" pattern.

       Example:

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
           # Don't allowlist connections to the backup IP address.
           # Postfix < 3.6 use postscreen_whitelist_interfaces.
           postscreen_allowlist_interfaces = !168.100.189.8, static:all

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.6 and later.

       Available as postscreen_whitelist_interfaces in Postfix 2.9 - 3.5.

postscreen_bare_newline_action (default: ignore)

       The action that postscreen(8) takes when a remote SMTP client sends a bare newline character, that is,  a
       newline not preceded by carriage return.  Specify one of the following:

       ignore Ignore  the  failure  of this test. Allow other tests to complete.  Do not repeat this test before
              the result from some other test expires.   This  option  is  useful  for  testing  and  collecting
              statistics without blocking mail permanently.

       enforce
              Allow  other tests to complete. Reject attempts to deliver mail with a 550 SMTP reply, and log the
              helo/sender/recipient information.  Repeat this test the next time the client connects.

       drop   Drop the connection immediately with a 521 SMTP reply. Repeat this test the next time  the  client
              connects.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_bare_newline_enable (default: no)

       Enable  "bare  newline"  SMTP  protocol  tests  in the postscreen(8) server. These tests are expensive: a
       remote SMTP client must disconnect after it passes the test, before it can talk to a  real  Postfix  SMTP
       server.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_bare_newline_ttl (default: 30d)

       The  amount of time that postscreen(8) will use the result from a successful "bare newline" SMTP protocol
       test. During this time, the client IP address is excluded from this test. The default is long  because  a
       remote  SMTP  client  must disconnect after it passes the test, before it can talk to a real Postfix SMTP
       server.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is d (days).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_blacklist_action (default: ignore)

       Renamed to postscreen_denylist_action in Postfix 3.6.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 - 3.5.

postscreen_cache_cleanup_interval (default: 12h)

       The  amount  of  time  between postscreen(8) cache cleanup runs.  Cache cleanup increases the load on the
       cache database and should therefore not be run frequently. This feature requires that the cache  database
       supports the "delete" and "sequence" operators.  Specify a zero interval to disable cache cleanup.

       After  each cache cleanup run, the postscreen(8) daemon logs the number of entries that were retained and
       dropped. A cleanup run is logged as "partial" when the daemon terminates early  after  "postfix  reload",
       "postfix stop", or no requests for $max_idle seconds.

       Specify  a  non-negative  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies
       the time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default  time
       unit is h (hours).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_cache_map (default: btree:$data_directory/postscreen_cache)

       Persistent storage for the postscreen(8) server decisions.

       To  share  a  postscreen(8)  cache  between multiple postscreen(8) instances, use "postscreen_cache_map =
       proxy:btree:/path/to/file".   This  requires  Postfix  version  2.9   or   later;   earlier   proxymap(8)
       implementations  don't  support  cache  cleanup.  For  an  alternative approach see the memcache_table(5)
       manpage.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_cache_retention_time (default: 7d)

       The amount of time that postscreen(8) will cache an  expired  temporary  allowlist  entry  before  it  is
       removed.  This prevents clients from being logged as "NEW" just because their cache entry expired an hour
       ago. It also prevents the cache from filling up with clients that passed some deep protocol test once and
       never came back.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is d (days).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_client_connection_count_limit (default: $smtpd_client_connection_count_limit)

       How  many  simultaneous  connections  any  remote  SMTP  client is allowed to have with the postscreen(8)
       daemon. By default, this limit is the same as with the Postfix SMTP server. Note that the triage  process
       can  take  several  seconds,  with the time spent in postscreen_greet_wait delay, and with the time spent
       talking to the postscreen(8) built-in dummy SMTP protocol engine.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_command_count_limit (default: 20)

       The limit on the total number of commands per SMTP session for  postscreen(8)'s  built-in  SMTP  protocol
       engine.   This  SMTP engine defers or rejects all attempts to deliver mail, therefore there is no need to
       enforce separate limits on the number of junk commands and error commands.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_command_filter (default: $smtpd_command_filter)

       A mechanism to transform commands  from  remote  SMTP  clients.   See  smtpd_command_filter  for  further
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

postscreen_command_time_limit (default: normal: 300s, overload: 10s)

       The time limit to read an entire command line with postscreen(8)'s built-in SMTP protocol engine.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_denylist_action (default: ignore)

       The  action  that  postscreen(8)  takes  when  a  remote  SMTP  client is permanently denylisted with the
       postscreen_access_list parameter.  Specify one of the following:

       ignore (default)
              Ignore  this result. Allow other tests to complete.  Repeat this test the  next  time  the  client
              connects.  This option is useful for testing and collecting statistics without blocking mail.

       enforce
              Allow  other tests to complete. Reject attempts to deliver mail with a 550 SMTP reply, and log the
              helo/sender/recipient information.  Repeat this test the next time the client connects.

       drop   Drop the connection immediately with a 521 SMTP reply. Repeat this test the next time  the  client
              connects.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.6 and later.

       Available as postscreen_blacklist_action in Postfix 2.8 - 3.5.

postscreen_disable_vrfy_command (default: $disable_vrfy_command)

       Disable the SMTP VRFY command in the postscreen(8) daemon.  See disable_vrfy_command for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps (default: $smtpd_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps)

       Lookup  tables,  indexed  by the remote SMTP client address, with case insensitive lists of EHLO keywords
       (pipelining, starttls, auth, etc.) that the postscreen(8) server will not send in the EHLO response to  a
       remote  SMTP  client. See smtpd_discard_ehlo_keywords for details.  The table is not searched by hostname
       for robustness reasons.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

postscreen_discard_ehlo_keywords (default: $smtpd_discard_ehlo_keywords)

       A case insensitive list of EHLO keywords (pipelining, starttls, auth, etc.) that the postscreen(8) server
       will not send in the EHLO response to a remote SMTP client. See smtpd_discard_ehlo_keywords for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

postscreen_dnsbl_action (default: ignore)

       The action that postscreen(8) takes when a remote SMTP client's combined  DNSBL  score  is  equal  to  or
       greater  than  a  threshold  (as  defined  with the postscreen_dnsbl_sites and postscreen_dnsbl_threshold
       parameters).  Specify one of the following:

       ignore (default)
              Ignore the failure of this test. Allow other tests to complete.  Repeat this test  the  next  time
              the client connects.  This option is useful for testing and collecting statistics without blocking
              mail.

       enforce
              Allow  other tests to complete. Reject attempts to deliver mail with a 550 SMTP reply, and log the
              helo/sender/recipient information.  Repeat this test the next time the client connects.

       drop   Drop the connection immediately with a 521 SMTP reply. Repeat this test the next time  the  client
              connects.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_dnsbl_allowlist_threshold (default: 0)

       Allow  a  remote  SMTP  client  to  skip  "before"  and "after 220 greeting" protocol tests, based on its
       combined DNSBL score as defined with the postscreen_dnsbl_sites parameter.

       Specify   a   negative   value   to    enable    this    feature.    When    a    client    passes    the
       postscreen_dnsbl_allowlist_threshold without having failed other tests, all pending or disabled tests are
       flagged  as  completed  with a time-to-live value equal to postscreen_dnsbl_ttl.  When a test was already
       completed, its time-to-live value is updated if it was less than postscreen_dnsbl_ttl.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.6 and later.

       Available as postscreen_dnsbl_whitelist_threshold in Postfix 2.11 - 3.5.

postscreen_dnsbl_max_ttl (default: ${postscreen_dnsbl_ttl?{$postscreen_dnsbl_ttl}:{1}}h)

       The maximum amount of time that postscreen(8) will use the result from a successful DNS-based  reputation
       test before a client IP address is required to pass that test again. If the DNS reply specifies a shorter
       TTL value, that value will be used unless it would be smaller than postscreen_dnsbl_min_ttl.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is h (hours).

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.1. The default setting is backwards-compatible with older  Postfix
       versions.

postscreen_dnsbl_min_ttl (default: 60s)

       The  minimum amount of time that postscreen(8) will use the result from a successful DNS-based reputation
       test before a client IP address is required to pass that test again. If the DNS reply specifies a  larger
       TTL value, that value will be used unless it would be larger than postscreen_dnsbl_max_ttl.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.1.

postscreen_dnsbl_reply_map (default: empty)

       A mapping from an actual DNSBL domain name which includes a secret password, to  the  DNSBL  domain  name
       that  postscreen will reply with when it rejects mail.  When no mapping is found, the actual DNSBL domain
       will be used.

       For maximal stability it is best to use a file that is  read  into  memory  such  as  pcre:,  regexp:  or
       texthash:  (texthash:  is  similar to hash:, except a) there is no need to run postmap(1) before the file
       can be used, and b) texthash: does not detect changes after the file is read).

       Example:

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
           postscreen_dnsbl_reply_map = texthash:/etc/postfix/dnsbl_reply

       /etc/postfix/dnsbl_reply:
          secret.zen.spamhaus.org      zen.spamhaus.org

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_dnsbl_sites (default: empty)

       Optional list of patterns with DNS allow/denylist domains, filters and weight factors. When the  list  is
       non-empty,  the  dnsblog(8) daemon will query these domains with the reversed IP addresses of remote SMTP
       clients, and postscreen(8) will update an  SMTP  client's  DNSBL  score  with  each  non-error  reply  as
       described below.

       Caution:  when  postscreen  rejects  mail,  its  SMTP  response  contains  the DNSBL domain name. Use the
       postscreen_dnsbl_reply_map feature to hide "password" information in DNSBL domain names.

       When   a   client's   score   is   equal   to   or   greater   than   the   threshold   specified    with
       postscreen_dnsbl_threshold, postscreen(8) can drop the connection with the remote SMTP client.

       Specify a list of domain=filter*weight patterns, separated by comma or whitespace.

       •      When  a  pattern  specifies no "=filter", postscreen(8) will use any non-error DNSBL query result.
              Otherwise, postscreen(8) will use only DNSBL query results that match the filter. The  filter  has
              the  form  d.d.d.d,  where  each  d  is a number, or a pattern inside [] that contains one or more
              ";"-separated numbers or number..number ranges.

       •      When a pattern specifies no "*weight", the weight of the pattern is 1.  Otherwise, the weight must
              be an integral number.  Specify a negative number for allowlisting.

       •      When a pattern matches one or more DNSBL query results, postscreen(8) adds that  pattern's  weight
              once to the remote SMTP client's DNSBL score.

       Examples:

       To  use  example.com  as  a high-confidence blocklist, and to block mail with example.net and example.org
       only when both agree:

       postscreen_dnsbl_threshold = 2
       postscreen_dnsbl_sites = example.com*2, example.net, example.org

       To filter only DNSBL replies containing 127.0.0.4:

       postscreen_dnsbl_sites = example.com=127.0.0.4

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_dnsbl_threshold (default: 1)

       The inclusive lower bound for blocking a remote SMTP client, based on its combined DNSBL score as defined
       with the postscreen_dnsbl_sites parameter.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_dnsbl_timeout (default: 10s)

       The time limit for DNSBL or DNSWL lookups. This is separate from the timeouts in  the  dnsblog(8)  daemon
       which are defined by system resolver(3) routines.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0.

postscreen_dnsbl_ttl (default: 1h)

       The amount of time that postscreen(8) will use the result from a  successful  DNS-based  reputation  test
       before a client IP address is required to pass that test again.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is h (hours).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8-3.0. It was replaced by postscreen_dnsbl_max_ttl in Postfix 3.1.

postscreen_dnsbl_whitelist_threshold (default: 0)

       Renamed to postscreen_dnsbl_allowlist_threshold in Postfix 3.6.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.11 - 3.5.

postscreen_enforce_tls (default: $smtpd_enforce_tls)

       Mandatory TLS: announce STARTTLS support to remote  SMTP  clients,  and  require  that  clients  use  TLS
       encryption.  See smtpd_postscreen_enforce_tls for details.

       This  feature  is  available  in  Postfix  2.8  and later.  Preferably, use postscreen_tls_security_level
       instead.

postscreen_expansion_filter (default: see postconf -d output)

       List  of  characters  that  are  permitted  in  postscreen_reject_footer   attribute   expansions.    See
       smtpd_expansion_filter for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

postscreen_forbidden_commands (default: $smtpd_forbidden_commands)

       List  of  commands  that  the  postscreen(8)  server  considers  in  violation  of the SMTP protocol. See
       smtpd_forbidden_commands for syntax, and postscreen_non_smtp_command_action for possible actions.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_greet_action (default: ignore)

       The action that postscreen(8) takes when a remote SMTP client speaks before  its  turn  within  the  time
       specified with the postscreen_greet_wait parameter.  Specify one of the following:

       ignore (default)
              Ignore  the  failure  of this test. Allow other tests to complete.  Repeat this test the next time
              the client connects.  This option is useful for testing and collecting statistics without blocking
              mail.

       enforce
              Allow other tests to complete. Reject attempts to deliver mail with a 550 SMTP reply, and log  the
              helo/sender/recipient information.  Repeat this test the next time the client connects.

       drop   Drop  the  connection immediately with a 521 SMTP reply. Repeat this test the next time the client
              connects.

       In either case, postscreen(8) will not allowlist the remote SMTP client IP address.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_greet_banner (default: $smtpd_banner)

       The text in the optional "220-text..." server response that postscreen(8) sends ahead of the real Postfix
       SMTP server's "220 text..." response, in an attempt to confuse bad SMTP clients so that they speak before
       their turn (pre-greet).  Specify an empty value to disable this feature.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_greet_ttl (default: 1d)

       The amount of time that postscreen(8) will use the result from a successful PREGREET  test.  During  this
       time,  the  client IP address is excluded from this test. The default is relatively short, because a good
       client can immediately talk to a real Postfix SMTP server.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is d (days).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_greet_wait (default: normal: 6s, overload: 2s)

       The amount of time that postscreen(8) will wait for an SMTP client to send a command before its turn, and
       for  DNS  blocklist  lookup  results  to  arrive  (default: up to 2 seconds under stress, up to 6 seconds
       otherwise).

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_helo_required (default: $smtpd_helo_required)

       Require that a remote SMTP client sends HELO or EHLO before commencing a MAIL transaction.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_non_smtp_command_action (default: drop)

       The  action  that postscreen(8) takes when a remote SMTP client sends non-SMTP commands as specified with
       the postscreen_forbidden_commands parameter.  Specify one of the following:

       ignore Ignore the failure of this test. Allow other tests to complete.  Do not repeat  this  test  before
              the  result  from  some  other  test  expires.   This  option is useful for testing and collecting
              statistics without blocking mail permanently.

       enforce
              Allow other tests to complete. Reject attempts to deliver mail with a 550 SMTP reply, and log  the
              helo/sender/recipient information.  Repeat this test the next time the client connects.

       drop   Drop  the  connection immediately with a 521 SMTP reply. Repeat this test the next time the client
              connects. This action is the same as  with  the  Postfix  SMTP  server's  smtpd_forbidden_commands
              feature.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_non_smtp_command_enable (default: no)

       Enable  "non-SMTP  command"  tests  in the postscreen(8) server. These tests are expensive: a client must
       disconnect after it passes the test, before it can talk to a real Postfix SMTP server.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_non_smtp_command_ttl (default: 30d)

       The amount of time that postscreen(8) will use the  result  from  a  successful  "non_smtp_command"  SMTP
       protocol  test.  During  this time, the client IP address is excluded from this test. The default is long
       because a client must disconnect after it passes the test, before it can talk  to  a  real  Postfix  SMTP
       server.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is d (days).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_pipelining_action (default: enforce)

       The action that postscreen(8) takes when a remote SMTP client sends multiple commands instead of  sending
       one command and waiting for the server to respond.  Specify one of the following:

       ignore Ignore  the  failure  of this test. Allow other tests to complete.  Do not repeat this test before
              the result from some other test expires.   This  option  is  useful  for  testing  and  collecting
              statistics without blocking mail permanently.

       enforce
              Allow  other tests to complete. Reject attempts to deliver mail with a 550 SMTP reply, and log the
              helo/sender/recipient information.  Repeat this test the next time the client connects.

       drop   Drop the connection immediately with a 521 SMTP reply. Repeat this test the next time  the  client
              connects.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_pipelining_enable (default: no)

       Enable  "pipelining"  SMTP  protocol tests in the postscreen(8) server. These tests are expensive: a good
       client must disconnect after it passes the test, before it can talk to a real Postfix SMTP server.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_pipelining_ttl (default: 30d)

       The amount of time that postscreen(8) will use the result from a successful  "pipelining"  SMTP  protocol
       test.  During  this time, the client IP address is excluded from this test. The default is long because a
       good client must disconnect after it passes the test, before it can talk to a real Postfix SMTP server.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is d (days).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_post_queue_limit (default: $default_process_limit)

       The  number of clients that can be waiting for service from a real Postfix SMTP server process. When this
       queue is full, all clients will receive a 421 response.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_pre_queue_limit (default: $default_process_limit)

       The number of non-allowlisted clients that can be waiting  for  a  decision  whether  they  will  receive
       service  from  a  real  Postfix SMTP server process. When this queue is full, all non-allowlisted clients
       will receive a 421 response.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_reject_footer (default: $smtpd_reject_footer)

       Optional  information  that  is  appended  after  a  4XX  or  5XX  postscreen(8)  server  response.   See
       smtpd_reject_footer for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

postscreen_reject_footer_maps (default: $smtpd_reject_footer_maps)

       Optional  lookup table for information that is appended after a 4XX or 5XX postscreen(8) server response.
       See smtpd_reject_footer_maps for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

postscreen_tls_security_level (default: $smtpd_tls_security_level)

       The SMTP TLS security level for the postscreen(8) server; when  a  non-empty  value  is  specified,  this
       overrides    the    obsolete    parameters    postscreen_use_tls    and    postscreen_enforce_tls.    See
       smtpd_tls_security_level for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

postscreen_upstream_proxy_protocol (default: empty)

       The name of the proxy protocol used by an optional before-postscreen proxy agent. When a proxy  agent  is
       used,    this   protocol   conveys   local   and   remote   address   and   port   information.   Specify
       "postscreen_upstream_proxy_protocol = haproxy" to enable the haproxy protocol;  version  2  is  supported
       with Postfix 3.5 and later.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.10 and later.

postscreen_upstream_proxy_timeout (default: 5s)

       The time limit for the proxy protocol specified with the postscreen_upstream_proxy_protocol parameter.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.10 and later.

postscreen_use_tls (default: $smtpd_use_tls)

       Opportunistic  TLS: announce STARTTLS support to remote SMTP clients, but do not require that clients use
       TLS encryption.

       This feature is available in  Postfix  2.8  and  later.   Preferably,  use  postscreen_tls_security_level
       instead.

postscreen_watchdog_timeout (default: 10s)

       How much time a postscreen(8) process may take to respond to a remote SMTP client command or to perform a
       cache  operation  before  it is terminated by a built-in watchdog timer.  This is a safety mechanism that
       prevents postscreen(8) from becoming non-responsive due to a bug in Postfix itself or in system software.
       To avoid false alarms and unnecessary cache corruption this limit cannot be set under 10s.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_whitelist_interfaces (default: static:all)

       Renamed to postscreen_allowlist_interfaces in Postfix 3.6.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.9 - 3.5.

prepend_delivered_header (default: command, file, forward)

       The message delivery contexts where the Postfix local(8) delivery agent prepends a Delivered-To:  message
       header  with  the address that the mail was delivered to. This information is used for mail delivery loop
       detection.

       By default, the Postfix local delivery agent prepends a Delivered-To: header  when  forwarding  mail  and
       when  delivering to file (mailbox) and command. Turning off the Delivered-To: header when forwarding mail
       is not recommended.

       Specify zero or more of forward, file, or command.

       Example:

       prepend_delivered_header = forward

process_id (read-only)

       The process ID of a Postfix command or daemon process.

process_id_directory (default: pid)

       The location of Postfix PID files relative to $queue_directory.  This is a read-only parameter.

process_name (read-only)

       The process name of a Postfix command or daemon process.

propagate_unmatched_extensions (default: canonical, virtual)

       What address lookup tables copy an address extension from the lookup key to the lookup result.

       For example, with  a  virtual(5)  mapping  of  "joe@example.com  =>  joe.user@example.net",  the  address
       "joe+foo@example.com" would rewrite to "joe.user+foo@example.net".

       Specify  zero  or  more  of  canonical,  virtual, alias, forward, include or generic. These cause address
       extension propagation with canonical(5), virtual(5), and aliases(5)  maps,  with  local(8)  .forward  and
       :include: file lookups, and with smtp(8) generic maps, respectively.

       Note:  enabling  this feature for types other than canonical and virtual is likely to cause problems when
       mail is forwarded to other sites, especially with mail that is sent to a mailing list exploder address.

       Examples:

       propagate_unmatched_extensions = canonical, virtual, alias,
               forward, include
       propagate_unmatched_extensions = canonical, virtual

proxy_interfaces (default: empty)

       The remote network interface addresses that this mail system receives mail  on  by  way  of  a  proxy  or
       network address translation unit.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

       You  must  specify  your  "outside"  proxy/NAT  addresses  when your system is a backup MX host for other
       domains, otherwise mail delivery loops will happen when the primary MX host is down.

       Example:

       proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4

proxy_read_maps (default: see postconf -d output)

       The lookup tables that the proxymap(8) server is allowed to access for the read-only service.

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma.  Table references  that
       don't begin with proxy: are ignored.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

proxy_write_maps (default: see postconf -d output)

       The  lookup  tables  that  the  proxymap(8)  server  is  allowed  to  access  for the read-write service.
       Postfix-owned local database files should  be  stored  under  the  Postfix-owned  data_directory.   Table
       references that don't begin with proxy: are ignored.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

proxymap_service_name (default: proxymap)

       The  name  of  the  proxymap read-only table lookup service.  This service is normally implemented by the
       proxymap(8) daemon.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

proxywrite_service_name (default: proxywrite)

       The name of the proxywrite read-write table lookup service.  This service is normally implemented by  the
       proxymap(8) daemon.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

qmgr_clog_warn_time (default: 300s)

       The  minimal  delay between warnings that a specific destination is clogging up the Postfix active queue.
       Specify 0 to disable.

       Specify a non-negative time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter  suffix  that  specifies
       the  time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time
       unit is s (seconds).

       This feature is enabled with the helpful_warnings parameter.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

qmgr_daemon_timeout (default: 1000s)

       How much time a Postfix queue manager process may take to handle a request before it is terminated  by  a
       built-in watchdog timer.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

qmgr_fudge_factor (default: 100)

       Obsolete feature: the percentage of delivery resources that a busy mail system will use up  for  delivery
       of a large mailing  list message.

       This  feature exists only in the oqmgr(8) old queue manager. The current queue manager solves the problem
       in a better way.

qmgr_ipc_timeout (default: 60s)

       The time limit for the queue manager to send  or  receive  information  over  an  internal  communication
       channel.   The purpose is to break out of deadlock situations. If the time limit is exceeded the software
       either retries or aborts the operation.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

qmgr_message_active_limit (default: 20000)

       The maximal number of messages in the active queue.

qmgr_message_recipient_limit (default: 20000)

       The maximal number of recipients held in memory by the Postfix queue manager, and the maximal size of the
       short-term, in-memory "dead" destination status cache.

qmgr_message_recipient_minimum (default: 10)

       The  minimal number of in-memory recipients for any message. This takes priority over any other in-memory
       recipient limits (i.e., the global qmgr_message_recipient_limit and the per  transport  _recipient_limit)
       if necessary. The minimum value allowed for this parameter is 1.

qmqpd_authorized_clients (default: empty)

       What remote QMQP clients are allowed to connect to the Postfix QMQP server port.

       By  default,  no client is allowed to use the service. This is because the QMQP server will relay mail to
       any destination.

       Specify a list of client patterns. A list pattern specifies a host  name,  a  domain  name,  an  internet
       address,  or  a  network/mask  pattern,  where the mask specifies the number of bits in the network part.
       When a pattern specifies a file name, its contents are substituted for the file name; when a pattern is a
       "type:table" table specification, table lookup is used instead.

       Patterns are separated by whitespace and/or commas. In order to reverse the  result,  precede  a  pattern
       with an exclamation point (!). The form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later.

       Pattern  matching  of domain names is controlled by the presence or absence of "qmqpd_authorized_clients"
       in the parent_domain_matches_subdomains parameter value.

       Example:

       qmqpd_authorized_clients = !192.168.0.1, 192.168.0.0/24

qmqpd_client_port_logging (default: no)

       Enable logging of the remote QMQP client port in addition to the hostname and  IP  address.  The  logging
       format is "host[address]:port".

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

qmqpd_error_delay (default: 1s)

       How  long  the  Postfix QMQP server will pause before sending a negative reply to the remote QMQP client.
       The purpose is to slow down confused or malicious clients.

       Specify a non-negative time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter  suffix  that  specifies
       the  time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time
       unit is s (seconds).

qmqpd_timeout (default: 300s)

       The time limit for sending or receiving information over the network.   If  a  read  or  write  operation
       blocks for more than $qmqpd_timeout seconds the Postfix QMQP server gives up and disconnects.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

queue_directory (default: see postconf -d output)

       The location of the Postfix top-level queue directory. This is  the  root  directory  of  Postfix  daemon
       processes that run chrooted.

queue_file_attribute_count_limit (default: 100)

       The  maximal  number  of (name=value) attributes that may be stored in a Postfix queue file. The limit is
       enforced by the cleanup(8) server.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

queue_minfree (default: 0)

       The minimal amount of free space in bytes in the queue file system that is needed to receive mail.   This
       is currently used by the Postfix SMTP server to decide if it will accept any mail at all.

       By default, the Postfix SMTP server rejects MAIL FROM commands when the amount of free space is less than
       1.5*$message_size_limit  (Postfix  version 2.1 and later).  To specify a higher minimum free space limit,
       specify a queue_minfree value that is at least 1.5*$message_size_limit.

       With Postfix versions 2.0 and earlier, a queue_minfree value of zero means there is no  minimum  required
       amount of free space.

queue_run_delay (default: 300s)

       The  time  between  deferred queue scans by the queue manager; prior to Postfix 2.4 the default value was
       1000s.

       This parameter should be set less than or equal to $minimal_backoff_time. See also $maximal_backoff_time.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

queue_service_name (default: qmgr)

       The name of the qmgr(8) service. This service manages the Postfix queue and schedules delivery requests.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

rbl_reply_maps (default: empty)

       Optional  lookup  tables  with  RBL response templates. The tables are indexed by the RBL domain name. By
       default, Postfix uses  the  default  template  as  specified  with  the  default_rbl_reply  configuration
       parameter. See there for a discussion of the syntax of RBL reply templates.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

readme_directory (default: see postconf -d output)

       The  location of Postfix README files that describe how to build, configure or operate a specific Postfix
       subsystem or feature.

receive_override_options (default: empty)

       Enable or disable recipient validation, built-in content filtering, or address mapping. Typically,  these
       are specified in master.cf as command-line arguments for the smtpd(8), qmqpd(8) or pickup(8) daemons.

       Specify  zero  or  more  of  the following options.  The options override main.cf settings and are either
       implemented by smtpd(8), qmqpd(8), or pickup(8) themselves, or they are forwarded to the cleanup server.

       no_unknown_recipient_checks
              Do not try to reject unknown recipients (SMTP server only).  This is typically specified AFTER  an
              external content filter.

       no_address_mappings
              Disable  canonical  address  mapping,  virtual  alias  map  expansion,  address  masquerading, and
              automatic BCC (blind carbon-copy) recipients. This  is  typically  specified  BEFORE  an  external
              content filter.

       no_header_body_checks
              Disable header/body_checks. This is typically specified AFTER an external content filter.

       no_milters
              Disable  Milter  (mail filter) applications. This is typically specified AFTER an external content
              filter.

       Note: when the "BEFORE content filter" receive_override_options setting is specified in the main.cf file,
       specify the "AFTER content filter" receive_override_options setting in master.cf (and vice versa).

       Examples:

       receive_override_options =
           no_unknown_recipient_checks, no_header_body_checks
       receive_override_options = no_address_mappings

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

recipient_bcc_maps (default: empty)

       Optional BCC (blind carbon-copy) address lookup tables, indexed by envelope recipient address.   The  BCC
       address (multiple results are not supported) is added when mail enters from outside of Postfix.

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma. Tables will be searched
       in the specified order until a match is found.

       The table search order is as follows:

       •      Look up the "user+extension@domain.tld" address including the optional address extension.

       •      Look up the "user@domain.tld" address without the optional address extension.

       •      Look  up  the  "user+extension"  address  local  part  when the recipient domain equals $myorigin,
              $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.

       •      Look up the "user" address local part when the recipient domain equals $myorigin,  $mydestination,
              $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.

       •      Look up the "@domain.tld" part.

       Note:  with  Postfix  2.3 and later the BCC address is added as if it was specified with NOTIFY=NONE. The
       sender will not be notified when the BCC address is undeliverable, as long as  all  down-stream  software
       implements RFC 3461.

       Note:  with  Postfix  2.2 and earlier the sender will unconditionally be notified when the BCC address is
       undeliverable.

       Note: automatic BCC recipients are produced only for new mail.  To  avoid  mailer  loops,  automatic  BCC
       recipients  are  not  generated  after  Postfix forwards mail internally, or after Postfix generates mail
       itself.

       Example:

       recipient_bcc_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/recipient_bcc

       After a change, run "postmap /etc/postfix/recipient_bcc".

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

recipient_canonical_classes (default: envelope_recipient, header_recipient)

       What   addresses   are   subject   to   recipient_canonical_maps   address    mapping.     By    default,
       recipient_canonical_maps  address  mapping  is  applied  to  envelope  recipient addresses, and to header
       recipient addresses.

       Specify one or more of: envelope_recipient, header_recipient

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

recipient_canonical_maps (default: empty)

       Optional address mapping lookup tables for envelope and header recipient addresses.  The table format and
       lookups are documented in canonical(5).

       Note: $recipient_canonical_maps is processed before $canonical_maps.

       Example:

       recipient_canonical_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/recipient_canonical

recipient_delimiter (default: empty)

       The set of characters that can separate an email address localpart, user name, or a  .forward  file  name
       from its extension.  For example, with "recipient_delimiter = +", the software tries user+foo@example.com
       before trying user@example.com, user+foo before trying user, and .forward+foo before trying .forward.

       More  formally,  an  email  address  localpart  or user name is separated from its extension by the first
       character that matches the recipient_delimiter set. The delimiter character and  extension  may  then  be
       used  to  generate an extended .forward file name. This implementation recognizes one delimiter character
       and one extension per email address localpart or email  address.  With  Postfix  2.10  and  earlier,  the
       recipient_delimiter specifies a single character.

       See canonical(5), local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects of recipient_delimiter on lookups
       in  aliases, canonical, virtual, and relocated maps, and see the propagate_unmatched_extensions parameter
       for propagating an extension from one email address to another.

       When  used  in  command_execution_directory,  forward_path,  or  luser_relay,  ${recipient_delimiter}  is
       replaced  with the actual recipient delimiter that was found in the recipient email address (Postfix 2.11
       and later), or it is replaced with the main.cf recipient_delimiter  parameter  value  (Postfix  2.10  and
       earlier).

       The  recipient_delimiter  is  not  applied  to  the mailer-daemon address, the postmaster address, or the
       double-bounce address. With the default "owner_request_special = yes" setting, the recipient_delimiter is
       also not applied to addresses with the special "owner-" prefix or the special "-request" suffix.

       Examples:

       # Handle Postfix-style extensions.
       recipient_delimiter = +

       # Handle both Postfix and qmail extensions (Postfix 2.11 and later).
       recipient_delimiter = +-

       # Use .forward for mail without address extension, and for mail with
       # an unrecognized address extension.
       forward_path = $home/.forward${recipient_delimiter}${extension},
           $home/.forward

reject_code (default: 554)

       The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when a remote SMTP client  request  is  rejected  by  the
       "reject" restriction.

       Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of RFC 5321.

reject_tempfail_action (default: defer_if_permit)

       The Postfix SMTP server's action when a reject-type restriction fails due to a temporary error condition.
       Specify  "defer"  to defer the remote SMTP client request immediately. With the default "defer_if_permit"
       action, the Postfix SMTP server continues to look for opportunities to reject mail, and defers the client
       request only if it would otherwise be accepted.

       For  finer   control,   see:   unverified_recipient_tempfail_action,   unverified_sender_tempfail_action,
       unknown_address_tempfail_action, and unknown_helo_hostname_tempfail_action.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

relay_clientcerts (default: empty)

       List  of  tables with remote SMTP client-certificate fingerprints or public key fingerprints (Postfix 2.9
       and later) for which the Postfix SMTP server will allow access with the  permit_tls_clientcerts  feature.
       The   fingerprint  digest  algorithm  is  configurable  via  the  smtpd_tls_fingerprint_digest  parameter
       (hard-coded as md5 prior to Postfix version 2.5).

       The default algorithm is sha256 with Postfix >= 3.6 and the compatibility_level set  to  3.6  or  higher.
       With  Postfix  <=  3.5,  the default algorithm is md5.  The best-practice algorithm is now sha256. Recent
       advances in hash function cryptanalysis have led to md5 and sha1 being deprecated  in  favor  of  sha256.
       However, as long as there are no known "second pre-image" attacks against the older algorithms, their use
       in this context, though not recommended, is still likely safe.

       Postfix  lookup  tables are in the form of (key, value) pairs.  Since we only need the key, the value can
       be chosen freely, e.g.  the name of the  user  or  host:  D7:04:2F:A7:0B:8C:A5:21:FA:31:77:E1:41:8A:EE:80
       lutzpc.at.home

       Example:

       relay_clientcerts = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_clientcerts

       For  more fine-grained control, use check_ccert_access to select an appropriate access(5) policy for each
       client.  See RESTRICTION_CLASS_README.

       This feature is available with Postfix version 2.2.

relay_destination_concurrency_limit (default: $default_destination_concurrency_limit)

       The maximal number of parallel deliveries  to  the  same  destination  via  the  relay  message  delivery
       transport.  This limit is enforced by the queue manager. The message delivery transport name is the first
       field in the entry in the master.cf file.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

relay_destination_recipient_limit (default: $default_destination_recipient_limit)

       The maximal number of recipients per message for the relay message  delivery  transport.  This  limit  is
       enforced by the queue manager. The message delivery transport name is the first field in the entry in the
       master.cf file.

       Setting  this  parameter  to a value of 1 changes the meaning of relay_destination_concurrency_limit from
       concurrency per domain into concurrency per recipient.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

relay_domains (default: Postfix >= 3.0: empty, Postfix < 3.0: $mydestination)

       What destination domains (and subdomains thereof) this system will relay mail to. For details  about  how
       the   relay_domains   value   is   used,   see   the   description  of  the  permit_auth_destination  and
       reject_unauth_destination SMTP recipient restrictions.

       Domains that match $relay_domains are delivered with the $relay_transport mail  delivery  transport.  The
       SMTP server validates recipient addresses with $relay_recipient_maps and rejects non-existent recipients.
       See also the relay domains address class in the ADDRESS_CLASS_README file.

       Note:  Postfix  will not automatically forward mail for domains that list this system as their primary or
       backup MX host. See the permit_mx_backup restriction in the postconf(5) manual page.

       Specify a list of host or domain names, "/file/name" patterns or "type:table" lookup tables, separated by
       commas and/or whitespace.  Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A  "/file/name"
       pattern  is  replaced  by  its  contents;  a  "type:table" lookup table is matched when a (parent) domain
       appears as lookup key. Specify "!pattern" to exclude a domain from the list. The  form  "!/file/name"  is
       supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later.

       Pattern  matching  of  domain  names  is  controlled by the presence or absence of "relay_domains" in the
       parent_domain_matches_subdomains parameter value.

relay_domains_reject_code (default: 554)

       The  numerical  Postfix  SMTP  server  response  code  when  a  client  request  is   rejected   by   the
       reject_unauth_destination recipient restriction.

       Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of RFC 5321.

relay_recipient_maps (default: empty)

       Optional lookup tables with all valid addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains. Specify @domain
       as  a  wild-card  for domains that have no valid recipient list, and become a source of backscatter mail:
       Postfix accepts spam for non-existent recipients and then floods innocent people with undeliverable mail.
       Technically, tables listed with $relay_recipient_maps are used as lists: Postfix needs to know only if  a
       lookup string is found or not, but it does not use the result from the table lookup.

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma. Tables will be searched
       in the specified order until a match is found.

       If  this  parameter  is  non-empty, then the Postfix SMTP server will reject mail to unknown relay users.
       This feature is off by default.

       See also the relay domains address class in the ADDRESS_CLASS_README file.

       Example:

       relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

relay_transport (default: relay)

       The default mail delivery transport and next-hop destination for remote delivery to domains  listed  with
       $relay_domains.   In   order   of   decreasing   precedence,   the  nexthop  destination  is  taken  from
       $relay_transport, $sender_dependent_relayhost_maps,  $relayhost,  or  from  the  recipient  domain.  This
       information can be overruled with the transport(5) table.

       Specify  a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is the name of a mail delivery transport
       defined in master.cf.  The :nexthop destination is optional; its syntax is documented in the manual  page
       of the corresponding delivery agent.

       See also the relay domains address class in the ADDRESS_CLASS_README file.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

relayhost (default: empty)

       The  next-hop destination(s) for non-local mail; overrides non-local domains in recipient addresses. This
       information    is    overruled     with     relay_transport,     sender_dependent_default_transport_maps,
       default_transport, sender_dependent_relayhost_maps and with the transport(5) table.

       On  an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your internal DNS uses no MX records, specify
       the name of the intranet gateway host instead.

       In the case of SMTP or LMTP delivery, specify one or more destinations in the  form  of  a  domain  name,
       hostname,  hostname:port,  [hostname]:port,  [hostaddress]  or  [hostaddress]:port, separated by comma or
       whitespace.  The form [hostname] turns off MX lookups. Multiple destinations are supported in Postfix 3.5
       and later.

       If you're connected via UUCP, see the UUCP_README file for useful information.

       Examples:

       relayhost = $mydomain
       relayhost = [gateway.example.com]
       relayhost = mail1.example:587, mail2.example:587
       relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]

relocated_maps (default: empty)

       Optional lookup tables with new contact information for users or domains that no longer exist.  The table
       format and lookups are documented in relocated(5).

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma. Tables will be searched
       in the specified order until a match is found.

       If you use this feature, run "postmap /etc/postfix/relocated" to build the necessary DBM or DB file after
       change, then "postfix reload" to make the changes visible.

       Examples:

       relocated_maps = dbm:/etc/postfix/relocated
       relocated_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relocated

remote_header_rewrite_domain (default: empty)

       Rewrite or add message headers in mail from remote clients if the remote_header_rewrite_domain  parameter
       value    is   non-empty,   updating   incomplete   addresses   with   the   domain   specified   in   the
       remote_header_rewrite_domain parameter, and adding missing headers.

       The local_header_rewrite_clients parameter controls what clients Postfix considers local.

       Examples:

       The safe setting: append "domain.invalid" to incomplete header addresses from  remote  SMTP  clients,  so
       that those addresses cannot be confused with local addresses.

           remote_header_rewrite_domain = domain.invalid

       The default, purist, setting: don't rewrite headers from remote clients at all.

           remote_header_rewrite_domain =

require_home_directory (default: no)

       Require  that  a local(8) recipient's home directory exists before mail delivery is attempted. By default
       this test is disabled.  It can be useful for environments that import home directories to the mail server
       (IMPORTING HOME DIRECTORIES IS NOT RECOMMENDED).

reset_owner_alias (default: no)

       Reset the local(8) delivery agent's idea of the owner-alias attribute, when delivering mail  to  a  child
       alias that does not have its own owner alias.

       This  feature  is  available in Postfix 2.8 and later. With older Postfix releases, the behavior is as if
       this parameter is set to "yes".

       As documented in aliases(5), when an alias name has a companion alias named owner-name, this will replace
       the envelope sender address, so that delivery errors will be reported to the owner alias instead  of  the
       sender. This configuration is recommended for mailing lists.

       A  less  known  property  of  the owner alias is that it also forces the local(8) delivery agent to write
       local and remote addresses from alias expansion to a new queue file, instead  of  attempting  to  deliver
       mail to local addresses as soon as they come out of alias expansion.

       Writing  local addresses from alias expansion to a new queue file allows for robust handling of temporary
       delivery errors: errors with one local member have no effect on deliveries to other members of the  list.
       On  the other hand, delivery to local addresses as soon as they come out of alias expansion is fragile: a
       temporary error with one local address from alias expansion will cause the entire alias  to  be  expanded
       repeatedly until the error goes away, or until the message expires in the queue.  In that case, a problem
       with one list member results in multiple message deliveries to other list members.

       The  default  behavior of Postfix 2.8 and later is to keep the owner-alias attribute of the parent alias,
       when delivering mail to a child alias that does not have its own owner alias. Then, local addresses  from
       that  child  alias will be written to a new queue file, and a temporary error with one local address will
       not affect delivery to other mailing list members.

       Unfortunately, older Postfix releases reset the owner-alias attribute when delivering  mail  to  a  child
       alias  that  does  not have its own owner alias. To be precise, this resets only the decision to create a
       new queue file, not the decision to override the envelope sender address.  The  local(8)  delivery  agent
       then  attempts to deliver local addresses as soon as they come out of child alias expansion.  If delivery
       to any address from child alias expansion fails with a temporary error condition, the entire mailing list
       may be expanded repeatedly until the mail expires in the queue, resulting in multiple deliveries  of  the
       same message to mailing list members.

resolve_dequoted_address (default: yes)

       Resolve a recipient address safely instead of correctly, by looking inside quotes.

       By  default,  the  Postfix  address resolver does not quote the address localpart as per RFC 822, so that
       additional @ or % or !  operators remain visible. This behavior  is  safe  but  it  is  also  technically
       incorrect.

       If  you specify "resolve_dequoted_address = no", then the Postfix resolver will not know about additional
       @ etc. operators in the address localpart. This opens opportunities for obscure mail relay  attacks  with
       user@domain@domain addresses when Postfix provides backup MX service for Sendmail systems.

resolve_null_domain (default: no)

       Resolve  an  address that ends in the "@" null domain as if the local hostname were specified, instead of
       rejecting the address as invalid.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.  Earlier versions always resolve the null  domain  as
       the local hostname.

       The  Postfix  SMTP  server uses this feature to reject mail from or to addresses that end in the "@" null
       domain, and from addresses that rewrite into a form that ends in the "@" null domain.

resolve_numeric_domain (default: no)

       Resolve "user@ipaddress" as "user@[ipaddress]", instead of rejecting the address as invalid.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

respectful_logging (default: see 'postconf -d' output)

       Avoid logging that implies  white  is  better  than  black.  Instead  use  'allowlist',  'denylist',  and
       variations of those words.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.6 and later.

rewrite_service_name (default: rewrite)

       The  name of the address rewriting service. This service rewrites addresses to standard form and resolves
       them to a (delivery method, next-hop host, recipient) triple.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

sample_directory (default: /etc/postfix)

       The name of the directory with example Postfix configuration files.  Starting  with  Postfix  2.1,  these
       files have been replaced with the postconf(5) manual page.

send_cyrus_sasl_authzid (default: no)

       When  authenticating  to  a  remote  SMTP  or  LMTP  server  with  the default setting "no", send no SASL
       authoriZation ID (authzid); send only the SASL authentiCation ID (authcid) plus the authcid's password.

       The non-default setting "yes" enables the behavior of older Postfix versions.  These always send  a  SASL
       authzid  that  is  equal  to  the  SASL authcid, but this causes interoperability problems with some SMTP
       servers.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.4.4 and later.

sender_based_routing (default: no)

       This parameter should not be used. It was replaced by sender_dependent_relayhost_maps in Postfix  version
       2.3.

sender_bcc_maps (default: empty)

       Optional  BCC  (blind  carbon-copy)  address  lookup tables, indexed by envelope sender address.  The BCC
       address (multiple results are not supported) is added when mail enters from outside of Postfix.

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma. Tables will be searched
       in the specified order until a match is found.

       The table search order is as follows:

       •      Look up the "user+extension@domain.tld" address including the optional address extension.

       •      Look up the "user@domain.tld" address without the optional address extension.

       •      Look up the  "user+extension"  address  local  part  when  the  sender  domain  equals  $myorigin,
              $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.

       •      Look  up  the  "user"  address local part when the sender domain equals $myorigin, $mydestination,
              $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.

       •      Look up the "@domain.tld" part.

       Note: with Postfix 2.3 and later the BCC address is added as if it was specified  with  NOTIFY=NONE.  The
       sender  will  not  be notified when the BCC address is undeliverable, as long as all down-stream software
       implements RFC 3461.

       Note: with Postfix 2.2 and earlier the sender will be notified when the BCC address is undeliverable.

       Note: automatic BCC recipients are produced only for new mail.  To  avoid  mailer  loops,  automatic  BCC
       recipients  are  not  generated  after  Postfix forwards mail internally, or after Postfix generates mail
       itself.

       Example:

       sender_bcc_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/sender_bcc

       After a change, run "postmap /etc/postfix/sender_bcc".

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

sender_canonical_classes (default: envelope_sender, header_sender)

       What addresses are subject to sender_canonical_maps address mapping.  By  default,  sender_canonical_maps
       address mapping is applied to envelope sender addresses, and to header sender addresses.

       Specify one or more of: envelope_sender, header_sender

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

sender_canonical_maps (default: empty)

       Optional  address  mapping  lookup tables for envelope and header sender addresses.  The table format and
       lookups are documented in canonical(5).

       Example: you want to rewrite the SENDER address "user@ugly.example" to "user@pretty.example", while still
       being able to send mail to the RECIPIENT address "user@ugly.example".

       Note: $sender_canonical_maps is processed before $canonical_maps.

       Example:

       sender_canonical_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/sender_canonical

sender_dependent_default_transport_maps (default: empty)

       A sender-dependent override for the global default_transport parameter setting. The tables  are  searched
       by  the  envelope  sender  address  and  @domain.  A lookup result of DUNNO terminates the search without
       overriding the global default_transport parameter  setting.   This  information  is  overruled  with  the
       transport(5) table.

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma. Tables will be searched
       in the specified order until a match is found.

       Note:  this overrides default_transport, not transport_maps, and therefore the expected syntax is that of
       default_transport,  not  the  syntax  of  transport_maps.   Specifically,  this  does  not  support   the
       transport_maps syntax for null transport, null nexthop, or null email addresses.

       For safety reasons, this feature does not allow $number substitutions in regular expression maps.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7 and later.

sender_dependent_relayhost_maps (default: empty)

       A  sender-dependent  override  for the global relayhost parameter setting. The tables are searched by the
       envelope sender address and @domain. A lookup result of DUNNO terminates the  search  without  overriding
       the  global  relayhost  parameter  setting  (Postfix  2.6  and later). This information is overruled with
       relay_transport, sender_dependent_default_transport_maps, default_transport  and  with  the  transport(5)
       table.

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma. Tables will be searched
       in the specified order until a match is found.

       For safety reasons, this feature does not allow $number substitutions in regular expression maps.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

sendmail_fix_line_endings (default: always)

       Controls  how  the  Postfix  sendmail command converts email message line endings from <CR><LF> into UNIX
       format (<LF>).

       always Always convert message lines ending in <CR><LF>. This setting is the default with Postfix 2.9  and
              later.

       strict Convert  message  lines  ending  in  <CR><LF>  only if the first input line ends in <CR><LF>. This
              setting is backwards-compatible with Postfix 2.8 and earlier.

       never  Never convert message lines ending in <CR><LF>. This setting exists for completeness only.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.9 and later.

sendmail_path (default: see postconf -d output)

       A Sendmail compatibility feature that specifies the location of the  Postfix  sendmail(1)  command.  This
       command can be used to submit mail into the Postfix queue.

service_name (read-only)

       The  master.cf service name of a Postfix daemon process. This can be used to distinguish the logging from
       different services that use the same program name.

       Example master.cf entries:

       # Distinguish inbound MTA logging from submission and smtps logging.
       smtp      inet  n       -       n       -       -       smtpd
       submission inet n       -       n       -       -       smtpd
           -o syslog_name=postfix/$service_name
       smtps     inet  n       -       n       -       -       smtpd
           -o syslog_name=postfix/$service_name

       # Distinguish outbound MTA logging from inbound relay logging.
       smtp      unix  -       -       n       -       -       smtp
       relay     unix  -       -       n       -       -       smtp
           -o syslog_name=postfix/$service_name

service_throttle_time (default: 60s)

       How long the Postfix master(8) waits before forking a server that appears to be malfunctioning.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

setgid_group (default: postdrop)

       The  group  ownership  of  set-gid  Postfix commands and of group-writable Postfix directories. When this
       parameter value is changed you need to re-run "postfix set-permissions" (with  Postfix  version  2.0  and
       earlier: "/etc/postfix/post-install set-permissions".

shlib_directory (default: see 'postconf -d' output)

       The  location  of  Postfix  dynamically-linked  libraries  (libpostfix-*.so), and the default location of
       Postfix database plugins (postfix-*.so) that have a relative pathname in the  dynamicmaps.cf  file.   The
       shlib_directory parameter defaults to "no" when Postfix dynamically-linked libraries and database plugins
       are   disabled   at   compile   time,   otherwise   it   typically   defaults   to   /usr/lib/postfix  or
       /usr/local/lib/postfix.

       Notes:

       •      The directory specified with shlib_directory should contain only  Postfix-related  files.  Postfix
              dynamically-linked  libraries  and  database  plugins should not be installed in a "public" system
              directory such as /usr/lib or /usr/local/lib. Linking Postfix dynamically-linked library files  or
              database plugins into non-Postfix programs is not supported.  Postfix dynamically-linked libraries
              and   database   plugins  implement  a  Postfix-internal  API  that  changes  without  maintaining
              compatibility.

       •      You can change the shlib_directory value after Postfix is built. However,  you  may  have  to  run
              ldconfig  or equivalent to prevent Postfix programs from failing because the libpostfix-*.so files
              are not found.  No ldconfig command is needed  if  you  keep  the  libpostfix-*.so  files  in  the
              compiled-in default $shlib_directory location.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

show_user_unknown_table_name (default: yes)

       Display  the  name  of  the  recipient  table  in  the  "User unknown" responses.  The extra detail makes
       troubleshooting easier but also reveals information that is nobody else's business.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

showq_service_name (default: showq)

       The name of the showq(8) service. This service produces mail queue status reports.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

smtp_address_preference (default: any)

       The address type ("ipv6", "ipv4" or  "any")  that  the  Postfix  SMTP  client  will  try  first,  when  a
       destination  has  IPv6 and IPv4 addresses with equal MX preference. This feature has no effect unless the
       inet_protocols setting enables both IPv4 and IPv6.

       Postfix SMTP client address preference has evolved. With Postfix  2.8  the  default  is  "ipv6";  earlier
       implementations are hard-coded to prefer IPv6 over IPv4.

       Notes for mail delivery between sites that have both IPv4 and IPv6 connectivity:

       •      The setting "smtp_address_preference = ipv6" is unsafe.  It can fail to deliver mail when there is
              an outage that affects IPv6, while the destination is still reachable over IPv4.

       •      The  setting "smtp_address_preference = any" is safe. With this, mail will eventually be delivered
              even if there is an outage that affects IPv6 or IPv4, as long as it does not affect both.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

smtp_address_verify_target (default: rcpt)

       In the context of email address verification, the SMTP protocol stage that determines  whether  an  email
       address  is deliverable.  Specify one of "rcpt" or "data".  The latter is needed with remote SMTP servers
       that reject recipients after the DATA command. Use transport_maps to apply this feature selectively:

           /etc/postfix/main.cf:
               transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport

           /etc/postfix/transport:
               smtp-domain-that-verifies-after-data    smtp-data-target:
               lmtp-domain-that-verifies-after-data    lmtp-data-target:

           /etc/postfix/master.cf:
               smtp-data-target    unix    -    -    n    -    -    smtp
                   -o smtp_address_verify_target=data
               lmtp-data-target    unix    -    -    n    -    -    lmtp
                   -o lmtp_address_verify_target=data

       Unselective use of the "data" target does no harm, but will result in unnecessary "lost connection  after
       DATA" events at remote SMTP/LMTP servers.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

smtp_always_send_ehlo (default: yes)

       Always send EHLO at the start of an SMTP session.

       With  "smtp_always_send_ehlo = no", the Postfix SMTP client sends EHLO only when the word "ESMTP" appears
       in the server greeting banner (example: 220 spike.porcupine.org ESMTP Postfix).

smtp_balance_inet_protocols (default: yes)

       When a remote destination resolves to a combination of IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, ensure that  the  Postfix
       SMTP client can try both address types before it runs into the smtp_mx_address_limit.

       This  avoids  an  interoperability  problem  when a destination resolves to primarily IPv6 addresses, the
       smtp_address_limit feature eliminates most or all IPv4 addresses, and the destination  is  not  reachable
       over IPv6.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.3 and later.

smtp_bind_address (default: empty)

       An  optional  numerical  network  address that the Postfix SMTP client should bind to when making an IPv4
       connection.

       This can be specified in the main.cf file for all SMTP clients, or it can be specified in  the  master.cf
       file for a specific client, for example:

           /etc/postfix/master.cf:
               smtp ... smtp -o smtp_bind_address=11.22.33.44

       See smtp_bind_address_enforce for how Postfix should handle errors (Postfix 3.7 and later).

       Note  1: when inet_interfaces specifies no more than one IPv4 address, and that address is a non-loopback
       address, it is automatically used as the smtp_bind_address.  This supports virtual IP hosting, but can be
       a problem on multi-homed firewalls. See the inet_interfaces documentation for more detail.

       Note 2: address information may be enclosed inside [], but this form is not required here.

smtp_bind_address6 (default: empty)

       An optional numerical network address that the Postfix SMTP client should bind to  when  making  an  IPv6
       connection.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

       This  can  be specified in the main.cf file for all SMTP clients, or it can be specified in the master.cf
       file for a specific client, for example:

           /etc/postfix/master.cf:
               smtp ... smtp -o smtp_bind_address6=1:2:3:4:5:6:7:8

       See smtp_bind_address_enforce for how Postfix should handle errors (Postfix 3.7 and later).

       Note 1: when inet_interfaces specifies no more than one IPv6 address, and that address is a  non-loopback
       address,  it  is automatically used as the smtp_bind_address6.  This supports virtual IP hosting, but can
       be a problem on multi-homed firewalls. See the inet_interfaces documentation for more detail.

       Note 2: address information may be enclosed inside [], but this form is not recommended here.

smtp_bind_address_enforce (default: no)

       Defer delivery when the Postfix SMTP client cannot  apply  the  smtp_bind_address  or  smtp_bind_address6
       setting. By default, the Postfix SMTP client will continue delivery after logging a warning.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.7 and later.

smtp_body_checks (default: empty)

       Restricted  body_checks(5)  tables  for the Postfix SMTP client.  These tables are searched while mail is
       being delivered.  Actions that change the delivery time or destination are not available.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

smtp_cname_overrides_servername (default: version dependent)

       When the remote SMTP servername is a DNS CNAME,  replace  the  servername  with  the  result  from  CNAME
       expansion  for  the  purpose  of  logging, SASL password lookup, TLS policy decisions, or TLS certificate
       verification. The value "no" hardens Postfix  smtp_tls_per_site  hostname-based  policies  against  false
       hostname information in DNS CNAME records, and makes SASL password file lookups more predictable. This is
       the default setting as of Postfix 2.3.

       When  DNS CNAME records are validated with secure DNS lookups (smtp_dns_support_level = dnssec), they are
       always allowed to override the above servername (Postfix 2.11 and later).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2.9 and later.

smtp_connect_timeout (default: 30s)

       The Postfix SMTP client time limit for completing a TCP connection, or zero  (use  the  operating  system
       built-in time limit).

       When no connection can be made within the deadline, the Postfix SMTP client tries the next address on the
       mail exchanger list. Specify 0 to disable the time limit (i.e. use whatever timeout is implemented by the
       operating system).

       Specify  a  non-negative  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies
       the time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default  time
       unit is s (seconds).

smtp_connection_cache_destinations (default: empty)

       Permanently enable SMTP connection caching for the specified destinations.  With SMTP connection caching,
       a  connection  is not closed immediately after completion of a mail transaction.  Instead, the connection
       is kept open for up to $smtp_connection_cache_time_limit seconds.  This allows connections to  be  reused
       for other deliveries, and can improve mail delivery performance.

       Specify a comma or white space separated list of destinations or pseudo-destinations:

       •      if  mail  is  sent  without  a relay host: a domain name (the right-hand side of an email address,
              without the [] around a numeric IP address),

       •      if mail is sent via a relay host: a relay host name (without  []  or  non-default  TCP  port),  as
              specified in main.cf or in the transport map,

       •      if mail is sent via a UNIX-domain socket: a pathname (without the unix: prefix),

       •      a /file/name with domain names and/or relay host names as defined above,

       •      a  "type:table"  with  domain names and/or relay host names on the left-hand side.  The right-hand
              side result from "type:table" lookups is ignored.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_connection_cache_on_demand (default: yes)

       Temporarily enable SMTP connection caching while a destination has a high volume of mail  in  the  active
       queue.   With  SMTP connection caching, a connection is not closed immediately after completion of a mail
       transaction.  Instead, the connection is kept open for up to  $smtp_connection_cache_time_limit  seconds.
       This allows connections to be reused for other deliveries, and can improve mail delivery performance.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_connection_cache_time_limit (default: 2s)

       When  SMTP  connection  caching  is enabled, the amount of time that an unused SMTP client socket is kept
       open before it is closed.  Do not specify larger values without permission from the remote sites.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_connection_reuse_count_limit (default: 0)

       When SMTP connection caching is enabled, the number of times that an SMTP session may be reused before it
       is closed, or zero (no limit).  With a reuse count limit of N, a connection is used up to N+1 times.

       NOTE: This feature is unsafe. When a high-volume destination has multiple inbound MTAs, then the  slowest
       inbound  MTA  will attract the most connections to that destination.  This limitation does not exist with
       the smtp_connection_reuse_time_limit feature.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.11.

smtp_connection_reuse_time_limit (default: 300s)

       The amount of time during which Postfix will use an SMTP connection repeatedly.  The  timer  starts  when
       the  connection is initiated (i.e. it includes the connect, greeting and helo latency, in addition to the
       latencies of subsequent mail delivery transactions).

       This feature addresses a performance stability problem with remote SMTP  servers.  This  problem  is  not
       specific  to  Postfix:  it  can  happen when any MTA sends large amounts of SMTP email to a site that has
       multiple MX hosts.

       The problem starts when one of a set of MX hosts becomes slower than the rest.  Even though SMTP  clients
       connect to fast and slow MX hosts with equal probability, the slow MX host ends up with more simultaneous
       inbound  connections  than  the  faster  MX hosts, because the slow MX host needs more time to serve each
       client request.

       The slow MX host becomes a connection attractor.  If one MX host becomes N times slower than the rest, it
       dominates mail delivery latency unless there are more than N fast MX hosts to counter the effect. And  if
       the  number  of  MX  hosts  is  smaller than N, the mail delivery latency becomes effectively that of the
       slowest MX host divided by the total number of MX hosts.

       The solution uses connection caching in a way that differs from Postfix version  2.2.   By  limiting  the
       amount  of  time  during  which  a  connection  can be used repeatedly (instead of limiting the number of
       deliveries over that connection), Postfix not only restores fairness in the distribution of  simultaneous
       connections across a set of MX hosts, it also favors deliveries over connections that perform well, which
       is exactly what we want.

       The default reuse time limit, 300s, is comparable to the various smtp transaction timeouts which are fair
       estimates  of  maximum  excess  latency  for  a  slow  delivery.  Note that hosts may accept thousands of
       messages over a single connection within the default connection reuse time limit.  This  number  is  much
       larger  than  the  default  Postfix  version 2.2 limit of 10 messages per cached connection. It may prove
       necessary to lower the limit to avoid interoperability issues with  MTAs  that  exhibit  bugs  when  many
       messages  are  delivered  via  a single connection.  A lower reuse time limit risks losing the benefit of
       connection reuse when the average connection and mail delivery latency exceeds the reuse time limit.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_data_done_timeout (default: 600s)

       The Postfix SMTP client time limit for sending the SMTP ".", and for receiving  the  remote  SMTP  server
       response.

       When  no  response  is  received  within the deadline, a warning is logged that the mail may be delivered
       multiple times.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

smtp_data_init_timeout (default: 120s)

       The  Postfix  SMTP client time limit for sending the SMTP DATA command, and for receiving the remote SMTP
       server response.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days),  w  (weeks).   The  default  time  unit  is  s
       (seconds).

smtp_data_xfer_timeout (default: 180s)

       The  Postfix  SMTP  client time limit for sending the SMTP message content.  When the connection makes no
       progress for more than $smtp_data_xfer_timeout seconds the Postfix SMTP client terminates the transfer.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days),  w  (weeks).   The  default  time  unit  is  s
       (seconds).

smtp_defer_if_no_mx_address_found (default: no)

       Defer mail delivery when no MX record resolves to an IP address.

       The  default  (no) is to return the mail as undeliverable. With older Postfix versions the default was to
       keep trying to deliver the mail until someone fixed the MX record or until the mail was too old.

       Note: the Postfix SMTP client always ignores MX records with equal or worse preference than the local MTA
       itself.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtp_delivery_status_filter (default: $default_delivery_status_filter)

       Optional filter for the smtp(8) delivery agent to change the delivery status code or explanatory text  of
       successful or unsuccessful deliveries.  See default_delivery_status_filter for details.

       NOTE:  This  feature  modifies  Postfix  SMTP  client  error or non-error messages that may or may not be
       derived from remote SMTP server responses.  In contrast, the smtp_reply_filter  feature  modifies  remote
       SMTP server responses only.

smtp_destination_concurrency_limit (default: $default_destination_concurrency_limit)

       The  maximal  number  of  parallel  deliveries  to  the  same  destination  via the smtp message delivery
       transport. This limit is enforced by the queue manager. The message delivery transport name is the  first
       field in the entry in the master.cf file.

smtp_destination_recipient_limit (default: $default_destination_recipient_limit)

       The  maximal  number  of  recipients  per  message for the smtp message delivery transport. This limit is
       enforced by the queue manager. The message delivery transport name is the first field in the entry in the
       master.cf file.

       Setting this parameter to a value of 1 changes the  meaning  of  smtp_destination_concurrency_limit  from
       concurrency per domain into concurrency per recipient.

smtp_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps (default: empty)

       Lookup  tables,  indexed  by the remote SMTP server address, with case insensitive lists of EHLO keywords
       (pipelining, starttls, auth, etc.) that the Postfix SMTP client will ignore in the EHLO response  from  a
       remote  SMTP server. See smtp_discard_ehlo_keywords for details. The table is not indexed by hostname for
       consistency with smtpd_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps.

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma. Tables will be searched
       in the specified order until a match is found.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_discard_ehlo_keywords (default: empty)

       A case insensitive list of EHLO keywords (pipelining, starttls, auth, etc.) that the Postfix SMTP  client
       will ignore in the EHLO response from a remote SMTP server.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

       Notes:

       •      Specify the silent-discard pseudo keyword to prevent this action from being logged.

       •      Use the smtp_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps feature to discard EHLO keywords selectively.

smtp_dns_reply_filter (default: empty)

       Optional  filter  for  Postfix  SMTP client DNS lookup results.  Specify zero or more lookup tables.  The
       lookup tables are searched in the given order for a match with the DNS lookup result,  converted  to  the
       following form:

           name ttl class type preference value

       The  class  field  is  always  "IN", the preference field exists only for MX records, the names of hosts,
       domains, etc.  end in ".", and those names are in ASCII form (xn--mumble form in the case of UTF8 names).

       When a match is found, the table lookup result specifies an action.  By default, the table query and  the
       action name are case-insensitive.  Currently, only the IGNORE action is implemented.

       Notes:

       •      Postfix  DNS  reply  filters  have  no  effect  on  implicit  DNS lookups through nsswitch.conf or
              equivalent mechanisms.

       •      The Postfix SMTP/LMTP client uses smtp_dns_reply_filter and lmtp_dns_reply_filter only to discover
              a remote SMTP or LMTP service (record types MX, A, AAAA, and TLSA).  These lookups are  also  made
              to implement the features reject_unverified_sender and reject_unverified_recipient.

       •      The  Postfix SMTP/LMTP client defers mail delivery when a filter removes all lookup results from a
              successful query.

       •      Postfix SMTP server uses smtpd_dns_reply_filter only to look up MX, A, AAAA, and  TXT  records  to
              implement     the     features     reject_unknown_helo_hostname,     reject_unknown_sender_domain,
              reject_unknown_recipient_domain, reject_rbl_*, and reject_rhsbl_*.

       •      The Postfix SMTP server logs a warning or defers mail delivery when a filter  removes  all  lookup
              results from a successful query.

       Example:  ignore  Google  AAAA  records  in  Postfix  SMTP  client  DNS lookups, because Google sometimes
       hard-rejects mail from IPv6 clients with valid PTR etc. records.

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
           smtp_dns_reply_filter = pcre:/etc/postfix/smtp_dns_reply_filter

       /etc/postfix/smtp_dns_reply_filter:
           # /domain ttl IN AAAA address/ action, all case-insensitive.
           # Note: the domain name ends in ".".
           /^\S+\.google\.com\.\s+\S+\s+\S+\s+AAAA\s+/ IGNORE

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

smtp_dns_resolver_options (default: empty)

       DNS Resolver options for the Postfix SMTP client.   Specify  zero  or  more  of  the  following  options,
       separated  by  comma  or whitespace.  Option names are case-sensitive. Some options refer to domain names
       that are specified in the file /etc/resolv.conf or equivalent.

       res_defnames
              Append the current domain name to  single-component  names  (those  that  do  not  contain  a  "."
              character).  This  can  produce incorrect results, and is the hard-coded behavior prior to Postfix
              2.8.

       res_dnsrch
              Search for host names in the current domain and in parent  domains.  This  can  produce  incorrect
              results and is therefore not recommended.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

smtp_dns_support_level (default: empty)

       Level of DNS support in the Postfix SMTP client.  With "smtp_dns_support_level" left at its empty default
       value,  the  legacy  "disable_dns_lookups"  parameter controls whether DNS is enabled in the Postfix SMTP
       client, otherwise the legacy parameter is ignored.

       Specify one of the following:

       disabled
              Disable  DNS  lookups.   No  MX  lookups  are  performed  and  hostname  to  address  lookups  are
              unconditionally  "native".   This  setting  is  not appropriate for hosts that deliver mail to the
              public Internet.   Some  obsolete  how-to  documents  recommend  disabling  DNS  lookups  in  some
              configurations with content_filters.  This is no longer required and strongly discouraged.

       enabled
              Enable  DNS  lookups.   Nexthop  destination  domains  not  enclosed in "[]" will be subject to MX
              lookups.  If "dns" and "native" are included in the "smtp_host_lookup" parameter value,  DNS  will
              be  queried first to resolve MX-host A records, followed by "native" lookups if no answer is found
              in DNS.

       dnssec Enable DNSSEC lookups.  The "dnssec" setting differs from  the  "enabled"  setting  above  in  the
              following ways:

       •      Any MX lookups will set RES_USE_DNSSEC and RES_USE_EDNS0 to request DNSSEC-validated responses. If
              the MX response is DNSSEC-validated the corresponding hostnames are considered validated.

       •      The   address   lookups   of   validated   hostnames  are  also  validated,  (provided  of  course
              "smtp_host_lookup" includes "dns", see below).

       •      Temporary failures in DNSSEC-enabled hostname-to-address resolution block  any  "native"  lookups.
              Additional "native" lookups only happen when DNSSEC lookups hard-fail (NODATA or NXDOMAIN).

       The  Postfix  SMTP  client  considers  non-MX "[nexthop]" and "[nexthop]:port" destinations equivalent to
       statically-validated MX records of the form "nexthop.   IN  MX  0  nexthop."   Therefore,  with  "dnssec"
       support  turned  on, validated hostname-to-address lookups apply to the nexthop domain of any "[nexthop]"
       or  "[nexthop]:port"  destination.   This  is  also  true  for  LMTP  "inet:host"  and   "inet:host:port"
       destinations, as LMTP hostnames are never subject to MX lookups.

       The  "dnssec"  setting  is  recommended only if you plan to use the dane or dane-only TLS security level,
       otherwise enabling DNSSEC support in Postfix offers  no  additional  security.   Postfix  DNSSEC  support
       relies  on  an  upstream  recursive  nameserver that validates DNSSEC signatures.  Such a DNS server will
       always filter out forged DNS responses, even when Postfix itself is not configured to use DNSSEC.

       When using Postfix DANE support the "smtp_host_lookup" parameter should include "dns",  as  DANE  is  not
       applicable to hosts resolved via "native" lookups.

       As  mentioned  above,  Postfix  is  not  a validating stub resolver; it relies on the system's configured
       DNSSEC-validating recursive nameserver  to  perform  all  DNSSEC  validation.   Since  this  nameserver's
       DNSSEC-validated  responses  will  be  fully trusted, it is strongly recommended that the MTA host have a
       local DNSSEC-validating recursive caching nameserver listening on a loopback address, and  be  configured
       to  use only this nameserver for all lookups.  Otherwise, Postfix may remain subject to man-in-the-middle
       attacks that forge responses from the recursive nameserver

       DNSSEC support requires a version of Postfix compiled against a reasonably-modern DNS resolver(3) library
       that implements the RES_USE_DNSSEC and RES_USE_EDNS0 resolver options.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.11 and later.

smtp_enforce_tls (default: no)

       Enforcement mode: require that remote SMTP servers use TLS encryption, and never send mail in the  clear.
       This  also  requires  that  the  remote SMTP server hostname matches the information in the remote server
       certificate, and that the remote SMTP server certificate was issued by  a  CA  that  is  trusted  by  the
       Postfix  SMTP  client.  If  the  certificate  doesn't  verify  or the hostname doesn't match, delivery is
       deferred and mail stays in the queue.

       The server hostname is matched against all names provided as dNSNames in the SubjectAlternativeName.   If
       no  dNSNames  are  specified,  the  CommonName  is  checked.   The  behavior  may  be  changed  with  the
       smtp_tls_enforce_peername option.

       This option is useful only if you are definitely sure that you will only connect to servers that  support
       RFC  2487  _and_  that provide valid server certificates.  Typical use is for clients that send all their
       email to a dedicated mailhub.

       This  feature  is  available  in  Postfix   2.2   and   later.   With   Postfix   2.3   and   later   use
       smtp_tls_security_level instead.

smtp_fallback_relay (default: $fallback_relay)

       Optional  list  of  relay  destinations  that will be used when an SMTP destination is not found, or when
       delivery fails due to a non-permanent error. With Postfix  2.2  and  earlier  this  parameter  is  called
       fallback_relay.

       By default, smtp_fallback_relay is empty, mail is returned to the sender when a destination is not found,
       and delivery is deferred after it fails due to a non-permanent error.

       With  bulk email deliveries, it can be beneficial to run the fallback relay MTA on the same host, so that
       it can reuse the sender IP address.  This speeds up deliveries that are delayed  by  IP-based  reputation
       systems (greylist, etc.).

       The  fallback relays must be SMTP destinations. Specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port, [address]
       or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.  If  you  specify  multiple  SMTP  destinations,
       Postfix will try them in the specified order.

       To  prevent mailer loops between MX hosts and fall-back hosts, Postfix version 2.2 and later will not use
       the fallback relays for destinations that it is MX host for (assuming DNS lookup is turned on).

smtp_generic_maps (default: empty)

       Optional lookup tables that perform address rewriting in the Postfix SMTP client, typically to  transform
       a  locally  valid  address  into a globally valid address when sending mail across the Internet.  This is
       needed when the local machine does not have its  own  Internet  domain  name,  but  uses  something  like
       localdomain.local instead.

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma. Tables will be searched
       in the specified order until a match is found.

       The   table   format   and   lookups   are   documented   in   generic(5);  examples  are  shown  in  the
       ADDRESS_REWRITING_README and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README documents.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_header_checks (default: empty)

       Restricted header_checks(5) tables for the Postfix SMTP client.  These tables are searched while mail  is
       being delivered.  Actions that change the delivery time or destination are not available.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

smtp_helo_name (default: $myhostname)

       The hostname to send in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command.

       The default value is the machine hostname.  Specify a hostname or [ip.add.re.ss].

       This information can be specified in the main.cf file for all SMTP clients, or it can be specified in the
       master.cf file for a specific client, for example:

           /etc/postfix/master.cf:
               mysmtp ... smtp -o smtp_helo_name=foo.bar.com

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

smtp_helo_timeout (default: 300s)

       The  Postfix  SMTP  client time limit for sending the HELO or EHLO command, and for receiving the initial
       remote SMTP server response.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

smtp_host_lookup (default: dns)

       What  mechanisms  the Postfix SMTP client uses to look up a host's IP address.  This parameter is ignored
       when DNS lookups are disabled (see: disable_dns_lookups and smtp_dns_support_level).  The "dns" mechanism
       is always tried before "native" if both are listed.

       Specify one of the following:

       dns    Hosts can be found in the DNS (preferred).

       native Use the native naming service only (nsswitch.conf, or equivalent mechanism).

       dns, native
              Use the native service for hosts not found in the DNS.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtp_line_length_limit (default: 998)

       The maximal length of message header and body lines that Postfix will send via SMTP. This limit does  not
       include the <CR><LF> at the end of each line.  Longer lines are broken by inserting "<CR><LF><SPACE>", to
       minimize the damage to MIME formatted mail. Specify zero to disable this limit.

       The  Postfix  limit  of  998  characters not including <CR><LF> is consistent with the SMTP limit of 1000
       characters including <CR><LF>.  The Postfix limit was 990 with Postfix 2.8 and earlier.

smtp_mail_timeout (default: 300s)

       The Postfix SMTP client time limit for sending the MAIL FROM command, and for receiving the  remote  SMTP
       server response.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

smtp_mime_header_checks (default: empty)

       Restricted mime_header_checks(5) tables for the Postfix SMTP client. These tables are searched while mail
       is being delivered.  Actions that change the delivery time or destination are not available.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

smtp_min_data_rate (default: 500)

       The minimum plaintext data transfer rate in bytes/second for DATA requests, when  deadlines  are  enabled
       with  smtp_per_request_deadline.   After  a write operation transfers N plaintext message bytes (possibly
       after TLS encryption), and after the DATA request deadline is decremented by the  elapsed  time  of  that
       write  operation, the DATA request deadline is incremented by N/smtp_min_data_rate seconds.  However, the
       deadline will never be incremented beyond the time limit specified with smtp_data_xfer_timeout.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.7 and later.

smtp_mx_address_limit (default: 5)

       The maximal number of MX (mail exchanger) IP addresses that can result  from  Postfix  SMTP  client  mail
       exchanger lookups, or zero (no limit). Prior to Postfix version 2.3, this limit was disabled by default.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtp_mx_session_limit (default: 2)

       The  maximal  number  of  SMTP  sessions  per delivery request before the Postfix SMTP client gives up or
       delivers to a fall-back relay host, or zero (no limit). This restriction ignores sessions  that  fail  to
       complete  the  SMTP initial handshake (Postfix version 2.2 and earlier) or that fail to complete the EHLO
       and TLS handshake (Postfix version 2.3 and later).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtp_nested_header_checks (default: empty)

       Restricted nested_header_checks(5) tables for the Postfix SMTP client. These tables  are  searched  while
       mail is being delivered.  Actions that change the delivery time or destination are not available.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

smtp_never_send_ehlo (default: no)

       Never send EHLO at the start of an SMTP session. See also the smtp_always_send_ehlo parameter.

smtp_per_record_deadline (default: no)

       Change  the  behavior of the smtp_*_timeout time limits, from a time limit per read or write system call,
       to a time limit to send or receive a complete record (an SMTP command  line,  SMTP  response  line,  SMTP
       message  content  line, or TLS protocol message).  This limits the impact from hostile peers that trickle
       data one byte at a time.

       Note: when per-record deadlines are enabled, a short timeout may cause problems with TLS over  very  slow
       network  connections.   The  reasons  are  that  a TLS protocol message can be up to 16 kbytes long (with
       TLSv1), and that an entire TLS protocol message must be sent or received within the per-record deadline.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.9-3.6. With older Postfix releases, the behavior  is  as  if  this
       parameter is set to "no". Postfix 3.7 and later use smtp_per_request_deadline.

smtp_per_request_deadline (default: no)

       Change  the  behavior  of  the smtp_*_timeout time limits, from a time limit per plaintext or TLS read or
       write call, to a combined time limit for sending a complete SMTP request and  for  receiving  a  complete
       SMTP  response. The deadline limits only the time spent waiting for plaintext or TLS read or write calls,
       not time spent elsewhere. The per-request deadline limits the impact from hostile peers that trickle data
       one byte at a time.

       See smtp_min_data_rate for how the per-request deadline is managed during the DATA phase.

       Note: when per-request deadlines are enabled, a short time limit may cause problems with  TLS  over  very
       slow  network  connections.  The  reason is that a TLS protocol message can be up to 16 kbytes long (with
       TLSv1), and that an entire TLS protocol message must be transferred within the per-request deadline.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.7 and later. A weaker feature, called smtp_per_record_deadline, is
       available with Postfix 2.9-3.6.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.7 and later.

smtp_pix_workaround_delay_time (default: 10s)

       How long the Postfix SMTP client pauses before sending ".<CR><LF>"  in  order  to  work  around  the  PIX
       firewall "<CR><LF>.<CR><LF>" bug.

       Choosing too short a time makes this workaround ineffective when sending large messages over slow network
       connections.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

smtp_pix_workaround_maps (default: empty)

       Lookup tables, indexed by the remote SMTP server address, with per-destination workarounds for CISCO  PIX
       firewall    bugs.     The    table    is    not    indexed    by    hostname    for    consistency   with
       smtp_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps.

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma. Tables will be searched
       in the specified order until a match is found.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.4 and later.

smtp_pix_workaround_threshold_time (default: 500s)

       How long  a  message  must  be  queued  before  the  Postfix  SMTP  client  turns  on  the  PIX  firewall
       "<CR><LF>.<CR><LF>" bug workaround for delivery through firewalls with "smtp fixup" mode turned on.

       Specify  a  non-negative  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies
       the time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default  time
       unit is s (seconds).

       By  default,  the  workaround  is  turned off for mail that is queued for less than 500 seconds. In other
       words, the workaround is normally turned off for the first delivery attempt.

       Specify 0 to enable the PIX firewall "<CR><LF>.<CR><LF>" bug workaround upon the first delivery attempt.

smtp_pix_workarounds (default: disable_esmtp, delay_dotcrlf)

       A list that specifies zero or more workarounds  for  CISCO  PIX  firewall  bugs.  These  workarounds  are
       implemented  by  the  Postfix SMTP client. Workaround names are separated by comma or space, and are case
       insensitive.  This parameter setting  can  be  overruled  with  per-destination  smtp_pix_workaround_maps
       settings.

       delay_dotcrlf
              Insert  a  delay  before  sending  ".<CR><LF>" after the end of the message content.  The delay is
              subject to the  smtp_pix_workaround_delay_time  and  smtp_pix_workaround_threshold_time  parameter
              settings.

       disable_esmtp
              Disable all extended SMTP commands: send HELO instead of EHLO.

       This  feature  is  available in Postfix 2.4 and later. The default settings are backwards compatible with
       earlier Postfix versions.

smtp_quit_timeout (default: 300s)

       The Postfix SMTP client time limit for sending the QUIT command, and for receiving the remote SMTP server
       response.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

smtp_quote_rfc821_envelope (default: yes)

       Quote  addresses  in  Postfix  SMTP  client  MAIL FROM and RCPT TO commands as required by RFC 5321. This
       includes putting quotes around an address localpart that ends in ".".

       The default is to comply with RFC 5321. If you have to send mail to a broken  SMTP  server,  configure  a
       special SMTP client in master.cf:

           /etc/postfix/master.cf:
               broken-smtp . . . smtp -o smtp_quote_rfc821_envelope=no

       and  route mail for the destination in question to the "broken-smtp" message delivery with a transport(5)
       table.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtp_randomize_addresses (default: yes)

       Randomize the order of equal-preference MX host addresses.  This is a performance feature of the  Postfix
       SMTP client.

smtp_rcpt_timeout (default: 300s)

       The  Postfix  SMTP  client  time limit for sending the SMTP RCPT TO command, and for receiving the remote
       SMTP server response.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

smtp_reply_filter (default: empty)

       A mechanism to transform replies from remote SMTP servers one line at a time.  This is a last-resort tool
       to  work  around  server  replies  that  break interoperability with the Postfix SMTP client.  Other uses
       involve fault injection to test Postfix's handling of invalid responses.

       Notes:

       •      In the case of a multi-line reply, the Postfix SMTP client uses the final reply  line's  numerical
              SMTP reply code and enhanced status code.

       •      The  numerical SMTP reply code (XYZ) takes precedence over the enhanced status code (X.Y.Z).  When
              the enhanced status code initial digit differs from the SMTP reply code initial digit, or when  no
              enhanced  status  code  is  present,  the  Postfix SMTP client uses a generic enhanced status code
              (X.0.0) instead.

       Specify the name of a "type:table" lookup table. The search  string  is  a  single  SMTP  reply  line  as
       received  from  the  remote  SMTP server, except that the trailing <CR><LF> are removed.  When the lookup
       succeeds, the result replaces the single SMTP reply line.

       Examples:

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
           smtp_reply_filter = pcre:/etc/postfix/reply_filter

       /etc/postfix/reply_filter:
           # Transform garbage into "250-filler..." so that it looks like
           # one line from a multi-line reply. It does not matter what we
           # substitute here as long it has the right syntax.  The Postfix
           # SMTP client will use the final line's numerical SMTP reply
           # code and enhanced status code.
           !/^([2-5][0-9][0-9]($|[- ]))/ 250-filler for garbage

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7.

smtp_rset_timeout (default: 20s)

       The Postfix SMTP client time limit for sending the RSET command, and for receiving the remote SMTP server
       response. The SMTP client sends RSET in order to finish a recipient address probe, or to  verify  that  a
       cached session is still usable.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtp_sasl_auth_cache_name (default: empty)

       An optional table to prevent repeated SASL authentication failures  with  the  same  remote  SMTP  server
       hostname,  username  and  password.  Each  table (key, value) pair contains a server name, a username and
       password, and the full server response. This information is stored when a remote SMTP server  rejects  an
       authentication  attempt  with  a 535 reply code.  As long as the smtp_sasl_password_maps information does
       not  change,  and  as  long  as  the  smtp_sasl_auth_cache_name  information   does   not   expire   (see
       smtp_sasl_auth_cache_time)  the  Postfix  SMTP  client  avoids SASL authentication attempts with the same
       server,  username  and  password,  and  instead  bounces  or  defers  mail   as   controlled   with   the
       smtp_sasl_auth_soft_bounce configuration parameter.

       Use  a  per-destination delivery concurrency of 1 (for example, "smtp_destination_concurrency_limit = 1",
       "relay_destination_concurrency_limit = 1", etc.), otherwise multiple delivery  agents  may  experience  a
       login failure at the same time.

       The  table  must  be accessed via the proxywrite service, i.e. the map name must start with "proxy:". The
       table should be stored under the directory specified with the data_directory parameter.

       This feature uses cryptographic hashing to protect plain-text passwords, and  requires  that  Postfix  is
       compiled with TLS support.

       Example:

       smtp_sasl_auth_cache_name = proxy:btree:/var/lib/postfix/sasl_auth_cache

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

smtp_sasl_auth_cache_time (default: 90d)

       The maximal age of an smtp_sasl_auth_cache_name entry before it is removed.

       Specify  a  non-negative  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies
       the time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default  time
       unit is d (days).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

smtp_sasl_auth_enable (default: no)

       Enable  SASL  authentication  in  the  Postfix  SMTP client.  By default, the Postfix SMTP client uses no
       authentication.

       Example:

       smtp_sasl_auth_enable = yes

smtp_sasl_auth_soft_bounce (default: yes)

       When a remote SMTP server rejects a SASL authentication  request  with  a  535  reply  code,  defer  mail
       delivery  instead of returning mail as undeliverable. The latter behavior was hard-coded prior to Postfix
       version 2.5.

       Note: the setting "yes" overrides the global soft_bounce parameter, but the setting "no" does not.

       Example:

       # Default as of Postfix 2.5
       smtp_sasl_auth_soft_bounce = yes
       # The old hard-coded default
       smtp_sasl_auth_soft_bounce = no

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter (default: empty)

       If non-empty, a Postfix SMTP client filter for the remote SMTP server's list of offered SASL  mechanisms.
       Different  client  and  server  implementations  may  support  different mechanism lists; by default, the
       Postfix SMTP client will use  the  intersection  of  the  two.  smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter  specifies  an
       optional third mechanism list to intersect with.

       Specify  mechanism names, "/file/name" patterns or "type:table" lookup tables. The right-hand side result
       from "type:table" lookups is ignored. Specify "!pattern" to exclude a mechanism name from the  list.  The
       form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

       Examples:

       smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter = plain, login
       smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter = /etc/postfix/smtp_mechs
       smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter = !gssapi, !login, static:rest

smtp_sasl_password_maps (default: empty)

       Optional  Postfix  SMTP client lookup tables with one username:password entry per sender, remote hostname
       or next-hop domain. Per-sender lookup is done only when sender-dependent authentication is  enabled.   If
       no username:password entry is found, then the Postfix SMTP client will not attempt to authenticate to the
       remote host.

       The Postfix SMTP client opens the lookup table before going to chroot jail, so you can leave the password
       file in /etc/postfix.

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma. Tables will be searched
       in the specified order until a match is found.

smtp_sasl_path (default: empty)

       Implementation-specific  information  that  the  Postfix  SMTP  client passes through to the SASL plug-in
       implementation  that  is  selected  with  smtp_sasl_type.   Typically  this  specifies  the  name  of   a
       configuration file or rendezvous point.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_sasl_security_options (default: noplaintext, noanonymous)

       Postfix  SMTP  client  SASL security options; as of Postfix 2.3 the list of available features depends on
       the SASL client implementation that is selected with smtp_sasl_type.

       The following security features are defined for the cyrus client SASL implementation:

       Specify zero or more of the following:

       noplaintext
              Disallow methods that use plaintext passwords.

       noactive
              Disallow methods subject to active (non-dictionary) attack.

       nodictionary
              Disallow methods subject to passive (dictionary) attack.

       noanonymous
              Disallow methods that allow anonymous authentication.

       mutual_auth
              Only allow methods that provide mutual authentication (not available with SASL version 1).

       Example:

       smtp_sasl_security_options = noplaintext

smtp_sasl_tls_security_options (default: $smtp_sasl_security_options)

       The SASL authentication security options that the  Postfix  SMTP  client  uses  for  TLS  encrypted  SMTP
       sessions.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_sasl_tls_verified_security_options (default: $smtp_sasl_tls_security_options)

       The  SASL  authentication  security  options  that  the  Postfix  SMTP client uses for TLS encrypted SMTP
       sessions with a verified server certificate.

       When mail is sent to the public MX host for the recipient's domain, server certificates  are  by  default
       optional,  and  delivery  proceeds  even if certificate verification fails. For delivery via a submission
       service that requires SASL authentication, it may be appropriate to send plaintext  passwords  only  when
       the connection to the server is strongly encrypted and the server identity is verified.

       The  smtp_sasl_tls_verified_security_options  parameter  makes  it  possible  to  only  enable  plaintext
       mechanisms when a secure connection to the server is available. Submission servers subject to this policy
       must either have verifiable certificates or offer suitable non-plaintext SASL mechanisms.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

smtp_sasl_type (default: cyrus)

       The SASL plug-in type that the Postfix SMTP client should use for authentication.   The  available  types
       are listed with the "postconf -A" command.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_send_dummy_mail_auth (default: no)

       Whether  or  not  to  append  the  "AUTH=<>"  option  to the MAIL FROM command in SASL-authenticated SMTP
       sessions. The default is not to send this, to avoid problems with broken  remote  SMTP  servers.   Before
       Postfix 2.9 the behavior is as if "smtp_send_dummy_mail_auth = yes".

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.9 and later.

smtp_send_xforward_command (default: no)

       Send  the  non-standard  XFORWARD  command  when the Postfix SMTP server EHLO response announces XFORWARD
       support.

       This allows a Postfix SMTP delivery agent, used for injecting mail into a content filter, to forward  the
       name, address, protocol and HELO name of the original client to the content filter and downstream queuing
       SMTP server. This can produce more useful logging than localhost[127.0.0.1] etc.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtp_sender_dependent_authentication (default: no)

       Enable  sender-dependent  authentication  in  the  Postfix  SMTP client; this is available only with SASL
       authentication, and disables SMTP connection caching to ensure that mail from different senders will  use
       the appropriate credentials.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_skip_4xx_greeting (default: yes)

       Skip SMTP servers that greet with a 4XX status code (go away, try again later).

       By  default, the Postfix SMTP client moves on the next mail exchanger.  Specify "smtp_skip_4xx_greeting =
       no" if Postfix should defer delivery immediately.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and earlier.  Later Postfix versions  always  skip  remote  SMTP
       servers that greet with a 4XX status code.

smtp_skip_5xx_greeting (default: yes)

       Skip remote SMTP servers that greet with a 5XX status code.

       By  default,  the Postfix SMTP client moves on the next mail exchanger. Specify "smtp_skip_5xx_greeting =
       no" if Postfix should bounce the mail immediately. Caution: the latter behavior appears to contradict RFC
       2821.

smtp_skip_quit_response (default: yes)

       Do not wait for the response to the SMTP QUIT command.

smtp_starttls_timeout (default: 300s)

       Time limit for Postfix SMTP client write and read operations during TLS startup  and  shutdown  handshake
       procedures.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tcp_port (default: smtp)

       The default TCP port that the Postfix SMTP client connects to.  Specify a symbolic name (see services(5))
       or a numeric port.

smtp_tls_CAfile (default: empty)

       A file containing CA certificates of root CAs trusted to sign either remote SMTP server  certificates  or
       intermediate  CA  certificates.  These are loaded into memory before the smtp(8) client enters the chroot
       jail. If the number of trusted roots is large, consider using smtp_tls_CApath instead, but note that  the
       latter directory must be present in the chroot jail if the smtp(8) client is chrooted. This file may also
       be  used  to  augment  the  client  certificate  trust  chain, but it is best to include all the required
       certificates directly in $smtp_tls_cert_file (or, Postfix >= 3.4 $smtp_tls_chain_files).

       Specify "smtp_tls_CAfile = /path/to/system_CA_file" to use ONLY the system-supplied default Certification
       Authority certificates.

       Specify "tls_append_default_CA = no" to prevent Postfix from appending the  system-supplied  default  CAs
       and trusting third-party certificates.

       Example:

       smtp_tls_CAfile = /etc/postfix/CAcert.pem

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_CApath (default: empty)

       Directory  with  PEM  format  Certification  Authority  certificates that the Postfix SMTP client uses to
       verify a remote SMTP server certificate.  Don't forget to create the necessary  "hash"  links  with,  for
       example, "$OPENSSL_HOME/bin/c_rehash /etc/postfix/certs".

       To use this option in chroot mode, this directory (or a copy) must be inside the chroot jail.

       Specify  "smtp_tls_CApath  =  /path/to/system_CA_directory"  to  use  ONLY  the  system-supplied  default
       Certification Authority certificates.

       Specify "tls_append_default_CA = no" to prevent Postfix from appending the  system-supplied  default  CAs
       and trusting third-party certificates.

       Example:

       smtp_tls_CApath = /etc/postfix/certs

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_block_early_mail_reply (default: no)

       Try  to  detect  a  mail hijacking attack based on a TLS protocol vulnerability (CVE-2009-3555), where an
       attacker prepends malicious HELO, MAIL, RCPT, DATA commands to a Postfix SMTP client  TLS  session.   The
       attack  would  succeed  with  non-Postfix SMTP servers that reply to the malicious HELO, MAIL, RCPT, DATA
       commands after negotiating the Postfix SMTP client TLS session.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7.

smtp_tls_cert_file (default: empty)

       File with the Postfix SMTP client RSA certificate in PEM format.  This file may also contain the  Postfix
       SMTP client private RSA key, and these may be the same as the Postfix SMTP server RSA certificate and key
       file.   With  Postfix  >=  3.4  the  preferred  way  to configure client keys and certificates is via the
       "smtp_tls_chain_files" parameter.

       Do not configure client certificates unless you must present client  TLS  certificates  to  one  or  more
       servers.  Client  certificates are not usually needed, and can cause problems in configurations that work
       well without them. The recommended setting is to let the defaults stand:

           smtp_tls_cert_file =
           smtp_tls_key_file =
           smtp_tls_eccert_file =
           smtp_tls_eckey_file =
           # Obsolete DSA parameters
           smtp_tls_dcert_file =
           smtp_tls_dkey_file =
           # Postfix >= 3.4 interface
           smtp_tls_chain_files =

       The best way to use the default settings is to comment out the above parameters in main.cf if present.

       To enable remote SMTP servers to verify the Postfix SMTP client certificate, the issuing CA  certificates
       must  be  made  available  to  the  server.  You  should  include the required certificates in the client
       certificate file, the client certificate first, then the issuing CA(s) (bottom-up order).

       Example: the certificate for "client.example.com" was issued by "intermediate  CA"  which  itself  has  a
       certificate issued by "root CA".  As the "root" super-user create the client.pem file with:

           # umask 077
           # cat client_key.pem client_cert.pem intermediate_CA.pem > chain.pem

       If  you  also  want  to  verify  remote  SMTP server certificates issued by these CAs, you can add the CA
       certificates  to  the  smtp_tls_CAfile,  in  which  case  it  is  not  necessary  to  have  them  in  the
       smtp_tls_cert_file, smtp_tls_dcert_file (obsolete) or smtp_tls_eccert_file.

       A  certificate  supplied  here  must  be  usable as an SSL client certificate and hence pass the "openssl
       verify -purpose sslclient ..." test.

       Example:

       smtp_tls_cert_file = /etc/postfix/chain.pem

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_chain_files (default: empty)

       List of one or more PEM files, each holding one or more private keys directly followed by a corresponding
       certificate chain.  The file names are separated by commas and/or whitespace.  This  parameter  obsoletes
       the  legacy  algorithm-specific key and certificate file settings.  When this parameter is non-empty, the
       legacy parameters are ignored, and a warning is logged if any are also non-empty.

       With the proliferation of multiple private  key  algorithms-which,  as  of  OpenSSL  1.1.1,  include  DSA
       (obsolete),  RSA,  ECDSA,  Ed25519 and Ed448-it is increasingly impractical to use separate parameters to
       configure the key and certificate chain for each algorithm.   Therefore,  Postfix  now  supports  storing
       multiple keys and corresponding certificate chains in a single file or in a set of files.

       Each  key must appear immediately before the corresponding certificate, optionally followed by additional
       issuer certificates that complete the certificate chain for that key.  When multiple files are specified,
       they are equivalent to a single file that is concatenated from those files in  the  given  order.   Thus,
       while  a  key must always precede its certificate and issuer chain, it can be in a separate file, so long
       as that file is listed immediately before the file that holds the corresponding certificate chain.   Once
       all  the files are concatenated, the sequence of PEM objects must be: key1, cert1, [chain1], key2, cert2,
       [chain2], ..., keyN, certN, [chainN].

       Storing the private key in the same file as the corresponding certificate is more reliable.  With the key
       and certificate in separate files, there is a chance that during key rollover  a  Postfix  process  might
       load  a private key and certificate from separate files that don't match.  Various operational errors may
       even result in a persistent broken configuration in which the certificate does not match the private key.

       The file or files must contain at most one key of each type.  If, for example, two or more RSA  keys  and
       corresponding  chains  are  listed,  depending on the version of OpenSSL either only the last one will be
       used or a configuration error may be detected.  Note that while  "Ed25519"  and  "Ed448"  are  considered
       separate  algorithms,  the various ECDSA curves (typically one of prime256v1, secp384r1 or secp521r1) are
       considered as different parameters of a single "ECDSA" algorithm, so it  is  not  presently  possible  to
       configure keys for more than one ECDSA curve.

       Example (separate files for each key and corresponding certificate chain):

           /etc/postfix/main.cf:
               smtp_tls_chain_files =
                   ${config_directory}/ed25519.pem,
                   ${config_directory}/ed448.pem,
                   ${config_directory}/rsa.pem

           /etc/postfix/ed25519.pem:
               -----BEGIN PRIVATE KEY-----
               MC4CAQAwBQYDK2VwBCIEIEJfbbO4BgBQGBg9NAbIJaDBqZb4bC4cOkjtAH+Efbz3
               -----END PRIVATE KEY-----
               -----BEGIN CERTIFICATE-----
               MIIBKzCB3qADAgECAhQaw+rflRreYuUZBp0HuNn/e5rMZDAFBgMrZXAwFDESMBAG
               ...
               nC0egv51YPDWxEHom4QA

               -----END CERTIFICATE-----
           /etc/postfix/ed448.pem:
               -----BEGIN PRIVATE KEY-----
               MEcCAQAwBQYDK2VxBDsEOQf+m0P+G0qi+NZ0RolyeiE5zdlPQR8h8y4jByBifpIe
               LNler7nzHQJ1SLcOiXFHXlxp/84VZuh32A==
               -----END PRIVATE KEY-----
               -----BEGIN CERTIFICATE-----
               MIIBdjCB96ADAgECAhQSv4oP972KypOZPNPF4fmsiQoRHzAFBgMrZXEwFDESMBAG
               ...
               pQcWsx+4J29e6YWH3Cy/CdUaexKP4RPCZDrPX7bk5C2BQ+eeYOxyThMA

               -----END CERTIFICATE-----
           /etc/postfix/rsa.pem:
               -----BEGIN PRIVATE KEY-----
               MIIEvQIBADANBgkqhkiG9w0BAQEFAASCBKcwggSjAgEAAoIBAQDc4QusgkahH9rL
               ...
               ahQkZ3+krcaJvDSMgvu0tDc=
               -----END PRIVATE KEY-----
               -----BEGIN CERTIFICATE-----
               MIIC+DCCAeCgAwIBAgIUIUkrbk1GAemPCT8i9wKsTGDH7HswDQYJKoZIhvcNAQEL
               ...
               Rirz15HGVNTK8wzFd+nulPzwUo6dH2IU8KazmyRi7OGvpyrMlm15TRE2oyE=

               -----END CERTIFICATE-----
       Example (all keys and certificates in a single file):

           /etc/postfix/main.cf:
               smtp_tls_chain_files = ${config_directory}/chains.pem

           /etc/postfix/chains.pem:
               -----BEGIN PRIVATE KEY-----
               MC4CAQAwBQYDK2VwBCIEIEJfbbO4BgBQGBg9NAbIJaDBqZb4bC4cOkjtAH+Efbz3
               -----END PRIVATE KEY-----
               -----BEGIN CERTIFICATE-----
               MIIBKzCB3qADAgECAhQaw+rflRreYuUZBp0HuNn/e5rMZDAFBgMrZXAwFDESMBAG
               ...
               nC0egv51YPDWxEHom4QA
               -----END CERTIFICATE-----
               -----BEGIN PRIVATE KEY-----
               MEcCAQAwBQYDK2VxBDsEOQf+m0P+G0qi+NZ0RolyeiE5zdlPQR8h8y4jByBifpIe
               LNler7nzHQJ1SLcOiXFHXlxp/84VZuh32A==
               -----END PRIVATE KEY-----
               -----BEGIN CERTIFICATE-----
               MIIBdjCB96ADAgECAhQSv4oP972KypOZPNPF4fmsiQoRHzAFBgMrZXEwFDESMBAG
               ...
               pQcWsx+4J29e6YWH3Cy/CdUaexKP4RPCZDrPX7bk5C2BQ+eeYOxyThMA
               -----END CERTIFICATE-----
               -----BEGIN PRIVATE KEY-----
               MIIEvQIBADANBgkqhkiG9w0BAQEFAASCBKcwggSjAgEAAoIBAQDc4QusgkahH9rL
               ...
               ahQkZ3+krcaJvDSMgvu0tDc=
               -----END PRIVATE KEY-----
               -----BEGIN CERTIFICATE-----
               MIIC+DCCAeCgAwIBAgIUIUkrbk1GAemPCT8i9wKsTGDH7HswDQYJKoZIhvcNAQEL
               ...
               Rirz15HGVNTK8wzFd+nulPzwUo6dH2IU8KazmyRi7OGvpyrMlm15TRE2oyE=

               -----END CERTIFICATE-----
       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

smtp_tls_cipherlist (default: empty)

       Obsolete  Postfix  <  2.3 control for the Postfix SMTP client TLS cipher list. As this feature applies to
       all TLS security levels, it is easy to create interoperability problems by choosing a non-default  cipher
       list.  Do  not  use a non-default TLS cipher list on hosts that deliver email to the public Internet: you
       will be unable to send email to servers that only support the ciphers you  exclude.  Using  a  restricted
       cipher  list  may  be more appropriate for an internal MTA, where one can exert some control over the TLS
       software and settings of the peer servers.

       Note: do not use "" quotes around the parameter value.

       This feature is available in Postfix version 2.2. It  is  not  used  with  Postfix  2.3  and  later;  use
       smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers instead.

smtp_tls_ciphers (default: medium)

       The  minimum  TLS  cipher  grade that the Postfix SMTP client will use with opportunistic TLS encryption.
       Cipher types listed in smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers are excluded from the base  definition  of  the  selected
       cipher grade.   The default value is "medium" for Postfix releases after the middle of 2015, "export" for
       older releases.

       When  TLS  is  mandatory  the  cipher  grade  is  chosen via the smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers configuration
       parameter, see there for syntax details. See smtp_tls_policy_maps for information  on  how  to  configure
       ciphers on a per-destination basis.

       This   feature  is  available  in  Postfix  2.6  and  later.  With  earlier  Postfix  releases  only  the
       smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers parameter is implemented, and opportunistic TLS always uses "export" or better
       (i.e. all) ciphers.

smtp_tls_connection_reuse (default: no)

       Try to make multiple deliveries per TLS-encrypted connection.   This  uses  the  tlsproxy(8)  service  to
       encrypt  an SMTP connection, uses the scache(8) service to save that connection, and relies on hints from
       the qmgr(8) daemon.

       See "Client-side TLS connection reuse" for background details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

smtp_tls_dane_insecure_mx_policy (default: see postconf -d output)

       The TLS policy for MX hosts with "secure" TLSA records when the nexthop  destination  security  level  is
       dane, but the MX record was found via an "insecure" MX lookup.  The choices are:

       may    The  TLSA  records  will  be  ignored and TLS will be optional.  If the MX host does not appear to
              support STARTTLS, or the STARTTLS handshake fails, mail may be sent in the clear.

       encrypt
              The TLSA records will signal a requirement to use TLS.  While TLS  encryption  will  be  required,
              authentication will not be performed.

       dane   The  TLSA records will be used just as with "secure" MX records.  TLS encryption will be required,
              and, if at least one of the TLSA records is  "usable",  authentication  will  be  required.   When
              authentication  succeeds, it will be logged only as "Trusted", not "Verified", because the MX host
              name could have been forged.
              The default setting for Postfix >= 3.6 is "dane" with "smtp_tls_security_level = dane",  otherwise
              "may".  This  behavior  was  backported  to  Postfix versions 3.5.9, 3.4.19, 3.3.16. 3.2.21.  With
              earlier Postfix versions the default setting was always "dane".

       Though with "insecure" MX records an active attacker can compromise SMTP transport security by  returning
       forged  MX  records,  such attacks are "tamper-evident" since any forged MX hostnames will be recorded in
       the mail logs.  Attackers who place a high value on staying  hidden  may  be  deterred  from  forging  MX
       records.

       This  feature  is available in Postfix 3.1 and later. The may policy is backwards-compatible with earlier
       Postfix versions.

smtp_tls_dcert_file (default: empty)

       File with the Postfix SMTP client DSA certificate in PEM format.  This file may also contain the  Postfix
       SMTP client private DSA key.  The DSA algorithm is obsolete and should not be used.

       See the discussion under smtp_tls_cert_file for more details.

       Example:

       smtp_tls_dcert_file = /etc/postfix/client-dsa.pem

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_dkey_file (default: $smtp_tls_dcert_file)

       File  with  the  Postfix  SMTP  client DSA private key in PEM format.  This file may be combined with the
       Postfix SMTP client DSA certificate file  specified  with  $smtp_tls_dcert_file.  The  DSA  algorithm  is
       obsolete and should not be used.

       The private key must be accessible without a pass-phrase, i.e. it must not be encrypted. File permissions
       should grant read-only access to the system superuser account ("root"), and no access to anyone else.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_eccert_file (default: empty)

       File  with  the  Postfix  SMTP  client  ECDSA  certificate in PEM format.  This file may also contain the
       Postfix SMTP client ECDSA private key.  With Postfix >= 3.4 the preferred way to  configure  client  keys
       and certificates is via the "smtp_tls_chain_files" parameter.

       See the discussion under smtp_tls_cert_file for more details.

       Example:

       smtp_tls_eccert_file = /etc/postfix/ecdsa-ccert.pem

       This  feature  is  available  in  Postfix 2.6 and later, when Postfix is compiled and linked with OpenSSL
       1.0.0 or later.

smtp_tls_eckey_file (default: $smtp_tls_eccert_file)

       File with the Postfix SMTP client ECDSA private key in PEM format.  This file may be  combined  with  the
       Postfix SMTP client ECDSA certificate file specified with $smtp_tls_eccert_file.  With Postfix >= 3.4 the
       preferred way to configure client keys and certificates is via the "smtp_tls_chain_files" parameter.

       The private key must be accessible without a pass-phrase, i.e. it must not be encrypted. File permissions
       should grant read-only access to the system superuser account ("root"), and no access to anyone else.

       This  feature  is  available  in  Postfix 2.6 and later, when Postfix is compiled and linked with OpenSSL
       1.0.0 or later.

smtp_tls_enforce_peername (default: yes)

       With mandatory TLS encryption, require that the remote SMTP server hostname matches  the  information  in
       the  remote  SMTP  server  certificate.   As  of  RFC 2487 the requirements for hostname checking for MTA
       clients are not specified.

       This option can be set to "no" to disable strict peer name  checking.  This  setting  has  no  effect  on
       sessions that are controlled via the smtp_tls_per_site table.

       Disabling the hostname verification can make sense in a closed environment where special CAs are created.
       If  not  used  carefully, this option opens the danger of a "man-in-the-middle" attack (the CommonName of
       this attacker will be logged).

       This  feature  is  available  in  Postfix   2.2   and   later.   With   Postfix   2.3   and   later   use
       smtp_tls_security_level instead.

smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers (default: empty)

       List  of  ciphers or cipher types to exclude from the Postfix SMTP client cipher list at all TLS security
       levels. This is not an OpenSSL cipherlist, it is a simple list separated by whitespace and/or commas. The
       elements are a single cipher, or one or more "+" separated cipher properties, in which case only  ciphers
       matching all the properties are excluded.

       Examples (some of these will cause problems):

           smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers = aNULL
           smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers = MD5, DES
           smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers = DES+MD5
           smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers = AES256-SHA, DES-CBC3-MD5
           smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers = kEDH+aRSA

       The  first  setting disables anonymous ciphers. The next setting disables ciphers that use the MD5 digest
       algorithm or the (single) DES encryption algorithm. The next setting disables ciphers that  use  MD5  and
       DES  together.   The  next  setting  disables  the  two ciphers "AES256-SHA" and "DES-CBC3-MD5". The last
       setting disables ciphers that use "EDH" key exchange with RSA authentication.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_tls_fingerprint_cert_match (default: empty)

       List of acceptable remote SMTP server certificate fingerprints for the "fingerprint" TLS  security  level
       (smtp_tls_security_level  = fingerprint). At this security level, Certification Authorities are not used,
       and certificate expiration times are ignored. Instead, server  certificates  are  verified  directly  via
       their  certificate  fingerprint  or  public key fingerprint (Postfix 2.9 and later). The fingerprint is a
       message digest of the server certificate (or public key).  The  digest  algorithm  is  selected  via  the
       smtp_tls_fingerprint_digest parameter.

       The  colons  between  each  pair of nibbles in the fingerprint value are optional (Postfix >= 3.6). These
       were required in earlier Postfix releases.

       When an smtp_tls_policy_maps  table  entry  specifies  the  "fingerprint"  security  level,  any  "match"
       attributes  in  that  entry  specify  the  list  of valid fingerprints for the corresponding destination.
       Multiple fingerprints can be combined with a "|" delimiter in a single match attribute, or multiple match
       attributes can be employed.

       Example: Certificate fingerprint verification with  internal  mailhub.   Two  matching  fingerprints  are
       listed.  The  relayhost  may  be  multiple  physical  hosts  behind  a  load-balancer,  each with its own
       private/public key and self-signed certificate. Alternatively, a single relayhost may be in  the  process
       of  switching from one set of private/public keys to another, and both keys are trusted just prior to the
       transition.

           relayhost = [mailhub.example.com]
           smtp_tls_security_level = fingerprint
           smtp_tls_fingerprint_digest = sha256
           smtp_tls_fingerprint_cert_match =
               cd:fc:d8:db:f8:c4:82:96:6c:...:28:71:e8:f5:8d:a5:0d:9b:d4:a6
               dd:5c:ef:f5:c3:bc:64:25:36:...:99:36:06:ce:40:ef:de:2e:ad:a4

       Example: Certificate fingerprint verification with selected destinations.  As in the  example  above,  we
       show two matching fingerprints:

           /etc/postfix/main.cf:
               smtp_tls_policy_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/tls_policy
               smtp_tls_fingerprint_digest = sha256

           /etc/postfix/tls_policy:
               example.com fingerprint
                   match=51:e9:af:2e:1e:40:1f:...:64:0a:30:35:2d:09:16:31:5a:eb:82:76
                   match=b6:b4:72:34:e2:59:cd:...:c2:ca:63:0d:4d:cc:2c:7d:84:de:e6:2f

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

smtp_tls_fingerprint_digest (default: see postconf -d output)

       The  message  digest  algorithm  used  to  construct  remote SMTP server certificate fingerprints. At the
       "fingerprint" TLS security level (smtp_tls_security_level  =  fingerprint),  the  server  certificate  is
       verified  by directly matching its certificate fingerprint or its public key fingerprint (Postfix 2.9 and
       later). The fingerprint is the message digest of the server certificate (or its  public  key)  using  the
       selected  algorithm.  With a digest algorithm resistant to "second pre-image" attacks, it is not feasible
       to create a new public key and a matching certificate (or public/private  key-pair)  that  has  the  same
       fingerprint.

       The  default  algorithm  is  sha256 with Postfix >= 3.6 and the compatibility_level set to 3.6 or higher.
       With Postfix <= 3.5, the default algorithm is md5.

       The best-practice algorithm is now sha256. Recent advances in hash function cryptanalysis have led to md5
       and sha1 being deprecated in favor of sha256.  However, as long as there are no known "second  pre-image"
       attacks  against the older algorithms, their use in this context, though not recommended, is still likely
       safe.

       While additional digest algorithms are often available with  OpenSSL's  libcrypto,  only  those  used  by
       libssl  in  SSL cipher suites are available to Postfix.  You'll likely find support for md5, sha1, sha256
       and sha512.

       To find the fingerprint of a specific certificate file, with a specific digest algorithm, run:

           $ openssl x509 -noout -fingerprint -digest -in certfile.pem

       The text to the right of the "=" sign is the desired fingerprint.  For example:

           $ openssl x509 -noout -fingerprint -sha256 -in cert.pem
           SHA256 Fingerprint=D4:6A:AB:19:24:...:BB:A6:CB:66:82:C0:8E:9B:EE:29:A8:1A

       To extract the public key fingerprint from an X.509 certificate, you need to extract the public key  from
       the  certificate  and  compute  the  appropriate  digest  of  its  DER (ASN.1) encoding. With OpenSSL the
       "-pubkey" option of the "x509" command extracts the public key always in "PEM" format. We pipe the result
       to another OpenSSL command that converts the key to DER and then to the "dgst"  command  to  compute  the
       fingerprint.

       The  actual  command  to  transform  the  key to DER format depends on the version of OpenSSL used. As of
       OpenSSL 1.0.0, the "pkey" command supports all key types.

           # OpenSSL >= 1.0 with SHA-256 fingerprints.
           $ openssl x509 -in cert.pem -noout -pubkey |
               openssl pkey -pubin -outform DER |
               openssl dgst -sha256 -c
           (stdin)= 64:3f:1f:f6:e5:1e:d4:2a:56:...:fc:09:1a:61:98:b5:bc:7c:60:58

       The Postfix SMTP server and client log the  peer  (leaf)  certificate  fingerprint  and  the  public  key
       fingerprint when the TLS loglevel is 2 or higher.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

smtp_tls_force_insecure_host_tlsa_lookup (default: no)

       Lookup the associated DANE TLSA RRset even when a hostname is not an alias and its address records lie in
       an unsigned zone.  This is unlikely to ever yield DNSSEC validated results, since child zones of unsigned
       zones  are  also  unsigned  in  the  absence  of  DLV  or  locally configured non-root trust-anchors.  We
       anticipate that such mechanisms will not be used for just the "_tcp" subdomain of  a  host.   Suppressing
       the TLSA RRset lookup reduces latency and avoids potential interoperability problems with nameservers for
       unsigned zones that are not prepared to handle the new TLSA RRset.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.11.

smtp_tls_key_file (default: $smtp_tls_cert_file)

       File  with  the  Postfix  SMTP  client RSA private key in PEM format.  This file may be combined with the
       Postfix SMTP client RSA certificate file specified with $smtp_tls_cert_file.  With  Postfix  >=  3.4  the
       preferred way to configure client keys and certificates is via the "smtp_tls_chain_files" parameter.

       The private key must be accessible without a pass-phrase, i.e. it must not be encrypted. File permissions
       should grant read-only access to the system superuser account ("root"), and no access to anyone else.

       Example:

       smtp_tls_key_file = $smtp_tls_cert_file

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_loglevel (default: 0)

       Enable  additional  Postfix  SMTP  client  logging of TLS activity.  Each logging level also includes the
       information that is logged at a lower logging level.

              0 Disable logging of TLS activity.

              1 Log only a summary message on TLS handshake completion  -  no  logging  of  remote  SMTP  server
              certificate  trust-chain  verification  errors if server certificate verification is not required.
              With Postfix 2.8 and  earlier,  log  the  summary  message  and  unconditionally  log  trust-chain
              verification errors.

              2 Also log levels during TLS negotiation.

              3 Also log the hexadecimal and ASCII dump of the TLS negotiation process.

              4 Also log the hexadecimal and ASCII dump of complete transmission after STARTTLS.

       Do  not  use  "smtp_tls_loglevel = 2" or higher except in case of problems. Use of loglevel 4 is strongly
       discouraged.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers (default: medium)

       The minimum TLS cipher grade that the Postfix SMTP client will use with mandatory  TLS  encryption.   The
       default  value  "medium" is suitable for most destinations with which you may want to enforce TLS, and is
       beyond the reach of today's cryptanalytic methods. See smtp_tls_policy_maps for  information  on  how  to
       configure ciphers on a per-destination basis.

       The following cipher grades are supported:

       high   Enable  only "HIGH" grade OpenSSL ciphers.  This setting may be appropriate when all mandatory TLS
              destinations (e.g. when all mail is routed to a suitably capable relayhost) support at  least  one
              "HIGH"   grade  cipher.  The  underlying  cipherlist  is  specified  via  the  tls_high_cipherlist
              configuration parameter, which you are strongly encouraged not to change.

       medium Enable "MEDIUM" grade or better OpenSSL ciphers.  The underlying cipherlist is specified  via  the
              tls_medium_cipherlist configuration parameter, which you are strongly encouraged not to change.

       null   Enable  only  the  "NULL"  OpenSSL ciphers, these provide authentication without encryption.  This
              setting is only appropriate in the rare case that all servers are prepared  to  use  NULL  ciphers
              (not  normally  enabled  in  TLS  servers).  A plausible use-case is an LMTP server listening on a
              UNIX-domain socket that is configured to support "NULL"  ciphers.  The  underlying  cipherlist  is
              specified  via  the tls_null_cipherlist configuration parameter, which you are strongly encouraged
              not to change.

       low    Enable "LOW" grade or stronger OpenSSL ciphers.  In Postfix >= 3.8 this  cipher  grade  is  always
              identical  to  "medium".   Recent  versions of OpenSSL do not support any "LOW" grade ciphers.  In
              earlier Postfix releases the  underlying  cipherlist  was  specified  via  the  tls_low_cipherlist
              configuration  parameter,  which  you are strongly encouraged not to change.  This obsolete cipher
              grade SHOULD NOT be used.

       export Enable "EXPORT" grade or stronger OpenSSL ciphers.  In Postfix >= 3.8 this cipher grade is  always
              identical  to "medium".  Recent versions of OpenSSL do not support any "EXPORT" grade ciphers.  In
              earlier Postfix releases the underlying cipherlist was  specified  via  the  tls_export_cipherlist
              configuration  parameter,  which  you are strongly encouraged not to change.  This obsolete cipher
              grade SHOULD NOT be used.

       The underlying cipherlists for grades  other  than  "null"  include  anonymous  ciphers,  but  these  are
       automatically  filtered  out if the Postfix SMTP client is configured to verify server certificates.  You
       are very unlikely to need to take any steps to exclude anonymous ciphers, they are excluded automatically
       as necessary.  If you must exclude anonymous ciphers at the "may" or "encrypt" security levels, when  the
       Postfix  SMTP  client  does not need or use peer certificates, set "smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers = aNULL". To
       exclude anonymous ciphers only when TLS is enforced, set "smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers = aNULL".

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers (default: empty)

       Additional list of ciphers or cipher types to exclude  from  the  Postfix  SMTP  client  cipher  list  at
       mandatory   TLS   security   levels.   This  list  works  in  addition  to  the  exclusions  listed  with
       smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers (see there for syntax details).

       Starting with Postfix 2.6, the mandatory cipher exclusions can be specified on  a  per-destination  basis
       via the TLS policy "exclude" attribute. See smtp_tls_policy_maps for notes and examples.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols (default: see postconf -d output)

       TLS protocols that the Postfix SMTP client will use with mandatory TLS encryption.  In main.cf the values
       are  separated  by  whitespace,  commas  or  colons.  In  the  policy  table  "protocols"  attribute (see
       smtp_tls_policy_maps) the only valid separator is colon. An empty value means allow all protocols.

       The valid protocol names (see SSL_get_version(3)) are "SSLv2", "SSLv3", "TLSv1", "TLSv1.1", "TLSv1.2" and
       "TLSv1.3".  Starting with Postfix 3.6, the default value is ">=TLSv1", which sets TLS 1.0 as  the  lowest
       supported  TLS protocol version (see below).  Older releases use the "!" exclusion syntax, also described
       below.

       As of Postfix 3.6, the preferred way to limit the range of  acceptable  protocols  is  to  set  a  lowest
       acceptable TLS protocol version and/or a highest acceptable TLS protocol version.  To set the lower bound
       include  an  element  of  the  form:  ">=version" where version is a either one of the TLS protocol names
       listed above, or a hexadecimal number corresponding to the desired TLS protocol  version  (0301  for  TLS
       1.0, 0302 for TLS 1.1, etc.).  For the upper bound, use "<=version".  There must be no whitespace between
       the ">=" or "<=" symbols and the protocol name or number.

       Hexadecimal  protocol numbers make it possible to specify protocol bounds for TLS versions that are known
       to OpenSSL, but might not be known to Postfix.  They cannot be used with  the  legacy  exclusion  syntax.
       Leading  "0"  or  "0x"  prefixes  are supported, but not required.  Therefore, "301", "0301", "0x301" and
       "0x0301" are all equivalent to "TLSv1".  Hexadecimal versions unknown to OpenSSL will  fail  to  set  the
       upper  or  lower  bound,  and  a  warning  will be logged.  Hexadecimal versions should only be used when
       Postfix is linked with some future version of OpenSSL that supports TLS 1.4 or later,  but  Postfix  does
       not yet support a symbolic name for that protocol version.

       Hexadecimal example (Postfix >= 3.6):

           # Allow only TLS 1.2 through (hypothetical) TLS 1.4, once supported
           # in some future version of OpenSSL (presently a warning is logged).
           smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols = >=TLSv1.2, <=0305
           # Allow only TLS 1.2 and up:
           smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols = >=0x0303

       With  Postfix  <  3.6  there  is  no  support for a minimum or maximum version, and the protocol range is
       configured via protocol exclusions.  To require at least TLS  1.0,  set  "smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols  =
       !SSLv2,  !SSLv3".  Listing  the protocols to include, rather than the protocols to exclude, is supported,
       but not recommended.  The exclusion syntax more accurately matches the underlying OpenSSL interface.

       When using the exclusion syntax, take care to ensure that the range of protocols supported by the Postfix
       SMTP client is contiguous.  When a protocol version is enabled, disabling any higher  version  implicitly
       disables all versions above that higher version.  Thus, for example:

           smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols = !SSLv2, !SSLv3, !TLSv1.1

       also disables any protocol versions higher than TLSv1.1 leaving only "TLSv1" enabled.

       Support  for  "TLSv1.3"  was  introduced  in  OpenSSL  1.1.1.   Disabling this protocol via "!TLSv1.3" is
       supported since Postfix 3.4 (or patch releases >= 3.0.14, 3.1.10, 3.2.7 and 3.3.2).

       While the vast majority of SMTP servers with DANE TLSA records now support at least TLS 1.2, a few  still
       only  support  TLS 1.0.  If you use "dane" or "dane-only" it is best not to disable TLSv1, except perhaps
       via the policy table for destinations which you are sure will support "TLSv1.2".

       See the documentation of the smtp_tls_policy_maps parameter and TLS_README  for  more  information  about
       security levels.

       Example:
       # Preferred syntax with Postfix >= 3.6:
       smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols = >=TLSv1.2, <=TLSv1.3
       # Legacy syntax:
       smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols = !SSLv2, !SSLv3, !TLSv1, !TLSv1.1

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_tls_note_starttls_offer (default: no)

       Log  the  hostname of a remote SMTP server that offers STARTTLS, when TLS is not already enabled for that
       server.

       The logfile record looks like:

       postfix/smtp[pid]:  Host offered STARTTLS: [name.of.host]

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_per_site (default: empty)

       Optional lookup tables with the Postfix SMTP client TLS usage  policy  by  next-hop  destination  and  by
       remote  SMTP  server hostname.  When both lookups succeed, the more specific per-site policy (NONE, MUST,
       etc.) overrides the less specific one (MAY), and the more secure per-site policy (MUST,  etc.)  overrides
       the  less  secure  one (NONE).  With Postfix 2.3 and later smtp_tls_per_site is strongly discouraged: use
       smtp_tls_policy_maps instead.

       Use of the bare hostname as the per-site table lookup key is discouraged. Always use the full destination
       nexthop (enclosed in [] with a possible ":port" suffix).  A  recipient  domain  or  MX-enabled  transport
       next-hop with no port suffix may look like a bare hostname, but is still a suitable destination.

       Specify  a  next-hop  destination or server hostname on the left-hand side; no wildcards are allowed. The
       next-hop destination is either the recipient domain, or the destination  specified  with  a  transport(5)
       table,  the relayhost parameter, or the relay_transport parameter.  On the right hand side specify one of
       the following keywords:

       NONE   Don't use TLS at all. This overrides a less specific MAY lookup result from the alternate host  or
              next-hop   lookup   key,   and   overrides   the   global   smtp_use_tls,   smtp_enforce_tls,  and
              smtp_tls_enforce_peername settings.

       MAY    Try to use TLS if the server announces support, otherwise use an unencrypted connection. This  has
              less  precedence  than a more specific result (including NONE) from the alternate host or next-hop
              lookup key, and has less precedence than the more specific  global  "smtp_enforce_tls  =  yes"  or
              "smtp_tls_enforce_peername = yes".

       MUST_NOPEERMATCH
              Require  TLS  encryption,  but  do  not  require  that the remote SMTP server hostname matches the
              information in the remote SMTP server certificate, or that the server certificate was issued by  a
              trusted  CA.  This  overrides  a  less  secure  NONE or a less specific MAY lookup result from the
              alternate host or next-hop lookup key, and overrides the global smtp_use_tls, smtp_enforce_tls and
              smtp_tls_enforce_peername settings.

       MUST   Require TLS encryption, require that the remote SMTP server hostname matches  the  information  in
              the remote SMTP server certificate, and require that the remote SMTP server certificate was issued
              by  a  trusted  CA.  This  overrides a less secure NONE or MUST_NOPEERMATCH or a less specific MAY
              lookup result  from  the  alternate  host  or  next-hop  lookup  key,  and  overrides  the  global
              smtp_use_tls, smtp_enforce_tls and smtp_tls_enforce_peername settings.

       The  above  keywords  correspond to the "none", "may", "encrypt" and "verify" security levels for the new
       smtp_tls_security_level parameter introduced in Postfix 2.3. Starting with Postfix 2.3, and independently
       of  how  the  policy  is  specified,  the  smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers  and   smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols
       parameters apply when TLS encryption is mandatory. Connections for which encryption is optional typically
       enable all "export" grade and better ciphers (see smtp_tls_ciphers and smtp_tls_protocols).

       As  long  as  no  secure  DNS lookup mechanism is available, false hostnames in MX or CNAME responses can
       change the server hostname that Postfix uses for TLS policy lookup and server  certificate  verification.
       Even  with  a perfect match between the server hostname and the server certificate, there is no guarantee
       that Postfix is connected to the right server.  See TLS_README (Closing  a  DNS  loophole  with  obsolete
       per-site TLS policies) for a possible work-around.

       This  feature  is available in Postfix 2.2 and later. With Postfix 2.3 and later use smtp_tls_policy_maps
       instead.

smtp_tls_policy_maps (default: empty)

       Optional lookup tables with the Postfix SMTP client TLS security policy by next-hop destination;  when  a
       non-empty  value  is  specified, this overrides the obsolete smtp_tls_per_site parameter.  See TLS_README
       for a more detailed discussion of TLS security levels.

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma. Tables will be searched
       in the specified order until a match is found.

       The TLS policy table is indexed by the full next-hop destination, which is either the  recipient  domain,
       or  the  verbatim  next-hop  specified  in  the  transport  table,  $local_transport, $virtual_transport,
       $relay_transport or $default_transport. This includes any enclosing square brackets and  any  non-default
       destination  server  port  suffix.  The  LMTP  socket type prefix (inet: or unix:) is not included in the
       lookup key.

       Only the next-hop domain, or $myhostname with LMTP over UNIX-domain sockets, is used as the nexthop  name
       for  certificate  verification.  The  port and any enclosing square brackets are used in the table lookup
       key, but are not used for server name verification.

       When the lookup key is a domain name without enclosing square brackets or any :port suffix (typically the
       recipient domain), and the full domain is not found in the table, just as with  the  transport(5)  table,
       the  parent  domain  starting  with  a  leading  "." is matched recursively. This allows one to specify a
       security policy for a recipient domain and all its sub-domains.

       The lookup result is a security level, followed by an optional list of whitespace and/or comma  separated
       name=value  attributes  that  override  related  main.cf  settings.  The  TLS security levels in order of
       increasing security are:

       none   No TLS. No additional attributes are supported at this level.

       may    Opportunistic TLS. Since sending in the clear is acceptable, demanding stronger than  default  TLS
              security  merely  reduces  interoperability.  The  optional  "ciphers", "exclude", and "protocols"
              attributes (available for opportunistic TLS with Postfix >= 2.6) and "connection_reuse"  attribute
              (Postfix     >=     3.4)     override    the    "smtp_tls_ciphers",    "smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers",
              "smtp_tls_protocols", and "smtp_tls_connection_reuse"  configuration  parameters.  In  the  policy
              table,  multiple  ciphers, protocols or excluded ciphers must be separated by colons, as attribute
              values may not contain whitespace or commas.  When  opportunistic  TLS  handshakes  fail,  Postfix
              retries   the   connection   with   TLS  disabled.   This  allows  mail  delivery  to  sites  with
              non-interoperable TLS implementations.

       encrypt
              Mandatory TLS encryption. At this level and higher, the optional "protocols"  attribute  overrides
              the main.cf smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols parameter, the optional "ciphers" attribute overrides the
              main.cf  smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers  parameter,  the optional "exclude" attribute (Postfix >= 2.6)
              overrides   the   main.cf   smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers   parameter,   and   the   optional
              "connection_reuse"  attribute  (Postfix  >=  3.4)  overrides the main.cf smtp_tls_connection_reuse
              parameter. In the policy table, multiple ciphers, protocols or excluded ciphers must be  separated
              by colons, as attribute values may not contain whitespace or commas.

       dane   Opportunistic  DANE  TLS.   The  TLS  policy  for  the destination is obtained via TLSA records in
              DNSSEC.  If no TLSA records are found, the effective security level used is may.  If TLSA  records
              are found, but none are usable, the effective security level is encrypt.  When usable TLSA records
              are  obtained for the remote SMTP server, the server certificate must match the TLSA records.  RFC
              7672 (DANE) TLS authentication and DNSSEC support is available with Postfix 2.11  and  later.  The
              optional    "connection_reuse"    attribute    (Postfix    >=    3.4)    overrides   the   main.cf
              smtp_tls_connection_reuse parameter.  When the effective security level used is may, the  optional
              "ciphers", "exclude", and "protocols" attributes (Postfix >= 2.6) override the "smtp_tls_ciphers",
              "smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers", and "smtp_tls_protocols" configuration parameters.  When the effective
              security  level  used  is  encrypt,  the optional "ciphers", "exclude", and "protocols" attributes
              (Postfix >= 2.6) override the "smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers",  "smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers",
              and "smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols" configuration parameters.

       dane-only
              Mandatory  DANE  TLS.   The TLS policy for the destination is obtained via TLSA records in DNSSEC.
              If no TLSA records are found, or none are usable, no connection  is  made  to  the  server.   When
              usable TLSA records are obtained for the remote SMTP server, the server certificate must match the
              TLSA  records.   RFC  7672  (DANE) TLS authentication and DNSSEC support is available with Postfix
              2.11 and later. The optional "ciphers", "exclude", and "protocols"  attributes  (Postfix  >=  2.6)
              override     the     "smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers",    "smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers",    and
              "smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols" configuration parameters. The optional "connection_reuse" attribute
              (Postfix >= 3.4) overrides the main.cf smtp_tls_connection_reuse parameter.

       fingerprint
              Certificate fingerprint verification. Available with Postfix  2.5  and  later.  At  this  security
              level,  there  are  no  trusted Certification Authorities. The certificate trust chain, expiration
              date, ... are  not  checked.  Instead,  the  optional  "match"  attribute,  or  else  the  main.cf
              smtp_tls_fingerprint_cert_match  parameter,  lists  the certificate fingerprints or the public key
              fingerprint (Postfix 2.9 and later) of the valid server certificate. The digest algorithm used  to
              calculate  the  fingerprint  is  selected  by  the smtp_tls_fingerprint_digest parameter. Multiple
              fingerprints can be combined with a "|" delimiter in a single match attribute, or  multiple  match
              attributes can be employed. The ":" character is not used as a delimiter as it occurs between each
              pair  of  fingerprint  (hexadecimal)  digits.  The  optional "ciphers", "exclude", and "protocols"
              attributes     (Postfix     >=      2.6)      override      the      "smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers",
              "smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers", and "smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols" configuration parameters.
              The   optional   "connection_reuse"   attribute   (Postfix   >=   3.4)   overrides   the   main.cf
              smtp_tls_connection_reuse parameter.

       verify Mandatory TLS verification.  At this security level, DNS MX  lookups  are  trusted  to  be  secure
              enough,  and  the  name  verified  in  the  server  certificate is usually obtained indirectly via
              unauthenticated  DNS  MX  lookups.   The  optional  "match"  attribute   overrides   the   main.cf
              smtp_tls_verify_cert_match  parameter. In the policy table, multiple match patterns and strategies
              must be separated by colons.  In practice explicit control over matching is more common  with  the
              "secure"  policy,  described  below. The optional "ciphers", "exclude", and "protocols" attributes
              (Postfix >= 2.6) override the "smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers",  "smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers",
              and  "smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols"  configuration  parameters.  The  optional  "connection_reuse"
              attribute (Postfix >= 3.4) overrides the main.cf smtp_tls_connection_reuse parameter.

       secure Secure-channel TLS. At this security level, DNS MX lookups, though potentially used  to  determine
              the  candidate next-hop gateway IP addresses, are not trusted to be secure enough for TLS peername
              verification. Instead, the default name verified in the server certificate  is  obtained  directly
              from  the  next-hop, or is explicitly specified via the optional "match" attribute which overrides
              the main.cf smtp_tls_secure_cert_match parameter. In the policy table, multiple match patterns and
              strategies must be separated by colons.  The match attribute is most useful when multiple  domains
              are supported by a common server: the policy entries for additional domains specify matching rules
              for  the  primary  domain  certificate.  While  transport table overrides that route the secondary
              domains to the primary nexthop also allow secure verification, they risk  delivery  to  the  wrong
              destination  when  domains  change  hands  or  are  re-assigned  to new gateways. With the "match"
              attribute approach, routing is not perturbed, and mail is deferred if verification  of  a  new  MX
              host  fails.  The  optional  "ciphers",  "exclude",  and  "protocols"  attributes (Postfix >= 2.6)
              override    the    "smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers",     "smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers",     and
              "smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols" configuration parameters. The optional "connection_reuse" attribute
              (Postfix >= 3.4) overrides the main.cf smtp_tls_connection_reuse parameter.

       Example:

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
           smtp_tls_policy_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/tls_policy
           # Postfix 2.5 and later.
           #
           # The default digest is sha256 with Postfix >= 3.6 and
           # compatibility level >= 3.
           #
           smtp_tls_fingerprint_digest = sha256

       /etc/postfix/tls_policy:
           example.edu                 none
           example.mil                 may
           example.gov                 encrypt protocols=TLSv1
           example.com                 verify ciphers=high
           example.net                 secure
           .example.net                secure match=.example.net:example.net
           [mail.example.org]:587      secure match=nexthop
           # Postfix 2.5 and later
           [thumb.example.org]          fingerprint
               match=b6:b4:72:34:e2:59:cd:...:c2:ca:63:0d:4d:cc:2c:7d:84:de:e6:2f
               match=51:e9:af:2e:1e:40:1f:...:64:0a:30:35:2d:09:16:31:5a:eb:82:76

       Note:  The "hostname" strategy if listed in a non-default setting of smtp_tls_secure_cert_match or in the
       "match" attribute in the policy table can render the "secure" level vulnerable to DNS forgery. Do not use
       the "hostname" strategy for secure-channel configurations in  environments  where  DNS  security  is  not
       assured.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_tls_protocols (default: see postconf -d output)

       TLS  protocols  that  the Postfix SMTP client will use with opportunistic TLS encryption.  In main.cf the
       values are separated by whitespace, commas or colons. In the  policy  table  "protocols"  attribute  (see
       smtp_tls_policy_maps) the only valid separator is colon.  An empty value means allow all protocols.

       The valid protocol names (see SSL_get_version(3)) are "SSLv2", "SSLv3", "TLSv1", "TLSv1.1", "TLSv1.2" and
       "TLSv1.3".   Starting  with Postfix 3.6, the default value is ">=TLSv1", which sets TLS 1.0 as the lowest
       supported TLS protocol version (see below).  Older releases use the "!" exclusion syntax, also  described
       below.

       As  of  Postfix  3.6,  the  preferred way to limit the range of acceptable protocols is to set the lowest
       acceptable TLS protocol version and/or the highest acceptable TLS protocol version.   To  set  the  lower
       bound  include  an element of the form: ">=version" where version is either one of the TLS protocol names
       listed above, or a hexadecimal number corresponding to the desired TLS protocol  version  (0301  for  TLS
       1.0, 0302 for TLS 1.1, etc.).  For the upper bound, use "<=version".  There must be no whitespace between
       the ">=" or "<=" symbols and the protocol name or number.

       Hexadecimal  protocol numbers make it possible to specify protocol bounds for TLS versions that are known
       to OpenSSL, but might not be known to Postfix.  They cannot be used with  the  legacy  exclusion  syntax.
       Leading  "0"  or  "0x"  prefixes  are supported, but not required.  Therefore, "301", "0301", "0x301" and
       "0x0301" are all equivalent to "TLSv1".  Hexadecimal versions unknown to OpenSSL will  fail  to  set  the
       upper  or  lower  bound,  and  a  warning  will be logged.  Hexadecimal versions should only be used when
       Postfix is linked with some future version of OpenSSL that supports TLS 1.4 or later,  but  Postfix  does
       not yet support a symbolic name for that protocol version.

       Hexadecimal example (Postfix >= 3.6):

           # Allow only TLS 1.0 through (hypothetical) TLS 1.4, once supported
           # in some future version of OpenSSL (presently a warning is logged).
           smtp_tls_protocols = >=TLSv1, <=0305
           # Allow only TLS 1.0 and up:
           smtp_tls_protocols = >=0x0301

       With  Postfix  <  3.6  there  is  no  support for a minimum or maximum version, and the protocol range is
       configured via protocol exclusions.  To require at least  TLS  1.0,  set  "smtp_tls_protocols  =  !SSLv2,
       !SSLv3".   Listing  the  protocols  to  include,  rather than protocols to exclude, is supported, but not
       recommended.  The exclusion form more accurately matches the underlying OpenSSL interface.

       When using the exclusion syntax, take care to ensure that the range of protocols advertised by an SSL/TLS
       client is contiguous.  When a protocol version  is  enabled,  disabling  any  higher  version  implicitly
       disables all versions above that higher version.  Thus, for example:

           smtp_tls_protocols = !SSLv2, !SSLv3, !TLSv1.1
       also disables any protocols version higher than TLSv1.1 leaving only "TLSv1" enabled.

       Support  for  "TLSv1.3"  was  introduced  in  OpenSSL  1.1.1.   Disabling this protocol via "!TLSv1.3" is
       supported since Postfix 3.4 (or patch releases >= 3.0.14, 3.1.10, 3.2.7 and 3.3.2).

       Example:
       # Preferred syntax with Postfix >= 3.6:
       smtp_tls_protocols = >=TLSv1, <=TLSv1.3
       # Legacy syntax:
       smtp_tls_protocols = !SSLv2, !SSLv3

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

smtp_tls_scert_verifydepth (default: 9)

       The verification depth for remote SMTP server certificates. A depth of 1 is sufficient if the issuing  CA
       is listed in a local CA file.

       The  default  verification  depth  is  9  (the  OpenSSL  default)  for compatibility with earlier Postfix
       behavior. Prior to Postfix 2.5, the default value was 5, but the limit was not actually enforced. If  you
       have set this to a lower non-default value, certificates with longer trust chains may now fail to verify.
       Certificate chains with 1 or 2 CAs are common, deeper chains are more rare and any number between 5 and 9
       should  suffice  in  practice.  You  can  choose  a  lower number if, for example, you trust certificates
       directly signed by an issuing CA but not any CAs it delegates to.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_secure_cert_match (default: nexthop, dot-nexthop)

       How the Postfix SMTP client verifies the server certificate peername for the "secure" TLS security level.
       In a "secure" TLS policy table ($smtp_tls_policy_maps) entry the  optional  "match"  attribute  overrides
       this main.cf setting.

       This  parameter  specifies  one or more patterns or strategies separated by commas, whitespace or colons.
       In the policy table the only valid separator is the colon character.

       For a description of the pattern and strategy syntax see the  smtp_tls_verify_cert_match  parameter.  The
       "hostname"  strategy  should  be avoided in this context, as in the absence of a secure global DNS, using
       the results of MX lookups in certificate verification is not immune to active (man-in-the-middle) attacks
       on DNS.

       Sample main.cf setting:

           smtp_tls_secure_cert_match = nexthop

       Sample policy table override:

           example.net     secure match=example.com:.example.com
           .example.net    secure match=example.com:.example.com

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_tls_security_level (default: empty)

       The default SMTP TLS security level for the Postfix SMTP client.  When a non-empty  value  is  specified,
       this  overrides  the  obsolete  parameters smtp_use_tls, smtp_enforce_tls, and smtp_tls_enforce_peername;
       when no value is specified for smtp_tls_enforce_peername or the obsolete parameters, the default SMTP TLS
       security level is none.

       Specify one of the following security levels:

       none   No TLS. TLS will not be used unless enabled for specific destinations via smtp_tls_policy_maps.

       may    Opportunistic TLS. Use TLS if  this  is  supported  by  the  remote  SMTP  server,  otherwise  use
              plaintext.  Since sending in the clear is acceptable, demanding stronger than default TLS security
              merely reduces interoperability.  The "smtp_tls_ciphers" and "smtp_tls_protocols" (Postfix >= 2.6)
              configuration  parameters  provide  control  over  the  protocols  and  cipher  grade  used   with
              opportunistic  TLS.   With  earlier releases the opportunistic TLS cipher grade is always "export"
              and no protocols are disabled.  When TLS handshakes fail,  the  connection  is  retried  with  TLS
              disabled.  This allows mail delivery to sites with non-interoperable TLS implementations.

       encrypt
              Mandatory  TLS  encryption.  Since a minimum level of security is intended, it is reasonable to be
              specific about sufficiently secure protocol versions and  ciphers.  At  this  security  level  and
              higher, the main.cf parameters smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols and smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers specify
              the  TLS  protocols  and  minimum cipher grade which the administrator considers secure enough for
              mandatory encrypted sessions. This security level  is  not  an  appropriate  default  for  systems
              delivering mail to the Internet.

       dane   Opportunistic  DANE  TLS.   At this security level, the TLS policy for the destination is obtained
              via DNSSEC.  For TLSA policy to be in effect, the destination domain's containing DNS zone must be
              signed and the Postfix SMTP client's operating system must be configured to send its  DNS  queries
              to  a  recursive  DNS  nameserver that is able to validate the signed records.  Each MX host's DNS
              zone should also be signed, and should publish DANE TLSA (RFC 7672) records that specify how  that
              MX  host's TLS certificate is to be verified.  TLSA records do not preempt the normal SMTP MX host
              selection algorithm, if some MX hosts support TLSA and others do not, TLS security will vary  from
              delivery  to  delivery.   It  is  up to the domain owner to configure their MX hosts and their DNS
              sensibly.  To configure the Postfix SMTP client for DNSSEC lookups see the documentation  for  the
              smtp_dns_support_level  main.cf  parameter.   When DNSSEC-validated TLSA records are not found the
              effective tls security level is "may".  When TLSA records are found,  but  are  all  unusable  the
              effective  security level is "encrypt".  For purposes of protocol and cipher selection, the "dane"
              security level is treated like a "mandatory" TLS security level, and weak  ciphers  and  protocols
              are  disabled.   Since  DANE  authenticates  server  certificates  the  "aNULL"  cipher-suites are
              transparently excluded at this level, no need to configure this manually.   RFC  7672  (DANE)  TLS
              authentication is available with Postfix 2.11 and later.

       dane-only
              Mandatory  DANE  TLS.   This  is just like "dane" above, but DANE TLSA authentication is required.
              There is no fallback to "may" or "encrypt" when TLSA records are missing or  unusable.   RFC  7672
              (DANE) TLS authentication is available with Postfix 2.11 and later.

       fingerprint
              Certificate  fingerprint verification.  At this security level, there are no trusted Certification
              Authorities.  The certificate trust chain, expiration date, etc., are not  checked.  Instead,  the
              smtp_tls_fingerprint_cert_match   parameter  lists  the  certificate  fingerprint  or  public  key
              fingerprint (Postfix 2.9 and later) of the valid server certificate. The digest algorithm used  to
              calculate the fingerprint is selected by the smtp_tls_fingerprint_digest parameter. Available with
              Postfix 2.5 and later.

       verify Mandatory  TLS  verification.  At  this  security  level,  DNS MX lookups are trusted to be secure
              enough, and the name verified in  the  server  certificate  is  usually  obtained  indirectly  via
              unauthenticated  DNS  MX lookups. The smtp_tls_verify_cert_match parameter controls how the server
              name is verified. In practice explicit control over matching is more common at the "secure" level,
              described below. This security level is not an appropriate default for systems delivering mail  to
              the Internet.

       secure Secure-channel  TLS.  At this security level, DNS MX lookups, though potentially used to determine
              the candidate next-hop gateway IP addresses, are not trusted to be secure enough for TLS  peername
              verification.  Instead,  the  default name verified in the server certificate is obtained from the
              next-hop domain as  specified  in  the  smtp_tls_secure_cert_match  configuration  parameter.  The
              default  matching  rule  is  that  a  server certificate matches when its name is equal to or is a
              sub-domain of the nexthop domain. This security level is not an appropriate  default  for  systems
              delivering mail to the Internet.

       Examples:

       # No TLS. Formerly: smtp_use_tls=no and smtp_enforce_tls=no.
       smtp_tls_security_level = none

       # Opportunistic TLS.
       smtp_tls_security_level = may
       # Do not tweak opportunistic ciphers or protocols unless it is essential
       # to do so (if a security vulnerability is found in the SSL library that
       # can be mitigated by disabling a particular protocol or raising the
       # cipher grade).
       smtp_tls_ciphers = medium
       smtp_tls_protocols = >=TLSv1
       # Legacy (Postfix < 3.6) syntax:
       smtp_tls_protocols = !SSLv2, !SSLv3

       # Mandatory (high-grade) TLS encryption.
       smtp_tls_security_level = encrypt
       smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers = high

       # Authenticated TLS 1.2 or better matching the nexthop domain or a
       # subdomain.
       smtp_tls_security_level = secure
       smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers = high
       smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols = >=TLSv1.2
       smtp_tls_secure_cert_match = nexthop, dot-nexthop

       # Certificate fingerprint verification (Postfix >= 2.5).
       # The CA-less "fingerprint" security level only scales to a limited
       # number of destinations. As a global default rather than a per-site
       # setting, this is practical only when mail for all recipients is sent
       # to a central mail hub.
       relayhost = [mailhub.example.com]
       smtp_tls_security_level = fingerprint
       smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols = >=TLSv1.2
       smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers = high
       smtp_tls_fingerprint_cert_match =
           3D:95:34:51:...:40:99:C0:C1
           EC:3B:2D:B0:...:A3:9D:72:F6

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_tls_servername (default: empty)

       Optional  name  to send to the remote SMTP server in the TLS Server Name Indication (SNI) extension.  The
       SNI extension is always on when DANE is used to authenticate the server, and in that case  the  SNI  name
       sent is the one required by RFC7672 and this parameter is ignored.

       Some  SMTP servers use the received SNI name to select an appropriate certificate chain to present to the
       client.  While this may improve interoperability with such servers, it may reduce  interoperability  with
       other servers that choose to abort the connection when they don't have a certificate chain configured for
       the  requested  name.  Such servers should select a default certificate chain and continue the handshake,
       but some may not.  Therefore, absent DANE, no SNI name is sent by default.

       The SNI name must be either a valid DNS hostname, or else one of the special values hostname or  nexthop,
       which select either the remote hostname or the nexthop domain respectively.  DNS names for SNI must be in
       A-label  (punycode)  form.   Invalid  DNS  names  log  a configuration error warning and mail delivery is
       deferred.

       Except when using a relayhost to forward all email, the only sensible non-empty main.cf setting for  this
       parameter  is  hostname.   Other  non-empty  values are only practical on a per-destination basis via the
       servername attribute of the Postfix TLS policy table.  When in doubt, leave  this  parameter  empty,  and
       configure per-destination SNI as needed.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

smtp_tls_session_cache_database (default: empty)

       Name  of  the file containing the optional Postfix SMTP client TLS session cache. Specify a database type
       that supports enumeration, such as btree or sdbm; there is no need to  support  concurrent  access.   The
       file is created if it does not exist. The smtp(8) daemon does not use this parameter directly, rather the
       cache  is  implemented  indirectly  in  the tlsmgr(8) daemon. This means that per-smtp-instance master.cf
       overrides of this parameter are not effective.  Note that  each  of  the  cache  databases  supported  by
       tlsmgr(8)  daemon:  $smtpd_tls_session_cache_database, $smtp_tls_session_cache_database (and with Postfix
       2.3 and later $lmtp_tls_session_cache_database), needs to be stored separately. It is not  at  this  time
       possible to store multiple caches in a single database.

       Note: dbm databases are not suitable. TLS session objects are too large.

       As  of version 2.5, Postfix no longer uses root privileges when opening this file. The file should now be
       stored under the Postfix-owned data_directory. As a migration aid, an attempt to open the  file  under  a
       non-Postfix directory is redirected to the Postfix-owned data_directory, and a warning is logged.

       Example:

       smtp_tls_session_cache_database = btree:/var/lib/postfix/smtp_scache

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_session_cache_timeout (default: 3600s)

       The  expiration  time of Postfix SMTP client TLS session cache information.  A cache cleanup is performed
       periodically every $smtp_tls_session_cache_timeout  seconds.  As  with  $smtp_tls_session_cache_database,
       this parameter is implemented in the tlsmgr(8) daemon and therefore per-smtp-instance master.cf overrides
       are not possible.

       As  of  Postfix  2.11 this setting cannot exceed 100 days.  If set <= 0, session caching is disabled.  If
       set to a positive value less than 2 minutes, the minimum value of 2 minutes is used instead.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_trust_anchor_file (default: empty)

       Zero or more PEM-format files with trust-anchor certificates and/or public keys.  If the parameter is not
       empty the root CAs in CAfile and CApath are no longer trusted.  Rather, the Postfix SMTP client will only
       trust certificate-chains signed by one of the trust-anchors contained in the chosen files.  The specified
       trust-anchor  certificates  and  public keys are not subject to expiration, and need not be (self-signed)
       root CAs.  They may, if desired, be intermediate certificates. Therefore, these certificates also may  be
       found  "in  the middle" of the trust chain presented by the remote SMTP server, and any untrusted issuing
       parent certificates will be ignored.  Specify a list of pathnames separated by comma or whitespace.

       Whether specified in main.cf, or on a per-destination basis, the trust-anchor PEM file must be accessible
       to the Postfix SMTP client in the chroot jail if applicable.  The trust-anchor file should  contain  only
       certificates  and  public  keys,  no  private  key  material,  and must be readable by the non-privileged
       $mail_owner user.  This allows destinations to be bound to a set of specific CAs or public  keys  without
       trusting the same CAs for all destinations.

       The main.cf parameter supports single-purpose Postfix installations that send mail to a fixed set of SMTP
       peers.  At most sites, if trust-anchor files are used at all, they will be specified on a per-destination
       basis via the "tafile" attribute of the "verify" and "secure" levels in smtp_tls_policy_maps.

       The  underlying  mechanism  is  in  support of RFC 7672 (DANE TLSA), which defines mechanisms for an SMTP
       client MTA to securely determine server TLS certificates via DNS.

       If you want your trust anchors to be public keys, with OpenSSL you can extract a single  PEM  public  key
       from a PEM X.509 file containing a single certificate, as follows:

           $ openssl x509 -in cert.pem -out ta-key.pem -noout -pubkey

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.11 and later.

smtp_tls_verify_cert_match (default: hostname)

       How the Postfix SMTP client verifies the server certificate peername for the "verify" TLS security level.
       In  a  "verify"  TLS  policy table ($smtp_tls_policy_maps) entry the optional "match" attribute overrides
       this main.cf setting.

       This parameter specifies one or more patterns or strategies separated by commas,  whitespace  or  colons.
       In the policy table the only valid separator is the colon character.

       Patterns specify domain names, or domain name suffixes:

       example.com
              Match the example.com domain, i.e. one of the names in the server certificate must be example.com.
              Upper and lower case distinctions are ignored.

       .example.com
              Match  subdomains  of  the  example.com  domain,  i.e. match a name in the server certificate that
              consists of a non-zero number of labels followed by a .example.com suffix. Case  distinctions  are
              ignored.

       Strategies  specify  a  transformation  from  the  next-hop  domain  to  the  expected name in the server
       certificate:

       nexthop
              Match against the next-hop domain, which is either the recipient domain, or the transport next-hop
              configured for the domain stripped of any optional socket type prefix, enclosing  square  brackets
              and  trailing  port. When MX lookups are not suppressed, this is the original nexthop domain prior
              to the MX lookup, not the result of the MX lookup. For LMTP delivery via UNIX-domain sockets,  the
              verified  next-hop  name  is  $myhostname.   This  strategy  is suitable for use with the "secure"
              policy. Case is ignored.

       dot-nexthop
              As above, but match server certificate names that are subdomains of the next-hop domain.  Case  is
              ignored.

       hostname
              Match against the hostname of the server, often obtained via an unauthenticated DNS MX lookup. For
              LMTP  delivery  via  UNIX-domain  sockets,  the  verified  name  is  $myhostname. This matches the
              verification strategy of the "MUST" keyword  in  the  obsolete  smtp_tls_per_site  table,  and  is
              suitable  for  use  with the "verify" security level. When the next-hop name is enclosed in square
              brackets to suppress MX lookups, the "hostname" strategy is the same as  the  "nexthop"  strategy.
              Case is ignored.

       Sample main.cf setting:

       smtp_tls_verify_cert_match = hostname, nexthop, dot-nexthop

       Sample policy table override:

       example.com     verify  match=hostname:nexthop
       .example.com    verify  match=example.com:.example.com:hostname

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_tls_wrappermode (default: no)

       Request  that  the Postfix SMTP client connects using the SUBMISSIONS/SMTPS protocol instead of using the
       STARTTLS command.

       This mode requires "smtp_tls_security_level = encrypt" or stronger.

       Example: deliver all remote mail via a provider's server "mail.example.com".

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
           # Client-side SMTPS requires "encrypt" or stronger.
           smtp_tls_security_level = encrypt
           smtp_tls_wrappermode = yes
           # The [] suppress MX lookups.
           relayhost = [mail.example.com]:465

       More examples are in TLS_README, including examples for older Postfix versions.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

smtp_use_tls (default: no)

       Opportunistic mode: use TLS when a remote SMTP server announces STARTTLS support, otherwise send the mail
       in the clear. Beware: some SMTP servers offer STARTTLS even if it is not configured.  With Postfix < 2.3,
       if the TLS handshake fails, and no other server is available, delivery is deferred and mail stays in  the
       queue. If this is a concern for you, use the smtp_tls_per_site feature instead.

       This   feature   is   available   in   Postfix   2.2   and   later.   With  Postfix  2.3  and  later  use
       smtp_tls_security_level instead.

smtp_xforward_timeout (default: 300s)

       The Postfix SMTP client time limit for sending the XFORWARD command, and for receiving  the  remote  SMTP
       server response.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtpd_authorized_verp_clients (default: $authorized_verp_clients)

       What remote SMTP clients are allowed to specify the XVERP command.  This command requests  that  mail  be
       delivered one recipient at a time with a per recipient return address.

       By default, no clients are allowed to specify XVERP.

       This  parameter  was  renamed  with  Postfix  version 2.1. The default value is backwards compatible with
       Postfix version 2.0.

       Specify a list of network/netmask patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. The mask specifies the
       number of bits in the network part of a host address. You can also specify  hostnames  or  .domain  names
       (the  initial  dot causes the domain to match any name below it),  "/file/name" or "type:table" patterns.
       A "/file/name" pattern is replaced by its contents; a "type:table" lookup table is matched when  a  table
       entry  matches  a lookup string (the lookup result is ignored).  Continue long lines by starting the next
       line with whitespace. Specify "!pattern" to exclude an address or network block from the list.  The  form
       "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later.

       Note:  IP  version 6 address information must be specified inside [] in the smtpd_authorized_verp_clients
       value, and in files specified with "/file/name".  IP version 6 addresses contain the ":"  character,  and
       would otherwise be confused with a "type:table" pattern.

smtpd_authorized_xclient_hosts (default: empty)

       What  remote  SMTP  clients  are  allowed to use the XCLIENT feature.  This command overrides remote SMTP
       client information that is used for access control.  Typical  use  is  for  SMTP-based  content  filters,
       fetchmail-like programs, or SMTP server access rule testing. See the XCLIENT_README document for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       By default, no clients are allowed to specify XCLIENT.

       Specify a list of network/netmask patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. The mask specifies the
       number  of  bits  in  the network part of a host address. You can also specify hostnames or .domain names
       (the initial dot causes the domain to match any name below it),  "/file/name" or  "type:table"  patterns.
       A  "/file/name"  pattern is replaced by its contents; a "type:table" lookup table is matched when a table
       entry matches a lookup string (the lookup result is ignored).  Continue long lines by starting  the  next
       line  with  whitespace. Specify "!pattern" to exclude an address or network block from the list. The form
       "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later.

       Note: IP version 6 address information must be specified inside [] in the  smtpd_authorized_xclient_hosts
       value,  and  in files specified with "/file/name".  IP version 6 addresses contain the ":" character, and
       would otherwise be confused with a "type:table" pattern.

smtpd_authorized_xforward_hosts (default: empty)

       What remote SMTP clients are allowed to use the XFORWARD feature.  This command forwards information that
       is used to improve logging after  SMTP-based  content  filters.  See  the  XFORWARD_README  document  for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       By default, no clients are allowed to specify XFORWARD.

       Specify a list of network/netmask patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. The mask specifies the
       number  of  bits  in  the network part of a host address. You can also specify hostnames or .domain names
       (the initial dot causes the domain to match any name below it),  "/file/name" or  "type:table"  patterns.
       A  "/file/name"  pattern is replaced by its contents; a "type:table" lookup table is matched when a table
       entry matches a lookup string (the lookup result is ignored).  Continue long lines by starting  the  next
       line  with  whitespace. Specify "!pattern" to exclude an address or network block from the list. The form
       "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later.

       Note: IP version 6 address information must be specified inside [] in the smtpd_authorized_xforward_hosts
       value, and in files specified with "/file/name".  IP version 6 addresses contain the ":"  character,  and
       would otherwise be confused with a "type:table" pattern.

smtpd_banner (default: $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name)

       The  text  that follows the 220 status code in the SMTP greeting banner. Some people like to see the mail
       version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.

       You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. This is required by the SMTP protocol.

       Example:

       smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)

smtpd_client_auth_rate_limit (default: 0)

       The maximal number of AUTH commands that any client is allowed to send to this  service  per  time  unit,
       regardless  of  whether  or not Postfix actually accepts those commands.  The time unit is specified with
       the anvil_rate_time_unit configuration parameter.

       By default, there is no limit on the number of AUTH commands that a client may send.

       To disable this feature, specify a limit of 0.

       WARNING: The purpose of this feature is to limit abuse. It must not be used to regulate  legitimate  mail
       traffic.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.1 and later.

smtpd_client_connection_count_limit (default: 50)

       How  many  simultaneous connections any client is allowed to make to this service.  By default, the limit
       is set to half the default process limit value.

       To disable this feature, specify a limit of 0.

       WARNING: The purpose of this feature is to limit abuse. It must not be used to regulate  legitimate  mail
       traffic.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_client_connection_rate_limit (default: 0)

       The  maximal  number  of connection attempts any client is allowed to make to this service per time unit.
       The time unit is specified with the anvil_rate_time_unit configuration parameter.

       By default, a client can make as many connections per time unit as Postfix can accept.

       To disable this feature, specify a limit of 0.

       WARNING: The purpose of this feature is to limit abuse. It must not be used to regulate  legitimate  mail
       traffic.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

       Example:

       smtpd_client_connection_rate_limit = 1000

smtpd_client_event_limit_exceptions (default: $mynetworks)

       Clients that are excluded from smtpd_client_*_count/rate_limit restrictions. See the mynetworks parameter
       description for the parameter value syntax.

       By  default,  clients  in  trusted  networks are excluded. Specify a list of network blocks, hostnames or
       .domain names (the initial dot causes the domain to match any name below it).

       Note:   IP   version   6   address    information    must    be    specified    inside    []    in    the
       smtpd_client_event_limit_exceptions  value,  and  in  files  specified  with  "/file/name".  IP version 6
       addresses contain the ":" character, and would otherwise be confused with a "type:table" pattern.

       Pattern   matching   of   domain   names   is   controlled   by    the    presence    or    absence    of
       "smtpd_client_event_limit_exceptions"  in  the  parent_domain_matches_subdomains parameter value (Postfix
       3.0 and later).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_client_ipv4_prefix_length (default: 32)

       Aggregate smtpd_client_*_count and  smtpd_client_*_rate  statistics  by  IPv4  network  blocks  with  the
       specified  network  prefix.  Aggregation  uses fewer anvil(8) resources to maintain counters. By default,
       aggregation is disabled for IPv4.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.8 and later.

smtpd_client_ipv6_prefix_length (default: 84)

       Aggregate smtpd_client_*_count and  smtpd_client_*_rate  statistics  by  IPv6  network  blocks  with  the
       specified network prefix. Aggregation uses fewer the anvil(8) resources to maintain counters. By default,
       aggregation is enabled for IPv6.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.8 and later.

smtpd_client_message_rate_limit (default: 0)

       The  maximal  number  of message delivery requests that any client is allowed to make to this service per
       time unit, regardless of whether or not Postfix actually  accepts  those  messages.   The  time  unit  is
       specified with the anvil_rate_time_unit configuration parameter.

       By default, a client can send as many message delivery requests per time unit as Postfix can accept.

       To disable this feature, specify a limit of 0.

       WARNING:  The  purpose of this feature is to limit abuse. It must not be used to regulate legitimate mail
       traffic.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

       Example:

       smtpd_client_message_rate_limit = 1000

smtpd_client_new_tls_session_rate_limit (default: 0)

       The maximal number of new (i.e., uncached) TLS sessions that a remote SMTP client is allowed to negotiate
       with this service per time unit.  The time unit is specified with the anvil_rate_time_unit  configuration
       parameter.

       By  default,  a  remote  SMTP  client can negotiate as many new TLS sessions per time unit as Postfix can
       accept.

       To disable this feature, specify a limit of 0. Otherwise, specify a limit that is at least the per-client
       concurrent session limit, or else legitimate client sessions may be rejected.

       WARNING: The purpose of this feature is to limit abuse. It must not be used to regulate  legitimate  mail
       traffic.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

       Example:

       smtpd_client_new_tls_session_rate_limit = 100

smtpd_client_port_logging (default: no)

       Enable  logging  of  the  remote SMTP client port in addition to the hostname and IP address. The logging
       format is "host[address]:port".

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

smtpd_client_recipient_rate_limit (default: 0)

       The maximal number of recipient addresses that any client is allowed to send to  this  service  per  time
       unit, regardless of whether or not Postfix actually accepts those recipients.  The time unit is specified
       with the anvil_rate_time_unit configuration parameter.

       By default, a client can send as many recipient addresses per time unit as Postfix can accept.

       To disable this feature, specify a limit of 0.

       WARNING:  The  purpose of this feature is to limit abuse. It must not be used to regulate legitimate mail
       traffic.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

       Example:

       smtpd_client_recipient_rate_limit = 1000

smtpd_client_restrictions (default: empty)

       Optional restrictions that the Postfix SMTP server applies in the context of a client connection request.
       See SMTPD_ACCESS_README, section "Delayed evaluation of SMTP access restriction lists" for  a  discussion
       of evaluation context and time.

       The default is to allow all connection requests.

       Specify  a  list of restrictions, separated by commas and/or whitespace.  Continue long lines by starting
       the next line with whitespace.  Restrictions are applied in the order as specified; the first restriction
       that matches wins.

       The following restrictions are specific to client hostname or client network address information.

       check_ccert_access type:table
              By default use the remote SMTP client  certificate  fingerprint  or  the  public  key  fingerprint
              (Postfix  2.9  and  later)  as  the  lookup key for the specified access(5) database; with Postfix
              version 2.2, also require that the remote SMTP client certificate is verified  successfully.   The
              fingerprint  digest  algorithm  is  configurable  via  the  smtpd_tls_fingerprint_digest parameter
              (hard-coded as md5 prior to Postfix version 2.5).  This feature  requires  "smtpd_tls_ask_ccert  =
              yes" and is available with Postfix version 2.2 and later.
              The  default  algorithm  is  sha256  with Postfix >= 3.6 and the compatibility_level set to 3.6 or
              higher. With Postfix <= 3.5, the default algorithm is md5.  The  best-practice  algorithm  is  now
              sha256.  Recent  advances in hash function cryptanalysis have led to md5 and sha1 being deprecated
              in favor of sha256.  However, as long as there are no known "second pre-image" attacks against the
              older algorithms, their use in this context, though not recommended, is still likely safe.
              Alternatively, check_ccert_access accepts an explicit search order (Postfix 3.5  and  later).  The
              default search order as described above corresponds with:
              check_ccert_access { type:table, { search_order = cert_fingerprint, pubkey_fingerprint } }
              The commas are optional.

       check_client_access type:table
              Search  the  specified access database for the client hostname, parent domains, client IP address,
              or networks obtained by stripping least significant octets. See  the  access(5)  manual  page  for
              details.

       check_client_a_access type:table
              Search  the specified access(5) database for the IP addresses for the client hostname, and execute
              the corresponding action.  Note: a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons. Instead,  use
              DUNNO in order to exclude specific hosts from denylists.  This feature is available in Postfix 3.0
              and later.

       check_client_mx_access type:table
              Search  the specified access(5) database for the MX hosts for the client hostname, and execute the
              corresponding action.  If no MX record is found, look up A or AAAA records, just like the  Postfix
              SMTP client would. Note: a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons. Instead, use DUNNO in
              order  to  exclude  specific  hosts  from denylists.  This feature is available in Postfix 2.7 and
              later.

       check_client_ns_access type:table
              Search the specified access(5) database for the DNS servers for the client hostname,  and  execute
              the  corresponding action.  Note: a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons. Instead, use
              DUNNO in order to exclude specific hosts from denylists.  This feature is available in Postfix 2.7
              and later.

       check_reverse_client_hostname_access type:table
              Search the specified access database for the unverified reverse client hostname,  parent  domains,
              client  IP  address, or networks obtained by stripping least significant octets. See the access(5)
              manual page for details.  Note: a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons.  Instead,  use
              DUNNO in order to exclude specific hosts from denylists.  This feature is available in Postfix 2.6
              and later.

       check_reverse_client_hostname_a_access type:table
              Search  the  specified  access(5)  database for the IP addresses for the unverified reverse client
              hostname, and execute the corresponding action.  Note: a result of "OK" is not allowed for  safety
              reasons.   Instead,  use DUNNO in order to exclude specific hosts from denylists.  This feature is
              available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

       check_reverse_client_hostname_mx_access type:table
              Search the specified access(5) database for  the  MX  hosts  for  the  unverified  reverse  client
              hostname,  and  execute  the  corresponding  action.   If no MX record is found, look up A or AAAA
              records, just like the Postfix SMTP client would.  Note: a result  of  "OK"  is  not  allowed  for
              safety  reasons.   Instead,  use  DUNNO  in  order to exclude specific hosts from denylists.  This
              feature is available in Postfix 2.7 and later.

       check_reverse_client_hostname_ns_access type:table
              Search the specified access(5) database for the DNS servers  for  the  unverified  reverse  client
              hostname,  and execute the corresponding action.  Note: a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety
              reasons.  Instead, use DUNNO in order to exclude specific hosts from denylists.  This  feature  is
              available in Postfix 2.7 and later.

       check_sasl_access type:table
              Use  the remote SMTP client SASL user name as the lookup key for the specified access(5) database.
              The lookup key has the form "username@domainname" when the smtpd_sasl_local_domain parameter value
              is non-empty.  Unlike the check_client_access feature, check_sasl_access does not perform  matches
              of  parent  domains  or IP subnet ranges.  This feature is available with Postfix version 2.11 and
              later.

       permit_inet_interfaces
              Permit the request when the client IP address matches $inet_interfaces.

       permit_mynetworks
              Permit the request when the client IP address matches any network or  network  address  listed  in
              $mynetworks.

       permit_sasl_authenticated
              Permit the request when the client is successfully authenticated via the RFC 4954 (AUTH) protocol.

       permit_tls_all_clientcerts
              Permit  the request when the remote SMTP client certificate is verified successfully.  This option
              must be used only if a special CA issues the certificates and only this CA is listed as a  trusted
              CA.  Otherwise,  clients  with  a third-party certificate would also be allowed to relay.  Specify
              "tls_append_default_CA  =  no"  when  the  trusted  CA  is  specified  with  smtpd_tls_CAfile   or
              smtpd_tls_CApath, to prevent Postfix from appending the system-supplied default CAs.  This feature
              requires "smtpd_tls_ask_ccert = yes" and is available with Postfix version 2.2 and later.

       permit_tls_clientcerts
              Permit  the  request when the remote SMTP client certificate fingerprint or public key fingerprint
              (Postfix 2.9 and later) is listed in $relay_clientcerts.   The  fingerprint  digest  algorithm  is
              configurable  via  the  smtpd_tls_fingerprint_digest parameter (hard-coded as md5 prior to Postfix
              version 2.5).  This feature requires "smtpd_tls_ask_ccert = yes" and  is  available  with  Postfix
              version 2.2 and later.
              The  default  algorithm  is  sha256  with Postfix >= 3.6 and the compatibility_level set to 3.6 or
              higher. With Postfix <= 3.5, the default algorithm is md5.  The  best-practice  algorithm  is  now
              sha256.  Recent  advances in hash function cryptanalysis have led to md5 and sha1 being deprecated
              in favor of sha256.  However, as long as there are no known "second pre-image" attacks against the
              older algorithms, their use in this context, though not recommended, is still likely safe.

       reject_rbl_client rbl_domain=d.d.d.d
              Reject the request when the reversed client network address is listed with the A record  "d.d.d.d"
              under  rbl_domain (Postfix version 2.1 and later only).  Each "d" is a number, or a pattern inside
              "[]" that contains one or more ";"-separated numbers or number..number ranges (Postfix version 2.8
              and later).  If no "=d.d.d.d" is specified, reject the request when the  reversed  client  network
              address is listed with any A record under rbl_domain.
              The  maps_rbl_reject_code  parameter  specifies  the response code for rejected requests (default:
              554), the default_rbl_reply  parameter specifies the default server reply, and the  rbl_reply_maps
              parameter  specifies  tables with server replies indexed by rbl_domain.  This feature is available
              in Postfix 2.0 and later.

       permit_dnswl_client dnswl_domain=d.d.d.d
              Accept the request when the reversed client network address is listed with the A record  "d.d.d.d"
              under  dnswl_domain.   Each  "d"  is  a number, or a pattern inside "[]" that contains one or more
              ";"-separated numbers or number..number ranges.  If no "=d.d.d.d" is specified, accept the request
              when the reversed client network address is listed with any A record under dnswl_domain.
              For   safety,   permit_dnswl_client   is    silently    ignored    when    it    would    override
              reject_unauth_destination.   The  result  is  DEFER_IF_REJECT  when  allowlist lookup fails.  This
              feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

       reject_rhsbl_client rbl_domain=d.d.d.d
              Reject the request when the client hostname is listed with the A record "d.d.d.d" under rbl_domain
              (Postfix version 2.1 and later only).  Each "d" is  a  number,  or  a  pattern  inside  "[]"  that
              contains  one  or  more  ";"-separated  numbers  or number..number ranges (Postfix version 2.8 and
              later).  If no "=d.d.d.d" is specified, reject the request when the client hostname is listed with
              any A record under rbl_domain. See the reject_rbl_client  description  above  for  additional  RBL
              related  configuration  parameters.   This  feature  is  available  in Postfix 2.0 and later; with
              Postfix version 2.8 and later, reject_rhsbl_reverse_client will usually produce better results.

       permit_rhswl_client rhswl_domain=d.d.d.d
              Accept the request when  the  client  hostname  is  listed  with  the  A  record  "d.d.d.d"  under
              rhswl_domain.   Each  "d"  is  a  number,  or  a  pattern  inside  "[]"  that contains one or more
              ";"-separated numbers or number..number ranges. If no "=d.d.d.d" is specified, accept the  request
              when the client hostname is listed with any A record under rhswl_domain.
              Caution:  client  name  allowlisting  is  fragile,  since  the  client name lookup can fail due to
              temporary outages.  Client name allowlisting should be used only to reduce false positives in e.g.
              DNS-based blocklists, and not for making access rule exceptions.
              For   safety,   permit_rhswl_client   is    silently    ignored    when    it    would    override
              reject_unauth_destination.   The  result  is  DEFER_IF_REJECT  when  allowlist lookup fails.  This
              feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

       reject_rhsbl_reverse_client rbl_domain=d.d.d.d
              Reject the request when the unverified reverse  client  hostname  is  listed  with  the  A  record
              "d.d.d.d"  under  rbl_domain.  Each "d" is a number, or a pattern inside "[]" that contains one or
              more ";"-separated numbers or number..number ranges.  If no "=d.d.d.d" is  specified,  reject  the
              request  when the unverified reverse client hostname is listed with any A record under rbl_domain.
              See the reject_rbl_client description above for additional RBL related  configuration  parameters.
              This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

       reject_unknown_client_hostname (with Postfix < 2.3: reject_unknown_client)
              Reject  the  request  when  1)  the client IP address->name mapping fails, or 2) the name->address
              mapping fails, or 3) the name->address mapping does not match the client IP address.
              This is a stronger restriction  than  the  reject_unknown_reverse_client_hostname  feature,  which
              triggers only under condition 1) above.
              The  unknown_client_reject_code  parameter  specifies  the  response  code  for  rejected requests
              (default: 450). The reply is always 450 in case the address->name or name->address  lookup  failed
              due to a temporary problem.

       reject_unknown_reverse_client_hostname
              Reject the request when the client IP address has no address->name mapping.
              This  is  a weaker restriction than the reject_unknown_client_hostname feature, which requires not
              only that the address->name and name->address mappings exist,  but  also  that  the  two  mappings
              reproduce the client IP address.
              The  unknown_client_reject_code  parameter  specifies  the  response  code  for  rejected requests
              (default: 450).  The reply is always 450  in  case  the  address->name  lookup  failed  due  to  a
              temporary problem.
              This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

       In addition, you can use any of the following generic restrictions.  These restrictions are applicable in
       any SMTP command context.

       check_policy_service servername
              Query  the specified policy server. See the SMTPD_POLICY_README document for details. This feature
              is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       defer  Defer the request. The client is told to try again later. This restriction is useful at the end of
              a restriction list, to make the default policy explicit.
              The defer_code parameter specifies the SMTP server reply code (default: 450).

       defer_if_permit
              Defer the request if some later restriction would result in an explicit or implicit PERMIT action.
              This is useful when a denylisting feature fails due to  a  temporary  problem.   This  feature  is
              available in Postfix version 2.1 and later.

       defer_if_reject
              Defer  the request if some later restriction would result in a REJECT action.  This is useful when
              an allowlisting feature fails due to a temporary problem.  This feature is  available  in  Postfix
              version 2.1 and later.

       permit Permit  the  request.  This  restriction  is  useful at the end of a restriction list, to make the
              default policy explicit.

       reject_multi_recipient_bounce
              Reject the request when the envelope sender is the null address,  and  the  message  has  multiple
              envelope  recipients.  This  usage has rare but legitimate applications: under certain conditions,
              multi-recipient mail that was posted with the DSN option NOTIFY=NEVER may be  forwarded  with  the
              null sender address.
              Note:   this   restriction  can  only  work  reliably  when  used  in  smtpd_data_restrictions  or
              smtpd_end_of_data_restrictions, because the total number of recipients is not known at an  earlier
              stage  of  the  SMTP  conversation.   Use  at  the  RCPT  stage  will  only reject the second etc.
              recipient.
              The multi_recipient_bounce_reject_code parameter specifies the response code for rejected requests
              (default:  550).  This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       reject_plaintext_session
              Reject the request when the connection is not encrypted.  This  restriction  should  not  be  used
              before the client has had a chance to negotiate encryption with the AUTH or STARTTLS commands.
              The  plaintext_reject_code  parameter  specifies the response code for rejected requests (default:
              450).  This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

       reject_unauth_pipelining
              Reject the request when the client sends SMTP commands ahead of time where it is not  allowed,  or
              when  the  client sends SMTP commands ahead of time without knowing that Postfix actually supports
              ESMTP command pipelining. This stops mail from bulk  mail  software  that  improperly  uses  ESMTP
              command pipelining in order to speed up deliveries.
              With  Postfix  2.6  and later, the SMTP server sets a per-session flag whenever it detects illegal
              pipelining, including pipelined HELO or EHLO commands. The reject_unauth_pipelining feature simply
              tests whether the flag was set at any point in time during the session.
              With older Postfix versions, reject_unauth_pipelining checks the current status of the input  read
              queue, and its usage is not recommended in contexts other than smtpd_data_restrictions.

       reject Reject  the  request.  This  restriction  is  useful at the end of a restriction list, to make the
              default policy explicit.  The reject_code configuration parameter specifies the response code  for
              rejected requests (default: 554).

       sleep seconds
              Pause  for  the  specified number of seconds and proceed with the next restriction in the list, if
              any. This may stop zombie mail when used as:
              /etc/postfix/main.cf:
                  smtpd_client_restrictions =
                      sleep 1, reject_unauth_pipelining
                  smtpd_delay_reject = no
              This feature is available in Postfix 2.3.

       warn_if_reject
              A safety net for testing. When "warn_if_reject" is placed before a reject-type restriction, access
              table query, or check_policy_service query,  this  logs  a  "reject_warning"  message  instead  of
              rejecting  a  request  (when a reject-type restriction fails due to a temporary error, this logs a
              "reject_warning" message for any implicit "defer_if_permit" actions that  would  normally  prevent
              mail  from  being  accepted  by  some  later  access  restriction).  This feature has no effect on
              defer_if_reject restrictions.

       Other restrictions that are valid in this context:

       •      SMTP  command  specific  restrictions  that  are  described  under  the   smtpd_helo_restrictions,
              smtpd_sender_restrictions   or  smtpd_recipient_restrictions  parameters.  When  helo,  sender  or
              recipient restrictions are listed under smtpd_client_restrictions,  they  have  effect  only  with
              "smtpd_delay_reject  =  yes",  so  that $smtpd_client_restrictions is evaluated at the time of the
              RCPT TO command.

       Example:

       smtpd_client_restrictions = permit_mynetworks, reject_unknown_client_hostname

smtpd_command_filter (default: empty)

       A mechanism to transform commands from remote SMTP clients.  This is a last-resort tool  to  work  around
       client  commands  that  break  interoperability  with  the Postfix SMTP server.  Other uses involve fault
       injection to test Postfix's handling of invalid commands.

       Specify the name of a "type:table" lookup table. The search string is the SMTP command as  received  from
       the remote SMTP client, except that initial whitespace and the trailing <CR><LF> are removed.  The result
       value is executed by the Postfix SMTP server.

       There is no need to use smtpd_command_filter for the following cases:

       •      Use "resolve_numeric_domain = yes" to accept "user@ipaddress".

       •      Postfix   already   accepts   the  correct  form  "user@[ipaddress]".  Use  virtual_alias_maps  or
              canonical_maps to translate these into domain names if necessary.

       •      Use "strict_rfc821_envelopes = no" to accept "RCPT  TO:<User  Name  <user@example.com>>".  Postfix
              will ignore the "User Name" part and deliver to the <user@example.com> address.

       Examples of problems that can be solved with the smtpd_command_filter feature:

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
           smtpd_command_filter = pcre:/etc/postfix/command_filter

       /etc/postfix/command_filter:
           # Work around clients that send malformed HELO commands.
           /^HELO\s*$/ HELO domain.invalid

           # Work around clients that send empty lines.
           /^\s*$/     NOOP

           # Work around clients that send RCPT TO:<'user@domain'>.
           # WARNING: do not lose the parameters that follow the address.
           /^(RCPT\s+TO:\s*<)'([^[:space:]]+)'(>.*)/     $1$2$3

           # Append XVERP to MAIL FROM commands to request VERP-style delivery.
           # See VERP_README for more information on how to use Postfix VERP.
           /^(MAIL\s+FROM:\s*<listname@example\.com>.*)/   $1 XVERP

           # Bounce-never mail sink. Use notify_classes=bounce,resource,software
           # to send bounced mail to the postmaster (with message body removed).
           /^(RCPT\s+TO:\s*<.*>.*)\s+NOTIFY=\S+(.*)/     $1 NOTIFY=NEVER$2
           /^(RCPT\s+TO:.*)/                             $1 NOTIFY=NEVER

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7.

smtpd_data_restrictions (default: empty)

       Optional  access  restrictions  that  the  Postfix  SMTP  server  applies in the context of the SMTP DATA
       command.  See SMTPD_ACCESS_README, section "Delayed evaluation of SMTP access restriction  lists"  for  a
       discussion of evaluation context and time.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

       Specify  a  list of restrictions, separated by commas and/or whitespace.  Continue long lines by starting
       the next line with whitespace.  Restrictions are applied in the order as specified; the first restriction
       that matches wins.

       The following restrictions are valid in this context:

       •      Generic  restrictions  that  can  be  used  in  any  SMTP   command   context,   described   under
              smtpd_client_restrictions.

       •      SMTP     command     specific     restrictions    described    under    smtpd_client_restrictions,
              smtpd_helo_restrictions, smtpd_sender_restrictions or smtpd_recipient_restrictions.

       •      However, no recipient information is available in the case of multi-recipient mail. Acting on only
              one recipient would be misleading, because any decision will affect all recipients equally. Acting
              on all recipients would require a possibly  very  large  amount  of  memory,  and  would  also  be
              misleading for the reasons mentioned before.

       Examples:

       smtpd_data_restrictions = reject_unauth_pipelining
       smtpd_data_restrictions = reject_multi_recipient_bounce

smtpd_delay_open_until_valid_rcpt (default: yes)

       Postpone the start of an SMTP mail transaction until a valid RCPT TO command is received. Specify "no" to
       create a mail transaction as soon as the Postfix SMTP server receives a valid MAIL FROM command.

       With  sites  that  reject  lots  of  mail,  the  default  setting reduces the use of disk, CPU and memory
       resources. The downside is that rejected recipients are logged with NOQUEUE instead of a mail transaction
       ID. This complicates the logfile analysis of multi-recipient mail.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_delay_reject (default: yes)

       Wait until the RCPT TO command before evaluating $smtpd_client_restrictions, $smtpd_helo_restrictions and
       $smtpd_sender_restrictions, or wait until the ETRN command before  evaluating  $smtpd_client_restrictions
       and $smtpd_helo_restrictions.

       This  feature  is  turned  on by default because some clients apparently mis-behave when the Postfix SMTP
       server rejects commands before RCPT TO.

       The default setting has one major benefit: it allows Postfix to log recipient  address  information  when
       rejecting a client name/address or sender address, so that it is possible to find out whose mail is being
       rejected.

smtpd_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps (default: empty)

       Lookup  tables,  indexed  by the remote SMTP client address, with case insensitive lists of EHLO keywords
       (pipelining, starttls, auth, etc.) that the Postfix SMTP server will not send in the EHLO response  to  a
       remote SMTP client. See smtpd_discard_ehlo_keywords for details.  The tables are not searched by hostname
       for robustness reasons.

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma. Tables will be searched
       in the specified order until a match is found.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_discard_ehlo_keywords (default: empty)

       A  case insensitive list of EHLO keywords (pipelining, starttls, auth, etc.) that the Postfix SMTP server
       will not send in the EHLO response to a remote SMTP client.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

       Notes:

       •      Specify the silent-discard pseudo keyword to prevent this action from being logged.

       •      Use the smtpd_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps feature to discard EHLO keywords selectively.

smtpd_dns_reply_filter (default: empty)

       Optional filter for Postfix SMTP server  DNS  lookup  results.   See  smtp_dns_reply_filter  for  details
       including an example.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

smtpd_end_of_data_restrictions (default: empty)

       Optional  access restrictions that the Postfix SMTP server applies in the context of the SMTP END-OF-DATA
       command.  See SMTPD_ACCESS_README, section "Delayed evaluation of SMTP access restriction  lists"  for  a
       discussion of evaluation context and time.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

       See smtpd_data_restrictions for details and limitations.

smtpd_enforce_tls (default: no)

       Mandatory  TLS:  announce  STARTTLS  support  to  remote  SMTP  clients, and require that clients use TLS
       encryption.  According to RFC 2487 this MUST NOT be applied in case of a publicly-referenced SMTP server.
       This option is therefore off by default.

       Note 1: "smtpd_enforce_tls = yes" implies "smtpd_tls_auth_only = yes".

       Note 2: when invoked via "sendmail -bs", Postfix will never offer STARTTLS due to insufficient privileges
       to access the server private key. This is intended behavior.

       This  feature  is  available  in  Postfix   2.2   and   later.   With   Postfix   2.3   and   later   use
       smtpd_tls_security_level instead.

smtpd_error_sleep_time (default: 1s)

       With  Postfix  version  2.1  and  later: the SMTP server response delay after a client has made more than
       $smtpd_soft_error_limit errors, and fewer than $smtpd_hard_error_limit errors, without delivering mail.

       With Postfix version 2.0 and earlier: the SMTP  server  delay  before  sending  a  reject  (4xx  or  5xx)
       response,  when  the  client  has made fewer than $smtpd_soft_error_limit errors without delivering mail.
       When the client has made $smtpd_soft_error_limit or more errors, delay all responses with the  larger  of
       (number of errors) seconds or $smtpd_error_sleep_time.

       Specify  a  non-negative  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies
       the time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default  time
       unit is s (seconds).

smtpd_etrn_restrictions (default: empty)

       Optional  restrictions that the Postfix SMTP server applies in the context of a client ETRN command.  See
       SMTPD_ACCESS_README, section "Delayed evaluation of SMTP access restriction lists" for  a  discussion  of
       evaluation context and time.

       The  Postfix ETRN implementation accepts only destinations that are eligible for the Postfix "fast flush"
       service. See the ETRN_README file for details.

       Specify a list of restrictions, separated by commas and/or whitespace.  Continue long lines  by  starting
       the next line with whitespace.  Restrictions are applied in the order as specified; the first restriction
       that matches wins.

       The following restrictions are specific to the domain name information received with the ETRN command.

       check_etrn_access type:table
              Search  the  specified  access  database  for  the ETRN domain name or its parent domains. See the
              access(5) manual page for details.

       Other restrictions that are valid in this context:

       •      Generic  restrictions  that  can  be  used  in  any  SMTP   command   context,   described   under
              smtpd_client_restrictions.

       •      SMTP    command    specific    restrictions    described   under   smtpd_client_restrictions   and
              smtpd_helo_restrictions.

       Example:

       smtpd_etrn_restrictions = permit_mynetworks, reject

smtpd_expansion_filter (default: see postconf -d output)

       What characters are allowed in $name expansions of RBL reply templates. Characters not in the allowed set
       are replaced by "_".  Use C like escapes to specify special characters such as whitespace.

       The smtpd_expansion_filter value is not subject to Postfix configuration parameter $name expansion.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

smtpd_forbid_bare_newline (default: Postfix < 3.9: no)

       Reject or restrict input lines from an SMTP client that end in <LF> instead  of  the  standard  <CR><LF>.
       Such  line  endings  are  commonly  allowed  with UNIX-based SMTP servers, but they violate RFC 5321, and
       allowing such line endings can make a server vulnerable to SMTP smuggling.

       Specify one of the following values (case does not matter):

       normalize
              Require the standard End-of-DATA sequence <CR><LF>.<CR><LF>.  Otherwise, allow command or  message
              content lines ending in the non-standard <LF>, and process them as if the client sent the standard
              <CR><LF>.
              This  maintains  compatibility  with  many  legitimate SMTP client applications that send a mix of
              standard and non-standard line endings, but will fail to receive email from client implementations
              that do not terminate DATA content with the standard End-of-DATA sequence <CR><LF>.<CR><LF>.
              Such clients can be excluded with smtpd_forbid_bare_newline_exclusions.

       yes    Compatibility alias for normalize.

       reject Require the standard End-of-DATA sequence <CR><LF>.<CR><LF>. Reject a command or  message  content
              when  a  line contains bare <LF>, log a "bare <LF> received" error, and reply with the SMTP status
              code in $smtpd_forbid_bare_newline_reject_code.
              This will reject email from SMTP clients that send any  non-standard  line  endings  such  as  web
              applications, netcat, or load balancer health checks.
              This  will  also  reject  email  from  services  that use BDAT to send MIME text containing a bare
              newline (RFC 3030 Section 3 requires canonical MIME format for text message types, defined in  RFC
              2045 Sections 2.7 and 2.8).
              Such  clients  can  be excluded with smtpd_forbid_bare_newline_exclusions (or, in the case of BDAT
              violations, BDAT can be  selectively  disabled  with  smtpd_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps,  or
              globally disabled with smtpd_discard_ehlo_keywords).

       no (default)
              Do  not require the standard End-of-DATA sequence <CR><LF>.<CR><LF>. Always process a bare <LF> as
              if the client sent <CR><LF>. This option is fully backwards compatible, but is not recommended for
              an Internet-facing SMTP server, because it is vulnerable to  SMTP smuggling.

       Recommended settings:

           # Require the standard End-of-DATA sequence <CR><LF>.<CR><LF>.
           # Otherwise, allow bare <LF> and process it as if the client sent
           # <CR><LF>.
           #
           # This maintains compatibility with many legitimate SMTP client
           # applications that send a mix of standard and non-standard line
           # endings, but will fail to receive email from client implementations
           # that do not terminate DATA content with the standard End-of-DATA
           # sequence <CR><LF>.<CR><LF>.
           #
           # Such clients can be allowlisted with smtpd_forbid_bare_newline_exclusions.
           # The example below allowlists SMTP clients in trusted networks.
           #
           smtpd_forbid_bare_newline = normalize
           smtpd_forbid_bare_newline_exclusions = $mynetworks

       Alternative:

           # Reject input lines that contain <LF> and log a "bare <LF> received"
           # error. Require that input lines end in <CR><LF>, and require the
           # standard End-of-DATA sequence <CR><LF>.<CR><LF>.
           #
           # This will reject email from SMTP clients that send any non-standard
           # line endings such as web applications, netcat, or load balancer
           # health checks.
           #
           # This will also reject email from services that use BDAT to send
           # MIME text containing a bare newline (RFC 3030 Section 3 requires
           # canonical MIME format for text message types, defined in RFC 2045
           # Sections 2.7 and 2.8).
           #
           # Such clients can be allowlisted with smtpd_forbid_bare_newline_exclusions.
           # The example below allowlists SMTP clients in trusted networks.
           #
           smtpd_forbid_bare_newline = reject
           smtpd_forbid_bare_newline_exclusions = $mynetworks
           #
           # Alternatively, in the case of BDAT violations, BDAT can be selectively
           # disabled with smtpd_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps, or globally
           # disabled with smtpd_discard_ehlo_keywords.
           #
           # smtpd_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps = cidr:/path/to/file
           # /path/to/file:
           #     10.0.0.0/24 chunking, silent-discard
           # smtpd_discard_ehlo_keywords = chunking, silent-discard

       This feature with settings yes and  no  is  available  in  Postfix  3.8.4,  3.7.9,  3.6.13,  and  3.5.23.
       Additionally,  the  settings  reject,  and  normalize  are  available with Postfix >= 3.9, 3.8.5, 3.7.10,
       3.6.14, and 3.5.24.

smtpd_forbid_bare_newline_exclusions (default: $mynetworks)

       Exclude the specified clients from smtpd_forbid_bare_newline enforcement.  This  setting  uses  the  same
       syntax and parent-domain matching behavior as mynetworks.

       This feature is available in Postfix >= 3.9, 3.8.4, 3.7.9, 3.6.13, and 3.5.23.

smtpd_forbid_bare_newline_reject_code (default: 550)

       The  numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when rejecting a request with "smtpd_forbid_bare_newline
       = reject".  Specify a 5XX status code (521 to disconnect).

       This feature is available in Postfix >= 3.9, 3.8.5, 3.7.10, 3.6.14, and 3.5.24.

smtpd_forbid_unauth_pipelining (default: Postfix >= 3.9: yes)

       Disconnect remote SMTP clients that violate RFC 2920 (or 5321) command pipelining constraints. The server
       replies with "554 5.5.0 Error: SMTP protocol synchronization" and logs the unexpected remote SMTP  client
       input.  Specify "smtpd_forbid_unauth_pipelining = yes" to enable. This feature is enabled by default with
       Postfix >= 3.9.

       This feature is available in Postfix >= 3.9, 3.8.1, 3.7.6, 3.6.10, and 3.5.20.

smtpd_forbidden_commands (default: CONNECT GET POST regexp:{{/^[^A-Z]/ Bogus}})

       List of commands that cause the Postfix SMTP server to immediately terminate the session with a 221 code.
       This can be used to disconnect clients that obviously attempt to abuse the system.  In  addition  to  the
       commands  listed in this parameter, commands that follow the "Label:" format of message headers will also
       cause a disconnect. With Postfix versions 3.6 and earlier, the default value is "CONNECT GET POST".

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

       Support for inline regular expressions was added in  Postfix  version  3.7.  See  regexp_table(5)  for  a
       description of the syntax and features.

smtpd_hard_error_limit (default: normal: 20, overload: 1)

       The maximal number of errors a remote SMTP client is allowed to make without delivering mail. The Postfix
       SMTP server disconnects when the limit is reached. Normally the default limit is 20, but it changes under
       overload  to  just  1.  With  Postfix  2.5  and earlier, the SMTP server always allows up to 20 errors by
       default.  Valid values are greater than zero.

smtpd_helo_required (default: no)

       Require that a remote SMTP client introduces itself with the HELO or EHLO command before sending the MAIL
       command or other commands that require EHLO negotiation.

       Example:

       smtpd_helo_required = yes

smtpd_helo_restrictions (default: empty)

       Optional restrictions that the Postfix SMTP server applies in the context of a client HELO command.   See
       SMTPD_ACCESS_README,  section  "Delayed  evaluation of SMTP access restriction lists" for a discussion of
       evaluation context and time.

       The default is to permit everything.

       Note: specify "smtpd_helo_required = yes" to fully enforce this restriction (without "smtpd_helo_required
       = yes", a client can simply skip smtpd_helo_restrictions by not sending HELO or EHLO).

       Specify a list of restrictions, separated by commas and/or whitespace.  Continue long lines  by  starting
       the next line with whitespace.  Restrictions are applied in the order as specified; the first restriction
       that matches wins.

       The  following  restrictions  are  specific  to  the  hostname information received with the HELO or EHLO
       command.

       check_helo_access type:table
              Search the specified access(5) database for the HELO or  EHLO  hostname  or  parent  domains,  and
              execute the corresponding action.  Note: specify "smtpd_helo_required = yes" to fully enforce this
              restriction  (without  "smtpd_helo_required  = yes", a client can simply skip check_helo_access by
              not sending HELO or EHLO).

       check_helo_a_access type:table
              Search the specified access(5) database for the IP addresses for the HELO or  EHLO  hostname,  and
              execute  the  corresponding  action.   Note 1: a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons.
              Instead, use  DUNNO  in  order  to  exclude  specific  hosts  from  denylists.   Note  2:  specify
              "smtpd_helo_required  =  yes"  to  fully  enforce this restriction (without "smtpd_helo_required =
              yes", a client can simply skip check_helo_a_access by not sending HELO or EHLO).  This feature  is
              available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

       check_helo_mx_access type:table
              Search  the  specified  access(5)  database  for  the  MX hosts for the HELO or EHLO hostname, and
              execute the corresponding action.  If no MX record is found, look up A or AAAA records, just  like
              the  Postfix  SMTP  client  would.   Note  1:  a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons.
              Instead, use  DUNNO  in  order  to  exclude  specific  hosts  from  denylists.   Note  2:  specify
              "smtpd_helo_required  =  yes"  to  fully  enforce this restriction (without "smtpd_helo_required =
              yes", a client can simply skip check_helo_mx_access by not sending HELO or EHLO).  This feature is
              available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       check_helo_ns_access type:table
              Search the specified access(5) database for the DNS servers for the HELO  or  EHLO  hostname,  and
              execute  the  corresponding  action.   Note 1: a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons.
              Instead, use  DUNNO  in  order  to  exclude  specific  hosts  from  denylists.   Note  2:  specify
              "smtpd_helo_required  =  yes"  to  fully  enforce this restriction (without "smtpd_helo_required =
              yes", a client can simply skip check_helo_ns_access by not sending HELO or EHLO). This feature  is
              available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       reject_invalid_helo_hostname (with Postfix < 2.3: reject_invalid_hostname)
              Reject   the   request   when   the   HELO   or   EHLO   hostname  is  malformed.   Note:  specify
              "smtpd_helo_required = yes" to fully enforce  this  restriction  (without  "smtpd_helo_required  =
              yes", a client can simply skip reject_invalid_helo_hostname by not sending HELO or EHLO).
              The invalid_hostname_reject_code specifies the response code for rejected requests (default: 501).

       reject_non_fqdn_helo_hostname (with Postfix < 2.3: reject_non_fqdn_hostname)
              Reject  the  request  when  the  HELO or EHLO hostname is not in fully-qualified domain or address
              literal form, as required by the RFC. Note: specify "smtpd_helo_required = yes" to  fully  enforce
              this   restriction   (without   "smtpd_helo_required   =   yes",   a   client   can   simply  skip
              reject_non_fqdn_helo_hostname by not sending HELO or EHLO).
              The non_fqdn_reject_code parameter specifies the response code  for  rejected  requests  (default:
              504).

       reject_rhsbl_helo rbl_domain=d.d.d.d
              Reject  the  request  when  the  HELO or EHLO hostname is listed with the A record "d.d.d.d" under
              rbl_domain (Postfix version 2.1 and later only).  Each "d" is a number, or a pattern  inside  "[]"
              that  contains one or more ";"-separated numbers or number..number ranges (Postfix version 2.8 and
              later).  If no "=d.d.d.d" is specified, reject the request when  the  HELO  or  EHLO  hostname  is
              listed  with  any  A record under rbl_domain. See the reject_rbl_client description for additional
              RBL related configuration parameters.  Note: specify "smtpd_helo_required = yes" to fully  enforce
              this  restriction (without "smtpd_helo_required = yes", a client can simply skip reject_rhsbl_helo
              by not sending HELO or EHLO). This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

       reject_unknown_helo_hostname (with Postfix < 2.3: reject_unknown_hostname)
              Reject the request when the HELO or EHLO hostname has no DNS A or MX record.
              The  reply  is  specified  with  the  unknown_hostname_reject_code  parameter  (default:  450)  or
              unknown_helo_hostname_tempfail_action  (default:  defer_if_permit).   See the respective parameter
              descriptions for details.
              Note:  specify  "smtpd_helo_required  =  yes"  to  fully   enforce   this   restriction   (without
              "smtpd_helo_required  = yes", a client can simply skip reject_unknown_helo_hostname by not sending
              HELO or EHLO).

       Other restrictions that are valid in this context:

       •      Generic  restrictions  that  can  be  used  in  any  SMTP   command   context,   described   under
              smtpd_client_restrictions.

       •      Client     hostname     or    network    address    specific    restrictions    described    under
              smtpd_client_restrictions.

       •      SMTP   command   specific    restrictions    described    under    smtpd_sender_restrictions    or
              smtpd_recipient_restrictions.    When   sender   or   recipient   restrictions  are  listed  under
              smtpd_helo_restrictions,  they  have  effect  only  with  "smtpd_delay_reject  =  yes",  so   that
              $smtpd_helo_restrictions is evaluated at the time of the RCPT TO command.

       Examples:

       smtpd_helo_restrictions = permit_mynetworks, reject_invalid_helo_hostname
       smtpd_helo_restrictions = permit_mynetworks, reject_unknown_helo_hostname

smtpd_history_flush_threshold (default: 100)

       The  maximal number of lines in the Postfix SMTP server command history before it is flushed upon receipt
       of EHLO, RSET, or end of DATA.

smtpd_junk_command_limit (default: normal: 100, overload: 1)

       The number of junk commands (NOOP, VRFY, ETRN or RSET) that a remote SMTP  client  can  send  before  the
       Postfix SMTP server starts to increment the error counter with each junk command.  The junk command count
       is  reset  after  mail  is  delivered.   See  also  the smtpd_error_sleep_time and smtpd_soft_error_limit
       configuration parameters.  Normally the default limit is 100, but it changes under overload  to  just  1.
       With Postfix 2.5 and earlier, the SMTP server always allows up to 100 junk commands by default.

smtpd_log_access_permit_actions (default: empty)

       Enable  logging  of  the  named "permit" actions in SMTP server access lists (by default, the SMTP server
       logs "reject" actions but not "permit" actions).  This feature does not affect conditional  actions  such
       as "defer_if_permit".

       Specify  a  list  of  "permit"  action  names, "/file/name" or "type:table" patterns, separated by commas
       and/or whitespace. The list is matched left to right,  and  the  search  stops  on  the  first  match.  A
       "/file/name"  pattern  is  replaced  by  its contents; a "type:table" lookup table is matched when a name
       matches a lookup key (the lookup result is ignored).  Continue long lines by starting the next line  with
       whitespace. Specify "!pattern" to exclude a name from the list.

       Examples:

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
           # Log all "permit" actions.
           smtpd_log_access_permit_actions = static:all

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
           # Log "permit_dnswl_client" only.
           smtpd_log_access_permit_actions = permit_dnswl_client

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.10 and later.

smtpd_milter_maps (default: empty)

       Lookup  tables  with  Milter settings per remote SMTP client IP address.  The lookup result overrides the
       smtpd_milters setting, and has the same syntax.

       Note: lookup tables cannot return empty responses. Specify a lookup result  of  DISABLE  (case  does  not
       matter) to indicate that Milter support should be disabled.

       Example to disable Milters for local clients:

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
           smtpd_milter_maps = cidr:/etc/postfix/smtpd_milter_map
           smtpd_milters = inet:host:port, { inet:host:port, ... }, ...

       /etc/postfix/smtpd_milter_map:
           # Disable Milters for local clients.
           127.0.0.0/8    DISABLE
           192.168.0.0/16 DISABLE
           ::/64          DISABLE
           2001:db8::/32  DISABLE

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.2 and later.

smtpd_milters (default: empty)

       A  list  of  Milter (mail filter) applications for new mail that arrives via the Postfix smtpd(8) server.
       Specify space or comma as separator. See the MILTER_README document for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_min_data_rate (default: 500)

       The minimum plaintext data transfer rate in bytes/second for DATA and BDAT requests, when  deadlines  are
       enabled  with  smtpd_per_request_deadline.  After  a  read  operation transfers N plaintext message bytes
       (possibly after TLS decryption), and after the DATA or  BDAT  request  deadline  is  decremented  by  the
       elapsed   time   of   that  read  operation,  the  DATA  or  BDAT  request  deadline  is  incremented  by
       N/smtpd_min_data_rate seconds. However, the deadline will never be  incremented  beyond  the  time  limit
       specified with smtpd_timeout.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.7 and later.

smtpd_noop_commands (default: empty)

       List  of  commands that the Postfix SMTP server replies to with "250 Ok", without doing any syntax checks
       and without changing state.  This list overrides any commands built into the Postfix SMTP server.

smtpd_null_access_lookup_key (default: <>)

       The lookup key to be used in SMTP access(5) tables instead of the null sender address.

smtpd_peername_lookup (default: yes)

       Attempt to look up the remote SMTP client hostname, and verify  that  the  name  matches  the  client  IP
       address.  A  client name is set to "unknown" when it cannot be looked up or verified, or when name lookup
       is disabled.  Turning off name lookup reduces delays due to DNS lookup and increases the maximal  inbound
       delivery rate.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_per_record_deadline (default: normal: no, overload: yes)

       Change  the  behavior  of the smtpd_timeout and smtpd_starttls_timeout time limits, from a time limit per
       read or write system call, to a time limit to send or receive a complete record (an  SMTP  command  line,
       SMTP  response  line,  SMTP  message content line, or TLS protocol message).  This limits the impact from
       hostile peers that trickle data one byte at a time.

       Note: when per-record deadlines are enabled, a short timeout may cause problems with TLS over  very  slow
       network  connections.   The  reasons  are  that  a TLS protocol message can be up to 16 kbytes long (with
       TLSv1), and that an entire TLS protocol message must be sent or received within the per-record deadline.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.9-3.6. With older Postfix releases, the behavior  is  as  if  this
       parameter is set to "no". Postfix 3.7 and later use smtpd_per_request_deadline.

smtpd_per_request_deadline (default: normal: no, overload: yes)

       Change  the  behavior  of the smtpd_timeout and smtpd_starttls_timeout time limits, from a time limit per
       plaintext or TLS read or write call, to a combined time limit for receiving a complete SMTP  request  and
       for  sending  a  complete SMTP response. The deadline limits only the time spent waiting for plaintext or
       TLS read or write calls, not time spent elsewhere.  The  per-request  deadline  limits  the  impact  from
       hostile peers that trickle data one byte at a time.

       See smtpd_min_data_rate for how the per-request deadline is managed during the DATA and BDAT phase.

       Note:  when  per-request  deadlines are enabled, a short time limit may cause problems with TLS over very
       slow network connections. The reason is that a TLS protocol message can be up to  16  kbytes  long  (with
       TLSv1), and that an entire TLS protocol message must be transferred within the per-request deadline.

       This  feature  is available in Postfix 3.7 and later. A weaker feature, called smtpd_per_record_deadline,
       is available with Postfix 2.9-3.6. With older Postfix releases, the behavior is as if this  parameter  is
       set to "no".

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.7 and later.

smtpd_policy_service_default_action (default: 451 4.3.5 Server configuration problem)

       The  default  action  when  an  SMTPD  policy service request fails.  Specify "DUNNO" to behave as if the
       failed  SMTPD policy service request was not sent, and to continue processing other access  restrictions,
       if any.

       Limitations:

       •      This  parameter  may  specify  any  value  that  would be a valid SMTPD policy server response (or
              access(5) map lookup result).  An access(5) map or policy server in this parameter value may  need
              to be declared in advance with a restriction_class setting.

       •      If  the  specified action invokes another check_policy_service request, that request will have the
              built-in default action.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

smtpd_policy_service_max_idle (default: 300s)

       The time after which an idle SMTPD policy service connection is closed.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtpd_policy_service_max_ttl (default: 1000s)

       The time after which an active SMTPD policy service connection is closed.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtpd_policy_service_policy_context (default: empty)

       Optional information that the Postfix SMTP server specifies in the "policy_context" attribute of a policy
       service request (originally, to share the  same  service  endpoint  among  multiple  check_policy_service
       clients).

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.1 and later.

smtpd_policy_service_request_limit (default: 0)

       The maximal number of requests per SMTPD policy service connection, or zero (no limit). Once a connection
       reaches  this  limit,  the  connection is closed and the next request will be sent over a new connection.
       This is a workaround to avoid error-recovery delays with policy servers that cannot maintain a persistent
       connection.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

smtpd_policy_service_retry_delay (default: 1s)

       The delay between attempts to resend a failed SMTPD policy service request. Specify a value greater  than
       zero.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

smtpd_policy_service_timeout (default: 100s)

       The time limit for connecting to, writing to, or receiving from a delegated SMTPD policy server.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtpd_policy_service_try_limit (default: 2)

       The  maximal number of attempts to send an SMTPD policy service request before giving up. Specify a value
       greater than zero.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

smtpd_proxy_ehlo (default: $myhostname)

       How the Postfix SMTP server announces itself to the proxy filter.  By default, the  Postfix  hostname  is
       used.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtpd_proxy_filter (default: empty)

       The  hostname  and  TCP  port  of  the mail filtering proxy server.  The proxy receives all mail from the
       Postfix SMTP server, and is supposed to give the result to another Postfix SMTP server process.

       Specify "host:port" or "inet:host:port"  for  a  TCP  endpoint,  or  "unix:pathname"  for  a  UNIX-domain
       endpoint. The host can be specified as an IP address or as a symbolic name; no MX lookups are done.  When
       no  "host" or "host:" is specified, the local machine is assumed.  Pathname interpretation is relative to
       the Postfix queue directory.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       The "inet:" and "unix:" prefixes are available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_proxy_options (default: empty)

       List of options that control how the Postfix SMTP server communicates with a before-queue content filter.
       Specify zero or more of the following, separated by comma or whitespace.

       speed_adjust
              Do not connect to a before-queue content filter until an entire message has  been  received.  This
              reduces the number of simultaneous before-queue content filter processes.

       NOTE  1:  A  filter  must  not selectively reject recipients of a multi-recipient message.  Rejecting all
       recipients is OK, as is accepting all recipients.

       NOTE 2: This feature increases the minimum amount of free queue space by $message_size_limit.  The  extra
       space is needed to save the message to a temporary file.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7 and later.

smtpd_proxy_timeout (default: 100s)

       The  time  limit  for  connecting  to  a  proxy  filter and for sending or receiving information.  When a
       connection fails the client gets a generic error message while more detailed information is logged to the
       maillog file.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtpd_recipient_limit (default: 1000)

       The maximal number of recipients that the Postfix SMTP server accepts per message delivery request.

smtpd_recipient_overshoot_limit (default: 1000)

       The  number  of  recipients  that  a  remote  SMTP  client can send in excess of the limit specified with
       $smtpd_recipient_limit, before the Postfix SMTP server increments the per-session error  count  for  each
       excess recipient.

smtpd_recipient_restrictions (default: see postconf -d output)

       Optional  restrictions  that  the Postfix SMTP server applies in the context of a client RCPT TO command,
       after smtpd_relay_restrictions.  See SMTPD_ACCESS_README, section  "Delayed  evaluation  of  SMTP  access
       restriction lists" for a discussion of evaluation context and time.

       With  Postfix  versions before 2.10, the rules for relay permission and spam blocking were combined under
       smtpd_recipient_restrictions,  resulting  in  error-prone  configuration.   As  of  Postfix  2.10,  relay
       permission  rules  are  preferably  implemented  with smtpd_relay_restrictions, so that a permissive spam
       blocking policy under smtpd_recipient_restrictions will no longer  result  in  a  permissive  mail  relay
       policy.

       For   backwards   compatibility,   sites   that  migrate  from  Postfix  versions  before  2.10  can  set
       smtpd_relay_restrictions to the empty value, and use smtpd_recipient_restrictions exactly as before.

       IMPORTANT: Either the smtpd_relay_restrictions or the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter must specify
       at least one of the following restrictions. Otherwise Postfix will refuse to receive mail:

           reject, reject_unauth_destination

           defer, defer_if_permit, defer_unauth_destination

       Specify a list of restrictions, separated by commas and/or whitespace.  Continue long lines  by  starting
       the next line with whitespace.  Restrictions are applied in the order as specified; the first restriction
       that matches wins.

       The  following  restrictions  are  specific  to  the  recipient address that is received with the RCPT TO
       command.

       check_recipient_access type:table
              Search the specified access(5) database for the resolved RCPT TO address, domain, parent  domains,
              or localpart@, and execute the corresponding action.

       check_recipient_a_access type:table
              Search  the  specified access(5) database for the IP addresses for the RCPT TO domain, and execute
              the corresponding action.  Note: a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons. Instead,  use
              DUNNO in order to exclude specific hosts from denylists.  This feature is available in Postfix 3.0
              and later.

       check_recipient_mx_access type:table
              Search  the  specified access(5) database for the MX hosts for the RCPT TO domain, and execute the
              corresponding action.  If no MX record is found, look up A or AAAA records, just like the  Postfix
              SMTP client would. Note: a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons. Instead, use DUNNO in
              order  to  exclude  specific  hosts  from denylists.  This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and
              later.

       check_recipient_ns_access type:table
              Search the specified access(5) database for the DNS servers for the RCPT TO  domain,  and  execute
              the  corresponding action.  Note: a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons. Instead, use
              DUNNO in order to exclude specific hosts from denylists.  This feature is available in Postfix 2.1
              and later.

       permit_auth_destination
              Permit the request when one of the following is true:

       •      Postfix is a mail forwarder: the resolved RCPT TO domain matches  $relay_domains  or  a  subdomain
              thereof, and the address contains no sender-specified routing (user@elsewhere@domain),

       •      Postfix   is   the  final  destination:  the  resolved  RCPT  TO  domain  matches  $mydestination,
              $inet_interfaces, $proxy_interfaces, $virtual_alias_domains, or $virtual_mailbox_domains, and  the
              address contains no sender-specified routing (user@elsewhere@domain).

       permit_mx_backup
              Permit  the  request when the local mail system is a backup MX for the RCPT TO domain, or when the
              domain is an authorized destination (see permit_auth_destination for definition).

       •      Safety: permit_mx_backup does not accept addresses that have sender-specified routing  information
              (example: user@elsewhere@domain).

       •      Safety:  permit_mx_backup  can  be  vulnerable  to  mis-use  when  access  is  not restricted with
              permit_mx_backup_networks.

       •      Safety: as of Postfix version 2.3, permit_mx_backup no longer accepts the address when  the  local
              mail  system  is  a  primary MX for the recipient domain.  Exception: permit_mx_backup accepts the
              address when it specifies an authorized destination (see permit_auth_destination for definition).

       •      Limitation: mail may be rejected in case of a temporary DNS lookup problem with Postfix  prior  to
              version 2.0.

       reject_non_fqdn_recipient
              Reject  the  request  when  the  RCPT TO address specifies a domain that is not in fully-qualified
              domain form, as required by the RFC.
              The non_fqdn_reject_code parameter specifies the response code  for  rejected  requests  (default:
              504).

       reject_rhsbl_recipient rbl_domain=d.d.d.d
              Reject  the request when the RCPT TO domain is listed with the A record "d.d.d.d" under rbl_domain
              (Postfix version 2.1 and later only).  Each "d" is  a  number,  or  a  pattern  inside  "[]"  that
              contains  one  or  more  ";"-separated  numbers  or number..number ranges (Postfix version 2.8 and
              later). If no "=d.d.d.d" is specified, reject the request when the RCPT TO domain is  listed  with
              any A record under rbl_domain.
              The  maps_rbl_reject_code  parameter  specifies  the response code for rejected requests (default:
              554); the default_rbl_reply parameter specifies the default server reply; and  the  rbl_reply_maps
              parameter  specifies  tables with server replies indexed by rbl_domain.  This feature is available
              in Postfix version 2.0 and later.

       reject_unauth_destination
              Reject the request unless one of the following is true:

       •      Postfix is a mail forwarder: the resolved RCPT TO domain matches  $relay_domains  or  a  subdomain
              thereof, and contains no sender-specified routing (user@elsewhere@domain),

       •      Postfix   is   the  final  destination:  the  resolved  RCPT  TO  domain  matches  $mydestination,
              $inet_interfaces,  $proxy_interfaces,  $virtual_alias_domains,  or  $virtual_mailbox_domains,  and
              contains no sender-specified routing (user@elsewhere@domain).
              The  relay_domains_reject_code  parameter  specifies  the  response  code  for  rejected  requests
              (default: 554).

       defer_unauth_destination
              Reject the same requests as reject_unauth_destination, with  a  non-permanent  error  code.   This
              feature is available in Postfix 2.10 and later.

       reject_unknown_recipient_domain
              Reject the request when Postfix is not final destination for the recipient domain, and the RCPT TO
              domain  has  1)  no DNS MX and no DNS A record or 2) a malformed MX record such as a record with a
              zero-length MX hostname (Postfix version 2.3 and later).
              The  reply  is  specified  with  the   unknown_address_reject_code   parameter   (default:   450),
              unknown_address_tempfail_action  (default:  defer_if_permit),  or  556  (nullmx,  Postfix  3.0 and
              later). See the respective parameter descriptions for details.

       reject_unlisted_recipient (with Postfix version 2.0: check_recipient_maps)
              Reject the request when the RCPT TO address is not listed in the list of valid recipients for  its
              domain  class.  See  the  smtpd_reject_unlisted_recipient parameter description for details.  This
              feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       reject_unverified_recipient
              Reject the request when mail to the RCPT TO address is known to  bounce,  or  when  the  recipient
              address  destination  is  not  reachable.   Address  verification  information  is  managed by the
              verify(8) server; see the ADDRESS_VERIFICATION_README file for details.
              The unverified_recipient_reject_code parameter specifies  the  numerical  response  code  when  an
              address  is known to bounce (default: 450, change it to 550 when you are confident that it is safe
              to do so).
              The unverified_recipient_defer_code parameter  specifies  the  numerical  response  code  when  an
              address probe failed due to a temporary problem (default: 450).
              The  unverified_recipient_tempfail_action  parameter  specifies  the  action  after  address probe
              failure due to a temporary problem (default: defer_if_permit).
              This feature breaks for aliased addresses with "enable_original_recipient = no" (Postfix <= 3.2).
              This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       Other restrictions that are valid in this context:

       •      Generic  restrictions  that  can  be  used  in  any  SMTP   command   context,   described   under
              smtpd_client_restrictions.

       •      SMTP     command     specific     restrictions    described    under    smtpd_client_restrictions,
              smtpd_helo_restrictions and smtpd_sender_restrictions.

       Example:

       # The Postfix before 2.10 default mail relay policy. Later Postfix
       # versions implement this preferably with smtpd_relay_restrictions.
       smtpd_recipient_restrictions = permit_mynetworks, reject_unauth_destination

smtpd_reject_footer (default: empty)

       Optional information that is appended after each Postfix SMTP server 4XX or 5XX response.

       The following example uses "\c" at the start of the template (supported in Postfix  2.10  and  later)  to
       suppress  the  line  break between the reply text and the footer text. With earlier Postfix versions, the
       footer text always begins on a new line, and the "\c" is output literally.

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
           smtpd_reject_footer = \c. For assistance, call 800-555-0101.
            Please provide the following information in your problem report:
            time ($localtime), client ($client_address) and server
            ($server_name).

       Server response:

           550-5.5.1 <user@example> Recipient address rejected: User
           unknown. For assistance, call 800-555-0101. Please provide the
           following information in your problem report: time (Jan 4 15:42:00),
           client (192.168.1.248) and server (mail1.example.com).

       Note: the above text is meant to make it easier to find the Postfix logfile records  for  a  failed  SMTP
       session. The text itself is not logged to the Postfix SMTP server's maillog file.

       Be  sure  to  keep  the  text as short as possible. Long text may be truncated before it is logged to the
       remote SMTP client's maillog file, or  before  it  is  returned  to  the  sender  in  a  delivery  status
       notification.

       The  template  text  is  not  subject  to  Postfix configuration parameter $name expansion. Instead, this
       feature supports a limited number of $name attributes in the footer text. These attributes  are  replaced
       with their current value for the SMTP session.

       Note:   specify   $$name   in   footer   text   that   is   looked   up   from   regexp:  or  pcre:-based
       smtpd_reject_footer_maps, otherwise the Postfix server will not use  the  footer  text  and  will  log  a
       warning instead.

       client_address
              The Client IP address that is logged in the maillog file.

       client_port
              The client TCP port that is logged in the maillog file.

       localtime
              The server local time (Mmm dd hh:mm:ss) that is logged in the maillog file.

       server_name
              The  server's  myhostname  value.   This  attribute is made available for sites with multiple MTAs
              (perhaps behind a load-balancer), where the server name  can  help  the  server  support  team  to
              quickly find the right log files.

       Notes:

       •      NOT SUPPORTED are other attributes such as sender, recipient, or main.cf parameters.

       •      For safety reasons, text that does not match $smtpd_expansion_filter is censored.

       This  feature  supports  the  two-character sequence \n as a request for a line break in the footer text.
       Postfix automatically inserts after each line  break  the  three-digit  SMTP  reply  code  (and  optional
       enhanced status code) from the original Postfix reject message.

       To  work  around mail software that mis-handles multi-line replies, specify the two-character sequence \c
       at the start of the template.  This suppresses the line break between the reply text and the footer  text
       (Postfix 2.10 and later).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

smtpd_reject_footer_maps (default: empty)

       Lookup  tables,  indexed  by  the  complete  Postfix  SMTP server 4xx or 5xx response, with reject footer
       templates. See smtpd_reject_footer for details.

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma. Tables will be searched
       in the specified order until a match is found.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

smtpd_reject_unlisted_recipient (default: yes)

       Request that the Postfix SMTP server rejects mail for unknown recipient addresses, even when no  explicit
       reject_unlisted_recipient  access  restriction is specified. This prevents the Postfix queue from filling
       up with undeliverable MAILER-DAEMON messages.

       An address is considered "unknown" when 1) it does not match a virtual(5) alias or canonical(5)  mapping,
       and  2)  the  address  is  not  valid  for  its  address  class.  For a definition of class-based address
       validation, see ADDRESS_CLASS_README.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtpd_reject_unlisted_sender (default: no)

       Request that the Postfix SMTP server rejects mail from unknown sender addresses, even  when  no  explicit
       reject_unlisted_sender  access  restriction  is specified. This can slow down an explosion of forged mail
       from worms or viruses.

       An address is considered "unknown" when 1) it does not match a virtual(5) alias or canonical(5)  mapping,
       and  2)  the  address  is  not  valid  for  its  address  class.  For a definition of class-based address
       validation, see ADDRESS_CLASS_README.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtpd_relay_before_recipient_restrictions (default: see postconf -d output)

       Evaluate      smtpd_relay_restrictions      before      smtpd_recipient_restrictions.       Historically,
       smtpd_relay_restrictions  was  evaluated  after  smtpd_recipient_restrictions,  contradicting  documented
       behavior.

       Background: the smtpd_relay_restrictions feature is primarily designed to enforce a mail relaying policy,
       while smtpd_recipient_restrictions is primarily designed  to  enforce  spam  blocking  policy.  Both  are
       evaluated while replying to the RCPT TO command, and both support the same features.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.6 and later.

smtpd_relay_restrictions (default: permit_mynetworks, permit_sasl_authenticated, defer_unauth_destination)

       Access  restrictions  for  mail  relay control that the Postfix SMTP server applies in the context of the
       RCPT  TO  command,  before  smtpd_recipient_restrictions.   See  SMTPD_ACCESS_README,  section   "Delayed
       evaluation of SMTP access restriction lists" for a discussion of evaluation context and time.

       With  Postfix  versions before 2.10, the rules for relay permission and spam blocking were combined under
       smtpd_recipient_restrictions,  resulting  in  error-prone  configuration.   As  of  Postfix  2.10,  relay
       permission  rules  are  preferably  implemented  with smtpd_relay_restrictions, so that a permissive spam
       blocking policy under smtpd_recipient_restrictions will no longer  result  in  a  permissive  mail  relay
       policy.

       For   backwards   compatibility,   sites   that  migrate  from  Postfix  versions  before  2.10  can  set
       smtpd_relay_restrictions to the empty value, and use smtpd_recipient_restrictions exactly as before.

       By default, the Postfix SMTP server accepts:

       •      Mail from clients whose IP address matches $mynetworks, or:

       •      Mail from clients who are SASL authenticated, or:

       •      Mail to  remote  destinations  that  match  $relay_domains,  except  for  addresses  that  contain
              sender-specified routing (user@elsewhere@domain), or:

       •      Mail  to  local  destinations  that  match  $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces, $mydestination,
              $virtual_alias_domains, or $virtual_mailbox_domains.

       IMPORTANT: Either the smtpd_relay_restrictions or the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter must specify
       at least one of the following restrictions. Otherwise Postfix will refuse to receive mail:

           reject, reject_unauth_destination

           defer, defer_if_permit, defer_unauth_destination

       Specify a list of restrictions, separated by commas and/or whitespace.  Continue long lines  by  starting
       the   next   line   with   whitespace.    The   same  restrictions  are  available  as  documented  under
       smtpd_recipient_restrictions.

       This feature is available in Postix 2.10 and later.

smtpd_restriction_classes (default: empty)

       User-defined  aliases  for  groups  of  access  restrictions.   The   aliases   can   be   specified   in
       smtpd_recipient_restrictions etc., and on the right-hand side of a Postfix access(5) table.

       One  major  application  is for implementing per-recipient UCE control.  See the RESTRICTION_CLASS_README
       document for other examples.

smtpd_sasl_application_name (default: smtpd)

       The application name that the Postfix SMTP server uses for SASL server initialization. This controls  the
       name  of  the  SASL configuration file. The default value is smtpd, corresponding to a SASL configuration
       file named smtpd.conf.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and 2.2. With Postfix 2.3 it was renamed to smtpd_sasl_path.

smtpd_sasl_auth_enable (default: no)

       Enable SASL authentication in the Postfix SMTP server. By default, the Postfix SMTP server does  not  use
       authentication.

       If a remote SMTP client is authenticated, the permit_sasl_authenticated access restriction can be used to
       permit relay access, like this:

           # With Postfix 2.10 and later, the mail relay policy is
           # preferably specified under smtpd_relay_restrictions.
           smtpd_relay_restrictions =
               permit_mynetworks, permit_sasl_authenticated, ...

       # With Postfix before 2.10, the relay policy can be
       # specified only under smtpd_recipient_restrictions.
       smtpd_recipient_restrictions =
           permit_mynetworks, permit_sasl_authenticated, ...

       To reject all SMTP connections from unauthenticated clients, specify "smtpd_delay_reject = yes" (which is
       the default) and use:

           smtpd_client_restrictions = permit_sasl_authenticated, reject

       See the SASL_README file for SASL configuration and operation details.

smtpd_sasl_authenticated_header (default: no)

       Report the SASL authenticated user name in the smtpd(8) Received message header.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_sasl_exceptions_networks (default: empty)

       What remote SMTP clients the Postfix SMTP server will not offer AUTH support to.

       Some  clients  (Netscape 4 at least) have a bug that causes them to require a login and password whenever
       AUTH is offered, whether it's necessary or not. To work around this, specify, for example, $mynetworks to
       prevent Postfix from offering AUTH to local clients.

       Specify a list of network/netmask patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. The mask specifies the
       number of bits in the network part of a host address. You can also specify "/file/name"  or  "type:table"
       patterns.   A  "/file/name"  pattern  is replaced by its contents; a "type:table" lookup table is matched
       when a table entry matches a lookup string (the lookup  result  is  ignored).   Continue  long  lines  by
       starting  the  next  line with whitespace. Specify "!pattern" to exclude an address or network block from
       the list.  The form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later.

       Note: IP version 6 address information must be specified inside [] in the  smtpd_sasl_exceptions_networks
       value,  and  in files specified with "/file/name".  IP version 6 addresses contain the ":" character, and
       would otherwise be confused with a "type:table" pattern.

       Example:

       smtpd_sasl_exceptions_networks = $mynetworks

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtpd_sasl_local_domain (default: empty)

       The name of the Postfix SMTP server's local SASL authentication realm.

       By default, the local authentication realm name is the null string.

       Examples:

       smtpd_sasl_local_domain = $mydomain
       smtpd_sasl_local_domain = $myhostname

smtpd_sasl_mechanism_filter (default: !external, static:rest)

       If non-empty, a filter for the SASL mechanism names that the Postfix SMTP server  will  announce  in  the
       EHLO  response.  By  default,  the  Postfix SMTP server will not announce the EXTERNAL mechanism, because
       Postfix support for that is not implemented.

       Specify mechanism names, "/file/name" patterns, or "type:table" lookup  tables,  separated  by  comma  or
       whitespace.  The  right-hand  side  result  from  "type:table"  lookups is ignored. Specify "!pattern" to
       exclude a mechanism name from the list.

       Examples:

       smtpd_sasl_mechanism_filter = !external, !gssapi, static:rest
       smtpd_sasl_mechanism_filter = login, plain
       smtpd_sasl_mechanism_filter = /etc/postfix/smtpd_mechs

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.6 and later.

smtpd_sasl_path (default: smtpd)

       Implementation-specific information that the Postfix SMTP server  passes  through  to  the  SASL  plug-in
       implementation  that  is  selected  with  smtpd_sasl_type.   Typically  this  specifies  the  name  of  a
       configuration file or rendezvous point.

       This  feature  is  available  in  Postfix  2.3  and  later.   In   earlier   releases   it   was   called
       smtpd_sasl_application_name.

smtpd_sasl_response_limit (default: 12288)

       The  maximum  length  of  a  SASL  client's  response  to a server challenge.  When the client's "initial
       response" is longer than the normal limit for SMTP commands, the client must omit its  initial  response,
       and wait for an empty server challenge; it can then send what would have been its "initial response" as a
       response  to the empty server challenge.  RFC4954 requires the server to accept client responses up to at
       least 12288 octets of base64-encoded text.  The  default  value  is  therefore  also  the  minimum  value
       accepted for this parameter.

       This  feature  is  available  in Postfix 3.4 and later. Prior versions use "line_length_limit", which may
       need to be raised to accommodate larger client responses, as may be needed with GSSAPI authentication  of
       Windows AD users who are members of many groups.

smtpd_sasl_security_options (default: noanonymous)

       Postfix  SMTP  server  SASL security options; as of Postfix 2.3 the list of available features depends on
       the SASL server implementation that is selected with smtpd_sasl_type.

       The following security features are defined for the cyrus server SASL implementation:

       Restrict what authentication mechanisms the Postfix SMTP server will offer to the client.   The  list  of
       available authentication mechanisms is system dependent.

       Specify zero or more of the following:

       noplaintext
              Disallow methods that use plaintext passwords.

       noactive
              Disallow methods subject to active (non-dictionary) attack.

       nodictionary
              Disallow methods subject to passive (dictionary) attack.

       noanonymous
              Disallow methods that allow anonymous authentication.

       forward_secrecy
              Only allow methods that support forward secrecy (Dovecot only).

       mutual_auth
              Only allow methods that provide mutual authentication (not available with Cyrus SASL version 1).

       By default, the Postfix SMTP server accepts plaintext passwords but not anonymous logins.

       Warning:  it  appears  that  clients  try authentication methods in the order as advertised by the server
       (e.g., PLAIN ANONYMOUS CRAM-MD5) which means that if you disable plaintext passwords, clients will log in
       anonymously, even when they should be able to use CRAM-MD5.  So, if you disable plaintext logins, disable
       anonymous logins too.  Postfix treats anonymous login as no authentication.

       Example:

       smtpd_sasl_security_options = noanonymous, noplaintext

smtpd_sasl_service (default: smtp)

       The service name that  is  passed  to  the  SASL  plug-in  that  is  selected  with  smtpd_sasl_type  and
       smtpd_sasl_path.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.11 and later. Prior versions behave as if "smtp" is specified.

smtpd_sasl_tls_security_options (default: $smtpd_sasl_security_options)

       The  SASL  authentication  security  options  that  the  Postfix  SMTP server uses for TLS encrypted SMTP
       sessions.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_sasl_type (default: cyrus)

       The SASL plug-in type that the Postfix SMTP server should use for authentication. The available types are
       listed with the "postconf -a" command.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_sender_login_maps (default: empty)

       Optional lookup table with the SASL login names that own the sender (MAIL FROM) addresses.

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma. Tables will be searched
       in the specified order until a match is found.  With lookups from indexed files such as  DB  or  DBM,  or
       from  networked  tables  such as NIS, LDAP or SQL, the following search operations are done with a sender
       address of user@domain:

       1) user@domain
              This table lookup is always done and has the highest precedence.

       2) user
              This table lookup is done only when the domain part  of  the  sender  address  matches  $myorigin,
              $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.

       3) @domain
              This table lookup is done last and has the lowest precedence.

       In  all  cases  the  result  of  table  lookup  must  be either "not found" or a list of SASL login names
       separated by comma and/or whitespace.

smtpd_sender_restrictions (default: empty)

       Optional restrictions that the Postfix SMTP server applies in the context of a client MAIL FROM  command.
       See  SMTPD_ACCESS_README,  section "Delayed evaluation of SMTP access restriction lists" for a discussion
       of evaluation context and time.

       The default is to permit everything.

       Specify a list of restrictions, separated by commas and/or whitespace.  Continue long lines  by  starting
       the next line with whitespace.  Restrictions are applied in the order as specified; the first restriction
       that matches wins.

       The following restrictions are specific to the sender address received with the MAIL FROM command.

       check_sender_access type:table
              Search  the  specified  access(5)  database  for the MAIL FROM address, domain, parent domains, or
              localpart@, and execute the corresponding action.

       check_sender_a_access type:table
              Search the specified access(5) database for the IP addresses for the MAIL FROM domain, and execute
              the corresponding action.  Note: a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons. Instead,  use
              DUNNO in order to exclude specific hosts from denylists.  This feature is available in Postfix 3.0
              and later.

       check_sender_mx_access type:table
              Search the specified access(5) database for the MX hosts for the MAIL FROM domain, and execute the
              corresponding  action.  If no MX record is found, look up A or AAAA records, just like the Postfix
              SMTP client would. Note: a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons. Instead, use DUNNO in
              order to exclude specific hosts from denylists.  This feature is  available  in  Postfix  2.1  and
              later.

       check_sender_ns_access type:table
              Search  the specified access(5) database for the DNS servers for the MAIL FROM domain, and execute
              the corresponding action.  Note: a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons. Instead,  use
              DUNNO in order to exclude specific hosts from denylists.  This feature is available in Postfix 2.1
              and later.

       reject_authenticated_sender_login_mismatch
              Reject the request when the client is authenticated with SASL, but either the MAIL FROM address is
              not listed in $smtpd_sender_login_maps, or the SASL login name is not an owner for that address.
              This  prevents  an authenticated client from using a MAIL FROM address that they do not explicitly
              own.
              This feature is available in Postfix version 2.1 and later.

       reject_known_sender_login_mismatch
              When the client is authenticated with SASL, reject the request  when  the  MAIL  FROM  address  is
              listed in $smtpd_sender_login_maps, but the SASL login name is not an owner for that address.
              When  the  client is not authenticated with SASL, reject the request when SASL is enabled, and the
              MAIL FROM address is listed in $smtpd_sender_login_maps.
              This protects any MAIL FROM address  that  is  listed  in  $smtpd_sender_login_maps,  while  still
              allowing a client to use any unlisted MAIL FROM address.
              This feature is available in Postfix version 2.11 and later.

       reject_non_fqdn_sender
              Reject  the  request  when the MAIL FROM address specifies a domain that is not in fully-qualified
              domain form as required by the RFC.
              The non_fqdn_reject_code parameter specifies the response code  for  rejected  requests  (default:
              504).

       reject_rhsbl_sender rbl_domain=d.d.d.d
              Reject  the  request  when  the  MAIL  FROM  domain  is  listed  with the A record "d.d.d.d" under
              rbl_domain (Postfix version 2.1 and later only).  Each "d" is a number, or a pattern  inside  "[]"
              that  contains one or more ";"-separated numbers or number..number ranges (Postfix version 2.8 and
              later). If no "=d.d.d.d" is specified, reject the request when the MAIL FROM domain is listed with
              any A record under rbl_domain.
              The maps_rbl_reject_code parameter specifies the response code  for  rejected  requests  (default:
              554);  the  default_rbl_reply parameter specifies the default server reply; and the rbl_reply_maps
              parameter specifies tables with server replies indexed by rbl_domain.  This feature  is  available
              in Postfix 2.0 and later.

       reject_sender_login_mismatch
              As   of   Postfix   2.1,   this   is  an  alias  for  "reject_authenticated_sender_login_mismatch,
              reject_unauthenticated_sender_login_mismatch".

       reject_unauthenticated_sender_login_mismatch
              Reject  the  request  when   SASL   is   enabled,   the   MAIL   FROM   address   is   listed   in
              $smtpd_sender_login_maps, but the client is not authenticated with SASL.
              With  SASL  enabled, this prevents an unauthenticated client from using any MAIL FROM address that
              is listed in $smtpd_sender_login_maps.
              This feature is available in Postfix version 2.1 and later.

       reject_unknown_sender_domain
              Reject the request when Postfix is not the final destination for the sender address, and the  MAIL
              FROM  domain  has  1)  no DNS MX and no DNS A record, or 2) a malformed MX record such as a record
              with a zero-length MX hostname (Postfix version 2.3 and later).
              The  reply  is  specified  with  the   unknown_address_reject_code   parameter   (default:   450),
              unknown_address_tempfail_action  (default:  defer_if_permit),  or  550  (nullmx,  Postfix  3.0 and
              later). See the respective parameter descriptions for details.

       reject_unlisted_sender
              Reject the request when the MAIL FROM address is not listed in the list of  valid  recipients  for
              its  domain  class.  See the smtpd_reject_unlisted_sender parameter description for details.  This
              feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       reject_unverified_sender
              Reject the request when mail to the MAIL FROM address is known  to  bounce,  or  when  the  sender
              address  destination  is  not  reachable.   Address  verification  information  is  managed by the
              verify(8) server; see the ADDRESS_VERIFICATION_README file for details.
              The unverified_sender_reject_code parameter specifies the numerical response code when an  address
              is  known  to  bounce  (default: 450, change into 550 when you are confident that it is safe to do
              so).
              The unverified_sender_defer_code specifies the numerical  response  code  when  an  address  probe
              failed due to a temporary problem (default: 450).
              The  unverified_sender_tempfail_action  parameter specifies the action after address probe failure
              due to a temporary problem (default: defer_if_permit).
              This feature breaks for aliased addresses with "enable_original_recipient = no" (Postfix <= 3.2).
              This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       Other restrictions that are valid in this context:

       •      Generic  restrictions  that  can  be  used  in  any  SMTP   command   context,   described   under
              smtpd_client_restrictions.

       •      SMTP    command    specific    restrictions    described   under   smtpd_client_restrictions   and
              smtpd_helo_restrictions.

       •      SMTP command specific restrictions described under  smtpd_recipient_restrictions.  When  recipient
              restrictions   are   listed   under   smtpd_sender_restrictions,   they   have  effect  only  with
              "smtpd_delay_reject = yes", so that $smtpd_sender_restrictions is evaluated at  the  time  of  the
              RCPT TO command.

       Examples:

       smtpd_sender_restrictions = reject_unknown_sender_domain
       smtpd_sender_restrictions = reject_unknown_sender_domain,
           check_sender_access hash:/etc/postfix/access

smtpd_service_name (default: smtpd)

       The  internal  service that postscreen(8) hands off allowed connections to. In a future version there may
       be different classes of SMTP service.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

smtpd_soft_error_limit (default: 10)

       The number of errors a remote SMTP client is allowed to make without delivering mail before  the  Postfix
       SMTP server slows down all its responses.

       •      With Postfix version 2.1 and later, when the error count is > $smtpd_soft_error_limit, the Postfix
              SMTP server delays all responses by $smtpd_error_sleep_time.

       •      With  Postfix  versions  2.0  and  earlier, when the error count is > $smtpd_soft_error_limit, the
              Postfix SMTP server delays  all  responses  by  the  larger  of  (number  of  errors)  seconds  or
              $smtpd_error_sleep_time.

       •      With  Postfix  versions  2.0  and earlier, when the error count is <= $smtpd_soft_error_limit, the
              Postfix SMTP server delays 4XX and 5XX responses by $smtpd_error_sleep_time.

smtpd_starttls_timeout (default: see postconf -d output)

       The time limit for Postfix SMTP server  write  and  read  operations  during  TLS  startup  and  shutdown
       handshake  procedures.  The current default value is stress-dependent. Before Postfix version 2.8, it was
       fixed at 300s.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_timeout (default: normal: 300s, overload: 10s)

       When the Postfix SMTP server wants to send an SMTP server response, how long the Postfix SMTP server will
       wait  for  an  underlying  network  write operation to complete; and when the Postfix SMTP server Postfix
       wants to receive an SMTP client request, how long the Postfix SMTP server will  wait  for  an  underlying
       network  read  operation  to  complete. See the smtpd_per_request_deadline for how this time limit may be
       enforced (with Postfix 2.9-3.6 see smtpd_per_record_deadline).

       Normally the default limit is 300s, but it changes under overload to  just  10s.  With  Postfix  2.5  and
       earlier, the SMTP server always uses a time limit of 300s by default.

       Note:  if  you  set  SMTP  time limits to very large values you may have to update the global ipc_timeout
       parameter.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

smtpd_tls_CAfile (default: empty)

       A  file  containing  (PEM  format)  CA certificates of root CAs trusted to sign either remote SMTP client
       certificates or intermediate CA certificates.  These are loaded into memory before  the  smtpd(8)  server
       enters the chroot jail. If the number of trusted roots is large, consider using smtpd_tls_CApath instead,
       but note that the latter directory must be present in the chroot jail if the smtpd(8) server is chrooted.
       This  file  may also be used to augment the server certificate trust chain, but it is best to include all
       the required certificates directly in the server certificate file.

       Specify  "smtpd_tls_CAfile  =  /path/to/system_CA_file"  to  use   ONLY   the   system-supplied   default
       Certification Authority certificates.

       Specify  "tls_append_default_CA  =  no" to prevent Postfix from appending the system-supplied default CAs
       and trusting third-party certificates.

       By default (see smtpd_tls_ask_ccert), client certificates are not requested, and smtpd_tls_CAfile  should
       remain  empty.  If  you  do  make  use  of  client  certificates,  the  distinguished  names (DNs) of the
       Certification Authorities listed in smtpd_tls_CAfile are sent to the remote SMTP  client  in  the  client
       certificate  request  message.  MUAs  with  multiple  client  certificates  may use the list of preferred
       Certification Authorities to select the correct client certificate.  You may want to put your "preferred"
       CA or CAs in this file, and install other trusted CAs in $smtpd_tls_CApath.

       Example:

       smtpd_tls_CAfile = /etc/postfix/CAcert.pem

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_CApath (default: empty)

       A directory containing (PEM format) CA certificates of root CAs trusted to sign either remote SMTP client
       certificates or intermediate CA certificates. Do not forget to create the necessary  "hash"  links  with,
       for  example,  "$OPENSSL_HOME/bin/c_rehash  /etc/postfix/certs".  To use smtpd_tls_CApath in chroot mode,
       this directory (or a copy) must be inside the chroot jail.

       Specify "smtpd_tls_CApath  =  /path/to/system_CA_directory"  to  use  ONLY  the  system-supplied  default
       Certification Authority certificates.

       Specify  "tls_append_default_CA  =  no" to prevent Postfix from appending the system-supplied default CAs
       and trusting third-party certificates.

       By default (see smtpd_tls_ask_ccert), client certificates are not requested, and smtpd_tls_CApath  should
       remain   empty.   In  contrast  to  smtpd_tls_CAfile,  DNs  of  Certification  Authorities  installed  in
       $smtpd_tls_CApath are not included in the client certificate request message. MUAs with  multiple  client
       certificates  may  use  the  list  of  preferred  Certification  Authorities to select the correct client
       certificate.  You may want to put your "preferred" CA  or  CAs  in  $smtpd_tls_CAfile,  and  install  the
       remaining trusted CAs in $smtpd_tls_CApath.

       Example:

       smtpd_tls_CApath = /etc/postfix/certs

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_always_issue_session_ids (default: yes)

       Force  the  Postfix  SMTP  server  to issue a TLS session id, even when TLS session caching is turned off
       (smtpd_tls_session_cache_database is empty). This behavior is compatible with Postfix < 2.3.

       With Postfix 2.3 and later the Postfix SMTP server can disable session id  generation  when  TLS  session
       caching  is turned off. This keeps remote SMTP clients from caching sessions that almost certainly cannot
       be re-used.

       By default, the Postfix SMTP server always generates TLS session ids. This works around a known defect in
       mail client applications such as MS Outlook, and may also  prevent  interoperability  issues  with  other
       MTAs.

       Example:

       smtpd_tls_always_issue_session_ids = no

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_tls_ask_ccert (default: no)

       Ask  a remote SMTP client for a client certificate. This information is needed for certificate based mail
       relaying with, for example, the permit_tls_clientcerts feature.

       Some clients such as Netscape will either complain if no certificate is available (for the list of CAs in
       $smtpd_tls_CAfile) or will offer multiple client certificates to choose from. This may  be  annoying,  so
       this option is "off" by default.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_auth_only (default: no)

       When TLS encryption is optional in the Postfix SMTP server, do not announce or accept SASL authentication
       over unencrypted connections.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_ccert_verifydepth (default: 9)

       The  verification depth for remote SMTP client certificates. A depth of 1 is sufficient if the issuing CA
       is listed in a local CA file.

       The default verification depth is  9  (the  OpenSSL  default)  for  compatibility  with  earlier  Postfix
       behavior.  Prior to Postfix 2.5, the default value was 5, but the limit was not actually enforced. If you
       have set this to a lower non-default value, certificates with longer trust chains may now fail to verify.
       Certificate chains with 1 or 2 CAs are common, deeper chains are more rare and any number between 5 and 9
       should suffice in practice. You can choose a  lower  number  if,  for  example,  you  trust  certificates
       directly signed by an issuing CA but not any CAs it delegates to.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_cert_file (default: empty)

       File  with the Postfix SMTP server RSA certificate in PEM format.  This file may also contain the Postfix
       SMTP server private RSA key.  With Postfix >=  3.4  the  preferred  way  to  configure  server  keys  and
       certificates is via the "smtpd_tls_chain_files" parameter.

       Public  Internet  MX hosts without certificates signed by a "reputable" CA must generate, and be prepared
       to present to most clients, a self-signed or private-CA signed certificate. The client will not  be  able
       to  authenticate  the  server,  but  unless  it is running Postfix 2.3 or similar software, it will still
       insist on a server certificate.

       For servers that are not public Internet MX hosts, Postfix supports configurations with no  certificates.
       This  entails the use of just the anonymous TLS ciphers, which are not supported by typical SMTP clients.
       Since some clients may not fall back to plain text after a  TLS  handshake  failure,  a  certificate-less
       Postfix  SMTP  server  will be unable to receive email from some TLS-enabled clients. To avoid accidental
       configurations  with  no  certificates,  Postfix  enables  certificate-less  operation  only   when   the
       administrator  explicitly  sets  "smtpd_tls_cert_file  = none". This ensures that new Postfix SMTP server
       configurations will not accidentally enable TLS without certificates.

       Note that server certificates are not optional in TLS 1.3. To run  without  certificates  you'd  have  to
       disable  the  TLS  1.3  protocol  by  including  '!TLSv1.3'  in  "smtpd_tls_protocols"  and  perhaps also
       "smtpd_tls_mandatory_protocols".   It  is  simpler  instead  to  just  configure  a  certificate   chain.
       Certificate-less operation is not recommended.

       Both  RSA  and  DSA  certificates are supported.  When both types are present, the cipher used determines
       which certificate will be presented to the client.  For Netscape  and  OpenSSL  clients  without  special
       cipher choices the RSA certificate is preferred.

       To enable a remote SMTP client to verify the Postfix SMTP server certificate, the issuing CA certificates
       must  be  made  available  to  the  client.  You  should  include the required certificates in the server
       certificate file, the server certificate first, then the issuing CA(s) (bottom-up order).

       Example: the certificate for "server.example.com" was issued by "intermediate  CA"  which  itself  has  a
       certificate  of  "root  CA".   Create  the  server.pem file with "cat server_cert.pem intermediate_CA.pem
       root_CA.pem > server.pem".

       If you also want to verify client certificates issued by these CAs, you can add the  CA  certificates  to
       the  smtpd_tls_CAfile,  in  which  case  it  is  not  necessary  to have them in the smtpd_tls_cert_file,
       smtpd_tls_dcert_file (obsolete) or smtpd_tls_eccert_file.

       A certificate supplied here must be usable as an SSL server  certificate  and  hence  pass  the  "openssl
       verify -purpose sslserver ..." test.

       Example:

       smtpd_tls_cert_file = /etc/postfix/server.pem

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_chain_files (default: empty)

       List of one or more PEM files, each holding one or more private keys directly followed by a corresponding
       certificate  chain.   The file names are separated by commas and/or whitespace.  This parameter obsoletes
       the legacy algorithm-specific key and certificate file settings.  When this parameter is  non-empty,  the
       legacy parameters are ignored, and a warning is logged if any are also non-empty.

       With  the  proliferation  of  multiple  private  key  algorithms-which,  as of OpenSSL 1.1.1, include DSA
       (obsolete), RSA, ECDSA, Ed25519 and Ed448-it is increasingly impractical to use  separate  parameters  to
       configure  the  key  and  certificate  chain for each algorithm.  Therefore, Postfix now supports storing
       multiple keys and corresponding certificate chains in a single file or in a set of files.

       Each key must appear immediately before the corresponding certificate, optionally followed by  additional
       issuer certificates that complete the certificate chain for that key.  When multiple files are specified,
       they  are  equivalent  to  a single file that is concatenated from those files in the given order.  Thus,
       while a key must always precede its certificate and issuer chain, it can be in a separate file,  so  long
       as  that file is listed immediately before the file that holds the corresponding certificate chain.  Once
       all the files are concatenated, the sequence of PEM objects must be: key1, cert1, [chain1], key2,  cert2,
       [chain2], ..., keyN, certN, [chainN].

       Storing the private key in the same file as the corresponding certificate is more reliable.  With the key
       and  certificate  in  separate  files, there is a chance that during key rollover a Postfix process might
       load a private key and certificate from separate files that don't match.  Various operational errors  may
       even result in a persistent broken configuration in which the certificate does not match the private key.

       The  file  or files must contain at most one key of each type.  If, for example, two or more RSA keys and
       corresponding chains are listed, depending on the version of OpenSSL either only the  last  one  will  be
       used  or  a  configuration  error  may be detected.  Note that while "Ed25519" and "Ed448" are considered
       separate algorithms, the various ECDSA curves (typically one of prime256v1, secp384r1 or  secp521r1)  are
       considered  as  different  parameters  of  a single "ECDSA" algorithm, so it is not presently possible to
       configure keys for more than one ECDSA curve.

       RSA is still the most widely supported algorithm.  Presently (late 2018), ECDSA support  is  common,  but
       not  yet  universal,  and  Ed25519  and  Ed448  support  is  mostly absent.  Therefore, an RSA key should
       generally be configured, along with any additional keys for the other algorithms when desired.

       Example (separate files for each key and corresponding certificate chain):

           /etc/postfix/main.cf:
               smtpd_tls_chain_files =
                   ${config_directory}/ed25519.pem,
                   ${config_directory}/ed448.pem,
                   ${config_directory}/rsa.pem

           /etc/postfix/ed25519.pem:
               -----BEGIN PRIVATE KEY-----
               MC4CAQAwBQYDK2VwBCIEIEJfbbO4BgBQGBg9NAbIJaDBqZb4bC4cOkjtAH+Efbz3
               -----END PRIVATE KEY-----
               -----BEGIN CERTIFICATE-----
               MIIBKzCB3qADAgECAhQaw+rflRreYuUZBp0HuNn/e5rMZDAFBgMrZXAwFDESMBAG
               ...
               nC0egv51YPDWxEHom4QA

               -----END CERTIFICATE-----
           /etc/postfix/ed448.pem:
               -----BEGIN PRIVATE KEY-----
               MEcCAQAwBQYDK2VxBDsEOQf+m0P+G0qi+NZ0RolyeiE5zdlPQR8h8y4jByBifpIe
               LNler7nzHQJ1SLcOiXFHXlxp/84VZuh32A==
               -----END PRIVATE KEY-----
               -----BEGIN CERTIFICATE-----
               MIIBdjCB96ADAgECAhQSv4oP972KypOZPNPF4fmsiQoRHzAFBgMrZXEwFDESMBAG
               ...
               pQcWsx+4J29e6YWH3Cy/CdUaexKP4RPCZDrPX7bk5C2BQ+eeYOxyThMA

               -----END CERTIFICATE-----
           /etc/postfix/rsa.pem:
               -----BEGIN PRIVATE KEY-----
               MIIEvQIBADANBgkqhkiG9w0BAQEFAASCBKcwggSjAgEAAoIBAQDc4QusgkahH9rL
               ...
               ahQkZ3+krcaJvDSMgvu0tDc=
               -----END PRIVATE KEY-----
               -----BEGIN CERTIFICATE-----
               MIIC+DCCAeCgAwIBAgIUIUkrbk1GAemPCT8i9wKsTGDH7HswDQYJKoZIhvcNAQEL
               ...
               Rirz15HGVNTK8wzFd+nulPzwUo6dH2IU8KazmyRi7OGvpyrMlm15TRE2oyE=

               -----END CERTIFICATE-----
       Example (all keys and certificates in a single file):

           /etc/postfix/main.cf:
               smtpd_tls_chain_files = ${config_directory}/chains.pem

           /etc/postfix/chains.pem:
               -----BEGIN PRIVATE KEY-----
               MC4CAQAwBQYDK2VwBCIEIEJfbbO4BgBQGBg9NAbIJaDBqZb4bC4cOkjtAH+Efbz3
               -----END PRIVATE KEY-----
               -----BEGIN CERTIFICATE-----
               MIIBKzCB3qADAgECAhQaw+rflRreYuUZBp0HuNn/e5rMZDAFBgMrZXAwFDESMBAG
               ...
               nC0egv51YPDWxEHom4QA
               -----END CERTIFICATE-----
               -----BEGIN PRIVATE KEY-----
               MEcCAQAwBQYDK2VxBDsEOQf+m0P+G0qi+NZ0RolyeiE5zdlPQR8h8y4jByBifpIe
               LNler7nzHQJ1SLcOiXFHXlxp/84VZuh32A==
               -----END PRIVATE KEY-----
               -----BEGIN CERTIFICATE-----
               MIIBdjCB96ADAgECAhQSv4oP972KypOZPNPF4fmsiQoRHzAFBgMrZXEwFDESMBAG
               ...
               pQcWsx+4J29e6YWH3Cy/CdUaexKP4RPCZDrPX7bk5C2BQ+eeYOxyThMA
               -----END CERTIFICATE-----
               -----BEGIN PRIVATE KEY-----
               MIIEvQIBADANBgkqhkiG9w0BAQEFAASCBKcwggSjAgEAAoIBAQDc4QusgkahH9rL
               ...
               ahQkZ3+krcaJvDSMgvu0tDc=
               -----END PRIVATE KEY-----
               -----BEGIN CERTIFICATE-----
               MIIC+DCCAeCgAwIBAgIUIUkrbk1GAemPCT8i9wKsTGDH7HswDQYJKoZIhvcNAQEL
               ...
               Rirz15HGVNTK8wzFd+nulPzwUo6dH2IU8KazmyRi7OGvpyrMlm15TRE2oyE=

               -----END CERTIFICATE-----
       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

smtpd_tls_cipherlist (default: empty)

       Obsolete Postfix < 2.3 control for the Postfix SMTP  server  TLS  cipher  list.  It  is  easy  to  create
       interoperability  problems by choosing a non-default cipher list. Do not use a non-default TLS cipherlist
       for MX hosts on the public Internet. Clients that begin the TLS handshake, but are unable to agree  on  a
       common  cipher,  may not be able to send any email to the SMTP server. Using a restricted cipher list may
       be more appropriate for a dedicated MSA or an internal mailhub, where one can exert some control over the
       TLS software and settings of the connecting clients.

       Note: do not use "" quotes around the parameter value.

       This feature is available with Postfix version 2.2. It is not  used  with  Postfix  2.3  and  later;  use
       smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers instead.

smtpd_tls_ciphers (default: medium)

       The  minimum  TLS  cipher  grade that the Postfix SMTP server will use with opportunistic TLS encryption.
       Cipher types listed in smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers are excluded from the base definition  of  the  selected
       cipher  grade.  The default value is "medium" for Postfix releases after the middle of 2015, "export" for
       older releases.

       When TLS is mandatory the cipher  grade  is  chosen  via  the  smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers  configuration
       parameter, see there for syntax details.

       This   feature  is  available  in  Postfix  2.6  and  later.  With  earlier  Postfix  releases  only  the
       smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers parameter is implemented, and  opportunistic  TLS  always  uses  "export"  or
       better (i.e. all) ciphers.

smtpd_tls_dcert_file (default: empty)

       File  with the Postfix SMTP server DSA certificate in PEM format.  This file may also contain the Postfix
       SMTP server private DSA key.  The DSA algorithm is obsolete and should not be used.

       See the discussion under smtpd_tls_cert_file for more details.

       Example:

       smtpd_tls_dcert_file = /etc/postfix/server-dsa.pem

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_dh1024_param_file (default: empty)

       File with DH parameters that the Postfix SMTP server should use with non-export EDH ciphers.

       With Postfix >= 3.7, built with OpenSSL version is 3.0.0 or later, if the parameter value is either empty
       or "auto", then the DH parameter selection is delegated to the OpenSSL library, which selects appropriate
       parameters based on the TLS handshake.  This choice is likely to be  the  most  interoperable  with  SMTP
       clients  using  various  TLS  libraries, and custom local parameters are no longer recommended when using
       Postfix >= 3.7 built against OpenSSL 3.0.0.

       The best-practice choice of parameters uses a 2048-bit prime.   This  is  fine,  despite  the  historical
       "1024" in the parameter name.  Do not be tempted to use much larger values, performance degrades quickly,
       and  you  may  also  cease  to  interoperate  with  some mainstream SMTP clients.  As of Postfix 3.1, the
       compiled-in default prime is 2048-bits, and  it  is  not  strictly  necessary,  though  perhaps  somewhat
       beneficial to generate custom DH parameters.

       Instead  of using the exact same parameter sets as distributed with other TLS packages, it is more secure
       to generate your own set of parameters with something like the following commands:

           openssl dhparam -out /etc/postfix/dh2048.pem 2048
           openssl dhparam -out /etc/postfix/dh1024.pem 1024
           # As of Postfix 3.6, export-grade 512-bit DH parameters are no longer
           # supported or needed.
           openssl dhparam -out /etc/postfix/dh512.pem 512

       It is safe to share the same DH parameters between multiple Postfix instances.  If you  prefer,  you  can
       generate separate parameters for each instance.

       If  you  want  to  take  maximal  advantage of ciphers that offer forward secrecy see the Getting started
       section of FORWARD_SECRECY_README.  The full document conveniently presents all information about Postfix
       "perfect" forward secrecy support in one place: what forward secrecy is, how to tweak settings, and  what
       you can expect to see when Postfix uses ciphers with forward secrecy.

       Example:

       smtpd_tls_dh1024_param_file = /etc/postfix/dh2048.pem

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_dh512_param_file (default: empty)

       File  with  DH  parameters  that  the  Postfix SMTP server should use with export-grade EDH ciphers.  The
       default SMTP server cipher grade is "medium" with Postfix releases after the middle of  2015,  and  as  a
       result export-grade cipher suites are by default not used.

       With  Postfix  >= 3.6 export-grade Diffie-Hellman key exchange is no longer supported, and this parameter
       is silently ignored.

       See also the discussion under the smtpd_tls_dh1024_param_file configuration parameter.

       Example:

       smtpd_tls_dh512_param_file = /etc/postfix/dh_512.pem

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later, but is ignored in Postfix 3.6 and later.

smtpd_tls_dkey_file (default: $smtpd_tls_dcert_file)

       File with the Postfix SMTP server DSA private key in PEM format.  This file  may  be  combined  with  the
       Postfix  SMTP  server  DSA  certificate  file  specified with $smtpd_tls_dcert_file. The DSA algorithm is
       obsolete and should not be used.

       The private key must be accessible without a pass-phrase, i.e. it must not be encrypted. File permissions
       should grant read-only access to the system superuser account ("root"), and no access to anyone else.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_eccert_file (default: empty)

       File with the Postfix SMTP server ECDSA certificate in PEM  format.   This  file  may  also  contain  the
       Postfix  SMTP  server  private ECDSA key.  With Postfix >= 3.4 the preferred way to configure server keys
       and certificates is via the "smtpd_tls_chain_files" parameter.

       See the discussion under smtpd_tls_cert_file for more details.

       Example:

       smtpd_tls_eccert_file = /etc/postfix/ecdsa-scert.pem

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later, when Postfix is  compiled  and  linked  with  OpenSSL
       1.0.0 or later.

smtpd_tls_eckey_file (default: $smtpd_tls_eccert_file)

       File  with  the  Postfix SMTP server ECDSA private key in PEM format.  This file may be combined with the
       Postfix SMTP server ECDSA certificate file specified with $smtpd_tls_eccert_file.  With  Postfix  >=  3.4
       the preferred way to configure server keys and certificates is via the "smtpd_tls_chain_files" parameter.

       The private key must be accessible without a pass-phrase, i.e. it must not be encrypted. File permissions
       should grant read-only access to the system superuser account ("root"), and no access to anyone else.

       This  feature  is  available  in  Postfix 2.6 and later, when Postfix is compiled and linked with OpenSSL
       1.0.0 or later.

smtpd_tls_eecdh_grade (default: see postconf -d output)

       The Postfix SMTP server security grade for ephemeral elliptic-curve Diffie-Hellman (EECDH) key  exchange.
       As  of Postfix 3.6, the value of this parameter is always ignored, and Postfix behaves as though the auto
       value (described below) was chosen.

       The available choices are:

       auto   Use the most preferred curve that is supported by both the client and the  server.   This  setting
              requires  Postfix  >=  3.2 compiled and linked with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2.  This is the default setting
              under the above conditions (and the only setting used with Postfix >= 3.6).

       none   Don't use EECDH. Ciphers based on EECDH key exchange will be disabled.  This  is  the  default  in
              Postfix versions 2.6 and 2.7.

       strong Use  EECDH with approximately 128 bits of security at a reasonable computational cost. This is the
              default in Postfix versions 2.8-3.5.

       ultra  Use EECDH with approximately 192 bits of security at  computational  cost  that  is  approximately
              twice as high as 128 bit strength ECC.

       If  you  want  to  take  maximal  advantage of ciphers that offer forward secrecy see the Getting started
       section of FORWARD_SECRECY_README.  The full document conveniently presents all information about Postfix
       "perfect" forward secrecy support in one place: what forward secrecy is, how to tweak settings, and  what
       you can expect to see when Postfix uses ciphers with forward secrecy.

       This  feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later, when it is compiled and linked with OpenSSL 1.0.0 or
       later on platforms where EC algorithms have not been disabled by the vendor.

smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers (default: empty)

       List of ciphers or cipher types to exclude from the SMTP server cipher list at all TLS  security  levels.
       Excluding  valid  ciphers  can  create  interoperability  problems.  DO  NOT exclude ciphers unless it is
       essential to do so. This is not an OpenSSL cipherlist; it is a simple list separated by whitespace and/or
       commas. The elements are a single cipher, or one or more "+" separated cipher properties, in  which  case
       only ciphers matching all the properties are excluded.

       Examples (some of these will cause problems):

           smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers = aNULL
           smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers = MD5, DES
           smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers = DES+MD5
           smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers = AES256-SHA, DES-CBC3-MD5
           smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers = kEDH+aRSA

       The  first  setting disables anonymous ciphers. The next setting disables ciphers that use the MD5 digest
       algorithm or the (single) DES encryption algorithm. The next setting disables ciphers that  use  MD5  and
       DES  together.   The  next  setting  disables  the  two ciphers "AES256-SHA" and "DES-CBC3-MD5". The last
       setting disables ciphers that use "EDH" key exchange with RSA authentication.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_tls_fingerprint_digest (default: see postconf -d output)

       The message digest algorithm to construct remote  SMTP  client-certificate  fingerprints  or  public  key
       fingerprints (Postfix 2.9 and later) for check_ccert_access and permit_tls_clientcerts.

       The  default  algorithm  is  sha256 with Postfix >= 3.6 and the compatibility_level set to 3.6 or higher.
       With Postfix <= 3.5, the default algorithm is md5.

       The best-practice algorithm is now sha256. Recent advances in hash function cryptanalysis have led to md5
       and sha1 being deprecated in favor of sha256.  However, as long as there are no known "second  pre-image"
       attacks  against the older algorithms, their use in this context, though not recommended, is still likely
       safe.

       While additional digest algorithms are often available with  OpenSSL's  libcrypto,  only  those  used  by
       libssl  in  SSL cipher suites are available to Postfix.  You'll likely find support for md5, sha1, sha256
       and sha512.

       To find the fingerprint of a specific certificate file, with a specific digest algorithm, run:

           $ openssl x509 -noout -fingerprint -digest -in certfile.pem

       The text to the right of "=" sign is the desired fingerprint.  For example:

           $ openssl x509 -noout -fingerprint -sha256 -in cert.pem
           SHA256 Fingerprint=D4:6A:AB:19:24:...:A6:CB:66:82:C0:8E:9B:EE:29:A8:1A

       To extract the public key fingerprint from an X.509 certificate, you need to extract the public key  from
       the  certificate  and  compute  the  appropriate  digest  of  its  DER (ASN.1) encoding. With OpenSSL the
       "-pubkey" option of the "x509" command extracts the public key always in "PEM" format. We pipe the result
       to another OpenSSL command that converts the key to DER and then to the "dgst"  command  to  compute  the
       fingerprint.

       Example:

           $ openssl x509 -in cert.pem -noout -pubkey |
               openssl pkey -pubin -outform DER |
               openssl dgst -sha256 -c
           (stdin)= 64:3f:1f:f6:e5:1e:d4:2a:56:8b:fc:09:1a:61:98:b5:bc:7c:60:58

       The Postfix SMTP server and client log the peer (leaf) certificate fingerprint and public key fingerprint
       when the TLS loglevel is 2 or higher.

       Example: client-certificate access table, with sha256 fingerprints:

           /etc/postfix/main.cf:
               smtpd_tls_fingerprint_digest = sha256
               smtpd_client_restrictions =
                   check_ccert_access hash:/etc/postfix/access,
                   reject
           /etc/postfix/access:
               # Action folded to next line...
               AF:88:7C:AD:51:95:6F:36:96:...:01:FB:2E:48:CD:AB:49:25:A2:3B
                   OK
               85:16:78:FD:73:6E:CE:70:E0:...:5F:0D:3C:C8:6D:C4:2C:24:59:E1
                   permit_auth_destination

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

smtpd_tls_key_file (default: $smtpd_tls_cert_file)

       File  with  the  Postfix  SMTP  server RSA private key in PEM format.  This file may be combined with the
       Postfix SMTP server RSA certificate file specified with $smtpd_tls_cert_file.  With Postfix  >=  3.4  the
       preferred way to configure server keys and certificates is via the "smtpd_tls_chain_files" parameter.

       The private key must be accessible without a pass-phrase, i.e. it must not be encrypted. File permissions
       should grant read-only access to the system superuser account ("root"), and no access to anyone else.

smtpd_tls_loglevel (default: 0)

       Enable  additional  Postfix  SMTP  server  logging of TLS activity.  Each logging level also includes the
       information that is logged at a lower logging level.

              0 Disable logging of TLS activity.

              1 Log only a summary message on TLS handshake  completion  -  no  logging  of  client  certificate
              trust-chain  verification errors if client certificate verification is not required.  With Postfix
              2.8 and earlier, log the summary message, peer certificate summary information and unconditionally
              log trust-chain verification errors.

              2 Also log levels during TLS negotiation.

              3 Also log hexadecimal and ASCII dump of TLS negotiation process.

              4 Also log hexadecimal and ASCII dump of complete transmission after STARTTLS.

       Do not use "smtpd_tls_loglevel = 2" or higher except in case of problems. Use of loglevel 4  is  strongly
       discouraged.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers (default: medium)

       The  minimum  TLS  cipher  grade that the Postfix SMTP server will use with mandatory TLS encryption. The
       default grade ("medium") is sufficiently strong that any benefit from globally restricting  TLS  sessions
       to a more stringent grade is likely negligible, especially given the fact that many implementations still
       do  not  offer  any  stronger  ("high"  grade) ciphers, while those that do, will always use "high" grade
       ciphers. So insisting on "high" grade ciphers is generally counter-productive. Allowing "export" or "low"
       ciphers is typically not a good idea, as systems limited to just these are limited to obsolete  browsers.
       No known SMTP clients fail to support at least one "medium" or "high" grade cipher.

       The following cipher grades are supported:

       high   Enable  only  "HIGH"  grade  OpenSSL  ciphers.  The  underlying  cipherlist  is  specified via the
              tls_high_cipherlist configuration parameter, which you are strongly encouraged to not change.

       medium Enable "MEDIUM" grade  or  stronger  OpenSSL  ciphers.  These  use  128-bit  or  longer  symmetric
              bulk-encryption  keys.  This  is  the  default  minimum strength for mandatory TLS encryption. The
              underlying cipherlist is specified via the tls_medium_cipherlist  configuration  parameter,  which
              you are strongly encouraged not to change.

       null   Enable  only  the  "NULL"  OpenSSL ciphers, these provide authentication without encryption.  This
              setting is only appropriate in the rare case that all clients are prepared  to  use  NULL  ciphers
              (not   normally  enabled  in  TLS  clients).  The  underlying  cipherlist  is  specified  via  the
              tls_null_cipherlist configuration parameter, which you are strongly encouraged not to change.

       low    Enable "LOW" grade or stronger OpenSSL ciphers.  In Postfix >= 3.8 this  cipher  grade  is  always
              identical  to  "medium".   Recent  versions of OpenSSL do not support any "LOW" grade ciphers.  In
              earlier Postfix releases the  underlying  cipherlist  was  specified  via  the  tls_low_cipherlist
              configuration  parameter,  which  you are strongly encouraged not to change.  This obsolete cipher
              grade SHOULD NOT be used.

       export Enable "EXPORT" grade or stronger OpenSSL ciphers.  In Postfix >= 3.8 this cipher grade is  always
              identical  to "medium".  Recent versions of OpenSSL do not support any "EXPORT" grade ciphers.  In
              earlier Postfix releases the underlying cipherlist was  specified  via  the  tls_export_cipherlist
              configuration  parameter,  which  you are strongly encouraged not to change.  This obsolete cipher
              grade SHOULD NOT be used.

       Cipher types listed in smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers or smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers are excluded from
       the base definition of the selected cipher grade. See smtpd_tls_ciphers for cipher controls that apply to
       opportunistic TLS.

       The underlying cipherlists for grades  other  than  "null"  include  anonymous  ciphers,  but  these  are
       automatically  filtered  out if the server is configured to ask for remote SMTP client certificates.  You
       are very unlikely to need to take any steps to exclude anonymous ciphers, they are excluded automatically
       as required.  If you must exclude anonymous  ciphers  even  when  Postfix  does  not  need  or  use  peer
       certificates,  set  "smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers  =  aNULL".  To exclude anonymous ciphers only when TLS is
       enforced, set "smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers = aNULL".

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers (default: empty)

       Additional list of ciphers or cipher types to exclude  from  the  Postfix  SMTP  server  cipher  list  at
       mandatory   TLS   security   levels.   This  list  works  in  addition  to  the  exclusions  listed  with
       smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers (see there for syntax details).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_tls_mandatory_protocols (default: see postconf -d output)

       TLS protocols accepted by the Postfix SMTP server with mandatory TLS encryption.  If the list  is  empty,
       the  server  supports all available TLS protocol versions.  A non-empty value is a list of protocol names
       to include or exclude, separated by whitespace, commas or colons.

       The valid protocol names (see SSL_get_version(3)) are "SSLv2", "SSLv3", "TLSv1", "TLSv1.1", "TLSv1.2" and
       "TLSv1.3".  Starting with Postfix 3.6, the default value is ">=TLSv1", which sets TLS 1.0 as  the  lowest
       supported  TLS protocol version (see below).  Older releases use the "!" exclusion syntax, also described
       below.

       As of Postfix 3.6, the preferred way to limit the range of acceptable protocols  is  to  set  the  lowest
       acceptable  TLS  protocol  version  and/or the highest acceptable TLS protocol version.  To set the lower
       bound include an element of the form: ">=version" where version is a either one of the TLS protocol names
       listed above, or a hexadecimal number corresponding to the desired TLS protocol  version  (0301  for  TLS
       1.0, 0302 for TLS 1.1, etc.).  For the upper bound, use "<=version".  There must be no whitespace between
       the ">=" or "<=" symbols and the protocol name or number.

       Hexadecimal  protocol numbers make it possible to specify protocol bounds for TLS versions that are known
       to OpenSSL, but might not be known to Postfix.  They cannot be used with  the  legacy  exclusion  syntax.
       Leading  "0"  or  "0x"  prefixes  are supported, but not required.  Therefore, "301", "0301", "0x301" and
       "0x0301" are all equivalent to "TLSv1".  Hexadecimal versions unknown to OpenSSL will  fail  to  set  the
       upper  or  lower  bound,  and  a  warning  will be logged.  Hexadecimal versions should only be used when
       Postfix is linked with some future version of OpenSSL that supports TLS 1.4 or later,  but  Postfix  does
       not yet support a symbolic name for that protocol version.

       Hexadecimal example (Postfix >= 3.6):

           # Allow only TLS 1.2 through (hypothetical) TLS 1.4, once supported
           # in some future version of OpenSSL (presently a warning is logged).
           smtpd_tls_mandatory_protocols = >=TLSv1.2, <=0305
           # Allow only TLS 1.2 and up:
           smtpd_tls_mandatory_protocols = >=0x0303

       With  Postfix  <  3.6  there  is  no  support for a minimum or maximum version, and the protocol range is
       configured via protocol exclusions.  To require at least TLS 1.0,  set  "smtpd_tls_mandatory_protocols  =
       !SSLv2,  !SSLv3".   Listing the protocols to include, rather than protocols to exclude, is supported, but
       not recommended.  The exclusion form more accurately matches the underlying OpenSSL interface.

       Support for "TLSv1.3" was introduced in  OpenSSL  1.1.1.   Disabling  this  protocol  via  "!TLSv1.3"  is
       supported since Postfix 3.4 (or patch releases >= 3.0.14, 3.1.10, 3.2.7 and 3.3.2).

       Example:

       # Preferred syntax with Postfix >= 3.6:
       smtpd_tls_mandatory_protocols = >=TLSv1.2, <=TLSv1.3
       # Legacy syntax:
       smtpd_tls_mandatory_protocols = !SSLv2, !SSLv3, !TLSv1, !TLSv1.1

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_tls_protocols (default: see postconf -d output)

       TLS  protocols  accepted  by  the  Postfix  SMTP server with opportunistic TLS encryption. If the list is
       empty, the server supports all available TLS protocol versions.  A non-empty value is a list of  protocol
       names to include or exclude, separated by whitespace, commas or colons.

       The valid protocol names (see SSL_get_version(3)) are "SSLv2", "SSLv3", "TLSv1", "TLSv1.1", "TLSv1.2" and
       "TLSv1.3".   Starting  with Postfix 3.6, the default value is ">=TLSv1", which sets TLS 1.0 as the lowest
       supported TLS protocol version (see below).  Older releases use the "!" exclusion syntax, also  described
       below.

       As  of  Postfix  3.6,  the  preferred way to limit the range of acceptable protocols is to set the lowest
       acceptable TLS protocol version and/or the highest acceptable TLS protocol version.   To  set  the  lower
       bound include an element of the form: ">=version" where version is a either one of the TLS protocol names
       listed  above,  or  a  hexadecimal number corresponding to the desired TLS protocol version (0301 for TLS
       1.0, 0302 for TLS 1.1, etc.).  For the upper bound, use "<=version".  There must be no whitespace between
       the ">=" or "<=" symbols and the protocol name or number.

       Hexadecimal protocol numbers make it possible to specify protocol bounds for TLS versions that are  known
       to  OpenSSL,  but  might  not be known to Postfix.  They cannot be used with the legacy exclusion syntax.
       Leading "0" or "0x" prefixes are supported, but not required.   Therefore,  "301",  "0301",  "0x301"  and
       "0x0301"  are  all  equivalent  to "TLSv1".  Hexadecimal versions unknown to OpenSSL will fail to set the
       upper or lower bound, and a warning will be logged.   Hexadecimal  versions  should  only  be  used  when
       Postfix  is  linked  with some future version of OpenSSL that supports TLS 1.4 or later, but Postfix does
       not yet support a symbolic name for that protocol version.

       Hexadecimal example (Postfix >= 3.6):

           # Allow only TLS 1.0 through (hypothetical) TLS 1.4, once supported
           # in some future version of OpenSSL (presently a warning is logged).
           smtpd_tls_protocols = >=TLSv1, <=0305
           # Allow only TLS 1.0 and up:
           smtpd_tls_protocols = >=0x0301

       With Postfix < 3.6 there is no support for a minimum or  maximum  version,  and  the  protocol  range  is
       configured  via  protocol  exclusions.   To  require at least TLS 1.0, set "smtpd_tls_protocols = !SSLv2,
       !SSLv3".  Listing the protocols to include, rather than protocols  to  exclude,  is  supported,  but  not
       recommended.  The exclusion form more accurately matches the underlying OpenSSL interface.

       Support  for  "TLSv1.3"  was  introduced  in  OpenSSL  1.1.1.   Disabling this protocol via "!TLSv1.3" is
       supported since Postfix 3.4 (or patch releases >= 3.0.14, 3.1.10, 3.2.7 and 3.3.2).

       Example:
       # Preferred syntax with Postfix >= 3.6:
       smtpd_tls_protocols = >=TLSv1, <=TLSv1.3
       # Legacy syntax:
       smtpd_tls_protocols = !SSLv2, !SSLv3

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

smtpd_tls_received_header (default: no)

       Request that the Postfix SMTP server produces Received:  message headers that include  information  about
       the  protocol and cipher used, as well as the remote SMTP client CommonName and client certificate issuer
       CommonName.  This is disabled by default, as the information may be modified  in  transit  through  other
       mail servers.  Only information that was recorded by the final destination can be trusted.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_req_ccert (default: no)

       With  mandatory  TLS  encryption,  require a trusted remote SMTP client certificate in order to allow TLS
       connections to proceed.  This option implies "smtpd_tls_ask_ccert = yes".

       When TLS encryption is optional, this setting is ignored with a warning written to the mail log.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_security_level (default: empty)

       The SMTP TLS security level for the Postfix SMTP server;  when  a  non-empty  value  is  specified,  this
       overrides  the  obsolete  parameters  smtpd_use_tls and smtpd_enforce_tls. This parameter is ignored with
       "smtpd_tls_wrappermode = yes".

       Specify one of the following security levels:

       none   TLS will not be used.

       may    Opportunistic TLS: announce STARTTLS support to remote SMTP  clients,  but  do  not  require  that
              clients use TLS encryption.

       encrypt
              Mandatory  TLS  encryption:  announce  STARTTLS  support  to remote SMTP clients, and require that
              clients use TLS encryption. According to  RFC  2487  this  MUST  NOT  be  applied  in  case  of  a
              publicly-referenced SMTP server. Instead, this option should be used only on dedicated servers.

       Note  1: the "fingerprint", "verify" and "secure" levels are not supported here.  The Postfix SMTP server
       logs a warning and uses "encrypt" instead.  To verify remote SMTP client certificates, see TLS_README for
       a discussion of the smtpd_tls_ask_ccert, smtpd_tls_req_ccert, and permit_tls_clientcerts features.

       Note 2: The parameter setting "smtpd_tls_security_level = encrypt" implies "smtpd_tls_auth_only = yes".

       Note 3: when invoked via "sendmail -bs", Postfix will never offer STARTTLS due to insufficient privileges
       to access the server private key. This is intended behavior.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_tls_session_cache_database (default: empty)

       Name of the file containing the optional Postfix SMTP server TLS session cache. Specify a  database  type
       that  supports  enumeration,  such  as btree or sdbm; there is no need to support concurrent access.  The
       file is created if it does not exist. The smtpd(8) daemon does not use this  parameter  directly,  rather
       the cache is implemented indirectly in the tlsmgr(8) daemon. This means that per-smtpd-instance master.cf
       overrides  of  this  parameter  are  not  effective.  Note  that each of the cache databases supported by
       tlsmgr(8) daemon: $smtpd_tls_session_cache_database, $smtp_tls_session_cache_database (and  with  Postfix
       2.3  and  later  $lmtp_tls_session_cache_database), needs to be stored separately. It is not at this time
       possible to store multiple caches in a single database.

       Note: dbm databases are not suitable. TLS session objects are too large.

       As of version 2.5, Postfix no longer uses root privileges when opening this file. The file should now  be
       stored  under  the  Postfix-owned data_directory. As a migration aid, an attempt to open the file under a
       non-Postfix directory is redirected to the Postfix-owned data_directory, and a warning is logged.

       As of Postfix 2.11 the preferred mechanism for session resumption is RFC 5077 TLS session tickets,  which
       don't  require server-side storage.  Consequently, for Postfix >= 2.11 this parameter should generally be
       left empty.  TLS session tickets require an OpenSSL library (at least version 0.9.8h) that provides  full
       support for this TLS extension.  See also smtpd_tls_session_cache_timeout.

       Example:

       smtpd_tls_session_cache_database = btree:/var/lib/postfix/smtpd_scache

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_session_cache_timeout (default: 3600s)

       The  expiration  time  of Postfix SMTP server TLS session cache information. A cache cleanup is performed
       periodically every $smtpd_tls_session_cache_timeout seconds. As  with  $smtpd_tls_session_cache_database,
       this  parameter  is  implemented  in  the  tlsmgr(8)  daemon  and  therefore per-smtpd-instance master.cf
       overrides are not possible.

       As of Postfix 2.11 this setting cannot exceed 100 days.  If set <= 0, session caching  is  disabled,  not
       just  via  the  database,  but  also  via  RFC  5077 TLS session tickets, which don't require server-side
       storage.  If set to a positive value less than 2 minutes, the minimum value of 2 minutes is used instead.
       TLS session tickets require an OpenSSL library (at least version 0.9.8h) that provides full  support  for
       this TLS extension.

       Specify  a  non-negative  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies
       the time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default  time
       unit is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later, and updated for TLS session ticket support in Postfix
       2.11.

smtpd_tls_wrappermode (default: no)

       Run the Postfix SMTP server in TLS "wrapper" mode, instead of using the STARTTLS command.

       If   you   want  to  support  this  service,  enable  a  special  port  in  master.cf,  and  specify  "-o
       smtpd_tls_wrappermode=yes" on the SMTP server's command line. Port 465  (submissions/smtps)  is  reserved
       for this purpose.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_upstream_proxy_protocol (default: empty)

       The  name of the proxy protocol used by an optional before-smtpd proxy agent. When a proxy agent is used,
       this   protocol   conveys    local    and    remote    address    and    port    information.     Specify
       "smtpd_upstream_proxy_protocol  =  haproxy"  to  enable the haproxy protocol; version 2 is supported with
       Postfix 3.5 and later.

       NOTE:   To   use   the   nginx   proxy   with   smtpd(8),    enable    the    XCLIENT    protocol    with
       smtpd_authorized_xclient_hosts.  This  supports  SASL  authentication in the proxy agent (Postfix 2.9 and
       later).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.10 and later.

smtpd_upstream_proxy_timeout (default: 5s)

       The time limit for the proxy protocol specified with the smtpd_upstream_proxy_protocol parameter.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.10 and later.

smtpd_use_tls (default: no)

       Opportunistic  TLS: announce STARTTLS support to remote SMTP clients, but do not require that clients use
       TLS encryption.

       Note: when invoked via "sendmail -bs", Postfix will never offer STARTTLS due to  insufficient  privileges
       to access the server private key. This is intended behavior.

       This   feature   is   available   in   Postfix   2.2   and   later.   With  Postfix  2.3  and  later  use
       smtpd_tls_security_level instead.

smtputf8_autodetect_classes (default: sendmail, verify)

       Detect that a message requires SMTPUTF8 support for  the  specified  mail  origin  classes.   This  is  a
       workaround  to  avoid  chicken-and-egg problems during the initial SMTPUTF8 roll-out in environments with
       pre-existing mail flows that contain UTF8. Those mail flows should not  break  because  Postfix  suddenly
       refuses to deliver such mail to down-stream MTAs that don't announce SMTPUTF8 support.

       The  problem  is  that  Postfix  cannot  rely  solely on the sender's declaration that a message requires
       SMTPUTF8 support, because UTF8 may be  introduced  during  local  processing  (for  example,  the  client
       hostname in Postfix's Received: header, adding @$myorigin or .$mydomain to an incomplete address, address
       rewriting, alias expansion, automatic BCC recipients, local forwarding, and changes made by header checks
       or Milter applications).

       For  now,  the  default  is  to  enable  "SMTPUTF8  required"  autodetection  only  for  Postfix sendmail
       command-line submissions and address verification probes.  This may change once SMTPUTF8 support achieves
       world domination.  However, sites  that  add  UTF8  content  via  local  processing  (see  above)  should
       autodetect the need for SMTPUTF8 support for all email.

       Specify one or more of the following:

        sendmail
              Submission with the Postfix sendmail(1) command.

        smtpd Mail received with the smtpd(8) daemon.

        qmqpd Mail received with the qmqpd(8) daemon.

        forward
              Local  forwarding  or  aliasing.   When  a  message is received with "SMTPUTF8 required", then the
              forwarded (aliased) message always has "SMTPUTF8 required".

        bounce
              Submission by the bounce(8) daemon.  When a message is received with "SMTPUTF8 required", then the
              delivery status notification always has "SMTPUTF8 required".

        notify
              Postmaster notification from the smtp(8) or smtpd(8) daemon.

        verify
              Address verification probe from the verify(8) daemon.

        all   Enable SMTPUTF8 autodetection for all mail.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

smtputf8_enable (default: yes)

       Enable preliminary SMTPUTF8 support for the protocols described in RFC 6531, RFC 6532, and RFC 6533. This
       requires that Postfix is built to support these protocols.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

soft_bounce (default: no)

       Safety net to keep mail queued that would otherwise be returned to the sender.  This  parameter  disables
       locally-generated  bounces,  changes  the  handling  of  negative  responses from remote servers, content
       filters or plugins, and prevents the Postfix SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently by changing  5xx
       reply  codes  into  4xx.   However, soft_bounce is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing
       mistakes.

       Note: "soft_bounce = yes" is in some cases implemented by  modifying  server  responses.  Therefore,  the
       response that Postfix logs may differ from the response that Postfix actually sends or receives.

       Example:

       soft_bounce = yes

stale_lock_time (default: 500s)

       The time after which a stale exclusive mailbox lockfile is removed.  This is used for delivery to file or
       mailbox.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

stress (default: empty)

       This feature is documented in the STRESS_README document.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

strict_7bit_headers (default: no)

       Reject mail with 8-bit text in message headers. This blocks mail from poorly written applications.

       This feature should not be enabled on a general purpose mail server,  because  it  is  likely  to  reject
       legitimate email.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

strict_8bitmime (default: no)

       Enable both strict_7bit_headers and strict_8bitmime_body.

       This  feature  should  not  be  enabled  on a general purpose mail server, because it is likely to reject
       legitimate email.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

strict_8bitmime_body (default: no)

       Reject 8-bit message body text without 8-bit MIME content encoding information.  This  blocks  mail  from
       poorly written applications.

       Unfortunately,  this  also  rejects  majordomo approval requests when the included request contains valid
       8-bit MIME mail, and it rejects bounces from mailers that do not  MIME  encapsulate  8-bit  content  (for
       example, bounces from qmail or from old versions of Postfix).

       This  feature  should  not  be  enabled  on a general purpose mail server, because it is likely to reject
       legitimate email.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

strict_mailbox_ownership (default: yes)

       Defer delivery when a mailbox file is not owned by its recipient.  The default setting is  not  backwards
       compatible.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5.3 and later.

strict_mime_encoding_domain (default: no)

       Reject  mail  with  invalid  Content-Transfer-Encoding: information for the message/* or multipart/* MIME
       content types.  This blocks mail from poorly written software.

       This feature should not be enabled on a general purpose mail server, because it will reject mail after  a
       single violation.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

strict_rfc821_envelopes (default: no)

       Require  that  addresses  received  in SMTP MAIL FROM and RCPT TO commands are enclosed with <>, and that
       those addresses do not contain RFC 822 style comments or phrases.  This stops mail  from  poorly  written
       software.

       By default, the Postfix SMTP server accepts RFC 822 syntax in MAIL FROM and RCPT TO addresses.

strict_smtputf8 (default: no)

       Enable  stricter  enforcement  of  the  SMTPUTF8 protocol. The Postfix SMTP server accepts UTF8 sender or
       recipient addresses only when the client requests an SMTPUTF8 mail transaction.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

sun_mailtool_compatibility (default: no)

       Obsolete SUN mailtool compatibility feature. Instead, use "mailbox_delivery_lock = dotlock".

swap_bangpath (default: yes)

       Enable the rewriting of "site!user" into "user@site".  This is necessary if your machine is connected  to
       UUCP networks.  It is enabled by default.

       Note:  with  Postfix version 2.2, message header address rewriting happens only when one of the following
       conditions is true:

       •      The message is received with the Postfix sendmail(1) command,

       •      The message is received from a network client that matches $local_header_rewrite_clients,

       •      The message is received from the network, and the remote_header_rewrite_domain parameter specifies
              a non-empty value.

       To get the behavior before Postfix version 2.2, specify "local_header_rewrite_clients = static:all".

       Example:

       swap_bangpath = no

syslog_facility (default: mail)

       The syslog facility of Postfix logging. Specify a facility as  defined  in  syslog.conf(5).  The  default
       facility is "mail".

       Warning:  a  non-default  syslog_facility setting takes effect only after a Postfix process has completed
       initialization.  Errors during process initialization will be logged with the default facility.  Examples
       are errors while parsing the command line arguments, and  errors  while  accessing  the  Postfix  main.cf
       configuration file.

syslog_name (default: see postconf -d output)

       A  prefix  that is prepended to the process name in syslog records, so that, for example, "smtpd" becomes
       "prefix/smtpd".

       Warning: a non-default syslog_name setting takes effect  only  after  a  Postfix  process  has  completed
       initialization.  Errors  during process initialization will be logged with the default name. Examples are
       errors while parsing the  command  line  arguments,  and  errors  while  accessing  the  Postfix  main.cf
       configuration file.

tcp_windowsize (default: 0)

       An  optional  workaround  for  routers that break TCP window scaling.  Specify a value > 0 and < 65536 to
       enable this feature.  With Postfix TCP servers (smtpd(8), qmqpd(8)), this feature is implemented  by  the
       Postfix master(8) daemon.

       To change this parameter without stopping Postfix, you need to first terminate all Postfix TCP servers:

           # postconf -e master_service_disable=inet
           # postfix reload

       This  immediately terminates all processes that accept network connections.  Next, you enable Postfix TCP
       servers with the updated tcp_windowsize setting:

           # postconf -e tcp_windowsize=65535 master_service_disable=
           # postfix reload

       If you skip these steps with a running Postfix system, then the tcp_windowsize change will work only  for
       Postfix TCP clients (smtp(8), lmtp(8)).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

tls_append_default_CA (default: no)

       Append  the  system-supplied  default  Certification  Authority  certificates  to the ones specified with
       *_tls_CApath or *_tls_CAfile.  The default is "no";  this  prevents  Postfix  from  trusting  third-party
       certificates and giving them relay permission with permit_tls_all_clientcerts.

       This  feature  is  available  in  Postfix  2.4.15,  2.5.11,  2.6.8,  2.7.2  and  later  versions. Specify
       "tls_append_default_CA = yes" for backwards compatibility, to  avoid  breaking  certificate  verification
       with sites that don't use permit_tls_all_clientcerts.

tls_config_file (default: default)

       Optional  configuration file with baseline OpenSSL settings.  OpenSSL loads any SSL settings found in the
       configuration file for  the  selected  application  name  (see  tls_config_name)  or  else  the  built-in
       application  name "openssl_conf" when no application name is specified, or no corresponding configuration
       section is present.

       With OpenSSL releases  1.1.1  and  1.1.1a,  applications  (including  Postfix)  can  neither  specify  an
       alternative configuration file, nor avoid loading the default configuration file.

       With OpenSSL 1.1.1b or later, this parameter may be set to one of:

       default (default)
              Load the system-wide "openssl.cnf" configuration file.

       none (recommended, OpenSSL 1.1.1b or later only)
              This setting disables loading of  the system-wide "openssl.cnf" file.

       /absolute-path (OpenSSL 1.1.1b or later only)
              Load the configuration file specified by /absolute-path.  With this setting it is an error for the
              file  to  not  contain any settings for the selected tls_config_name.  There is no fallback to the
              default "openssl_conf" name.

       Failures in processing of the built-in default configuration file, are silently ignored.  Any  errors  in
       loading a non-default configuration file are detected by Postfix, and cause TLS support to be disabled.

       The OpenSSL configuration file format is not documented here, beyond giving two examples.

       Example: Default settings for all applications.

           # The name 'openssl_conf' is the default application name
           # The section name to the right of the '=' sign is arbitrary,
           # any name will do, so long as it refers to the desired section.
           #
           # The name 'system_default' selects the settings applied internally
           # by the SSL library as part of SSL object creation.  Applications
           # can then apply any additional settings of their choice.
           #
           # In this example, TLS versions prior to 1.2 are disabled by default.
           #
           openssl_conf = system_wide_settings
           [system_wide_settings]
           ssl_conf = ssl_library_settings
           [ssl_library_settings]
           system_default = initial_ssl_settings
           [initial_ssl_settings]
           MinProtocol = TLSv1.2

       Example: Custom settings for an application named "postfix".

           # The mapping from an application name to the corresponding configuration
           # section must appear near the top of the file, (in what is sometimes called
           # the "default section") prior to the start of any explicitly named
           # "[sections]".  The named sections can appear in any order and don't nest.
           #
           postfix = postfix_settings
           [postfix_settings]
           ssl_conf = postfix_ssl_settings
           [postfix_ssl_settings]
           system_default = baseline_postfix_settings
           [baseline_postfix_settings]
           MinProtocol = TLSv1

       This feature is available in Postfix >= 3.9, 3.8.1, 3.7.6, 3.6.10, and 3.5.20.

tls_config_name (default: empty)

       The application name passed by Postfix to OpenSSL library initialization functions.  This name is used to
       select  the  desired  configuration  "section"  in  the  OpenSSL  configuration  file  specified  via the
       tls_config_file parameter.  When empty, or when the selected name is not  present  in  the  configuration
       file, the default application name ("openssl_conf") is used as a fallback.

       This feature is available in Postfix >= 3.9, 3.8.1, 3.7.6, 3.6.10, and 3.5.20.

tls_daemon_random_bytes (default: 32)

       The  number of pseudo-random bytes that an smtp(8) or smtpd(8) process requests from the tlsmgr(8) server
       in order to seed its internal pseudo random number generator (PRNG).  The default of 32 bytes (equivalent
       to 256 bits) is sufficient to generate a 128bit (or 168bit) session key.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

tls_dane_digest_agility (default: on)

       Configure RFC7671 DANE TLSA digest algorithm agility.  Do not change this setting from its default value.

       See Section 8 of RFC7671 for correct key rotation procedures.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.11 through 3.1.  Postfix 3.2 and later ignore  this  configuration
       parameter and behave as though it were set to "on".

tls_dane_digests (default: sha512 sha256)

       DANE  TLSA (RFC 6698, RFC 7671, RFC 7672) resource-record "matching type" digest algorithms in descending
       preference order.  All the specified algorithms must be supported  by  the  underlying  OpenSSL  library,
       otherwise the Postfix SMTP client will not support DANE TLSA security.

       Specify  a  list of digest names separated by commas and/or whitespace.  Each digest name may be followed
       by an optional "=<number>" suffix.  For example, "sha512" may instead  be  specified  as  "sha512=2"  and
       "sha256"   may   instead   be   specified   as  "sha256=1".   The  optional  number  must  match  the  <a
       href="https://www.iana.org/assignments/dane-parameters/dane-parameters.xhtml#matching-types"        >IANA
       assigned TLSA matching type number the algorithm in question.  Postfix will check this constraint for the
       algorithms  it  knows  about.  Additional matching type algorithms registered with IANA can be added with
       explicit numbers provided they are supported by OpenSSL.

       Invalid list elements are logged with a warning and disable DANE support.  TLSA RRs that specify  digests
       not included in the list are ignored with a warning.

       Note:  It  is unwise to omit sha256 from the digest list.  This digest algorithm is the only mandatory to
       implement digest algorithm in RFC 6698, and many servers are expected to publish TLSA records  with  just
       sha256  digests.   Unless one of the standard digests is seriously compromised and servers have had ample
       time to update their TLSA records you should not omit any standard digests, just arrange  them  in  order
       from strongest to weakest.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.11 and later.

tls_dane_trust_anchor_digest_enable (default: yes)

       Enable  support  for  RFC  6698  (DANE  TLSA)  DNS  records  that  contain  digests of trust-anchors with
       certificate usage "2".  Do not change this setting from its default value.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.11 through  3.1.   It  has  been  withdrawn  in  Postfix  3.2,  as
       trust-anchor  TLSA  records  are  now widely used and have proved sufficiently reliable.  Postfix 3.2 and
       later ignore this configuration parameter and behaves as though it were set to "yes".

tls_disable_workarounds (default: see postconf -d output)

       List or bit-mask of OpenSSL bug work-arounds to disable.

       The OpenSSL toolkit includes a set of work-arounds for buggy SSL/TLS implementations. Applications,  such
       as  Postfix,  that  want  to  maximize interoperability ask the OpenSSL library to enable the full set of
       recommended work-arounds.

       From time to time, it is discovered that a work-around creates a security issue, and should no longer  be
       used. If upgrading OpenSSL to a fixed version is not an option or an upgrade is not available in a timely
       manner,  or  in  closed  environments  where  no buggy clients or servers exist, it may be appropriate to
       disable some or all of the OpenSSL interoperability work-arounds.  This  parameter  specifies  which  bug
       work-arounds to disable.

       If  the  value  of  the  parameter is a hexadecimal long integer starting with "0x", the bug work-arounds
       corresponding to the bits specified in its value are removed from  the  SSL_OP_ALL  work-around  bit-mask
       (see openssl/ssl.h and SSL_CTX_set_options(3)). You can specify more bits than are present in SSL_OP_ALL,
       excess  bits  are  ignored.  Specifying  0xFFFFFFFF disables all bug-workarounds on a 32-bit system. This
       should also be sufficient on 64-bit systems, until OpenSSL abandons support for 32-bit systems and starts
       using the high 32 bits of a 64-bit bug-workaround mask.

       Otherwise, the parameter is a white-space or comma separated list  of  specific  named  bug  work-arounds
       chosen  from the list below. It is possible that your OpenSSL version includes new bug work-arounds added
       after your Postfix source code was last updated, in that case you can only disable one of these  via  the
       hexadecimal syntax above.

       CRYPTOPRO_TLSEXT_BUG
              New with GOST support in OpenSSL 1.0.0.

       DONT_INSERT_EMPTY_FRAGMENTS
              See SSL_CTX_set_options(3)

       LEGACY_SERVER_CONNECT
              See SSL_CTX_set_options(3)

       MICROSOFT_BIG_SSLV3_BUFFER
              See SSL_CTX_set_options(3)

       MICROSOFT_SESS_ID_BUG
              See SSL_CTX_set_options(3)

       MSIE_SSLV2_RSA_PADDING
              also  aliased  as  CVE-2005-2969.  Postfix  2.8  disables this work-around by default with OpenSSL
              versions that may predate the fix. Fixed in OpenSSL 0.9.7h and OpenSSL 0.9.8a.

       NETSCAPE_CHALLENGE_BUG
              See SSL_CTX_set_options(3)

       NETSCAPE_REUSE_CIPHER_CHANGE_BUG
              also aliased as CVE-2010-4180. Postfix 2.8 disables  this  work-around  by  default  with  OpenSSL
              versions that may predate the fix. Fixed in OpenSSL 0.9.8q and OpenSSL 1.0.0c.

       SSLEAY_080_CLIENT_DH_BUG
              See SSL_CTX_set_options(3)

       SSLREF2_REUSE_CERT_TYPE_BUG
              See SSL_CTX_set_options(3)

       TLS_BLOCK_PADDING_BUG
              See SSL_CTX_set_options(3)

       TLS_D5_BUG
              See SSL_CTX_set_options(3)

       TLS_ROLLBACK_BUG
              See  SSL_CTX_set_options(3).   This is disabled in OpenSSL 0.9.7 and later. Nobody should still be
              using 0.9.6!

       TLSEXT_PADDING
              Postfix >= 3.4. See SSL_CTX_set_options(3).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tls_eecdh_auto_curves (default: see postconf -d output)

       The prioritized list of elliptic curves supported by the Postfix SMTP client and  server.   These  curves
       are  used  by  the  Postfix SMTP server when "smtpd_tls_eecdh_grade = auto".  The selected curves must be
       implemented by OpenSSL and be standardized for use in  TLS  (RFC  8422).   It  is  unwise  to  list  only
       "bleeding-edge"  curves  supported  by  a small subset of clients.  The default list is suitable for most
       users.

       Postfix skips curve names that are unknown to OpenSSL, or that are known but not yet  implemented.   This
       makes  it possible to "anticipate" support for curves that should be used once they become available.  In
       particular, in some OpenSSL versions, the new RFC 8031 curves "X25519" and "X448" may be known  by  name,
       but ECDH support for either or both may be missing.  These curves may appear in the default value of this
       parameter, even though they'll only be usable with later versions of OpenSSL.

       See  also  the  "tls_ffdhe_auto_groups"  parameter,  which  supports customizing the list of FFDHE groups
       enabled with TLS 1.3.  That setting is introduced with Postfix 3.8, when built  against  OpenSSL  3.0  or
       later.

       This  feature is available in Postfix 3.2 and later, when it is compiled and linked with OpenSSL 1.0.2 or
       later on platforms where EC algorithms have not been disabled by the vendor.

tls_eecdh_strong_curve (default: prime256v1)

       The elliptic curve used by the Postfix SMTP server for sensibly strong ephemeral ECDH key exchange.  This
       curve  is  used  by  the  Postfix SMTP server when "smtpd_tls_eecdh_grade = strong". The phrase "sensibly
       strong" means approximately 128-bit security based on best known attacks.  The  selected  curve  must  be
       implemented  by  OpenSSL  (as  reported  by  ecparam(1) with the "-list_curves" option) and be one of the
       curves listed in Section 5.1.1 of RFC 8422. You should not generally change this  setting.   Remote  SMTP
       client  implementations  must  support  this curve for EECDH key exchange to take place.  It is unwise to
       choose only "bleeding-edge" curves supported by only a small subset of clients.

       The default "strong" curve is rated in NSA Suite B for information classified up to SECRET.

       Note: elliptic curve names are poorly standardized; different standards groups  are  assigning  different
       names  to the same underlying curves.  The curve with the X9.62 name "prime256v1" is also known under the
       SECG name "secp256r1", but OpenSSL does not recognize the latter name.

       If you want to take maximal advantage of ciphers that offer  forward  secrecy  see  the  Getting  started
       section of FORWARD_SECRECY_README.  The full document conveniently presents all information about Postfix
       "perfect"  forward secrecy support in one place: what forward secrecy is, how to tweak settings, and what
       you can expect to see when Postfix uses ciphers with forward secrecy.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later, when it is compiled and linked with OpenSSL 1.0.0  or
       later on platforms where EC algorithms have not been disabled by the vendor.

tls_eecdh_ultra_curve (default: secp384r1)

       The elliptic curve used by the Postfix SMTP server for maximally strong ephemeral ECDH key exchange. This
       curve  is  used  by  the  Postfix SMTP server when "smtpd_tls_eecdh_grade = ultra". The phrase "maximally
       strong" means approximately 192-bit security based on best known attacks.  This additional strength comes
       at a significant computational cost, most users should instead set "smtpd_tls_eecdh_grade = strong".  The
       selected curve must be implemented by OpenSSL (as reported by ecparam(1) with the "-list_curves"  option)
       and  be  one  of  the  curves  listed  in Section 5.1.1 of RFC 8422. You should not generally change this
       setting.  Remote SMTP client implementations must support this curve  for  EECDH  key  exchange  to  take
       place.  It is unwise to choose only "bleeding-edge" curves supported by only a small subset of clients.

       This default "ultra" curve is rated in NSA Suite B for information classified up to TOP SECRET.

       If  you  want  to  take  maximal  advantage of ciphers that offer forward secrecy see the Getting started
       section of FORWARD_SECRECY_README.  The full document conveniently presents all information about Postfix
       "perfect" forward secrecy support in one place: what forward secrecy is, how to tweak settings, and  what
       you can expect to see when Postfix uses ciphers with forward secrecy.

       This  feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later, when it is compiled and linked with OpenSSL 1.0.0 or
       later on platforms where EC algorithms have not been disabled by the vendor.

tls_export_cipherlist (default: see postconf -d output)

       The OpenSSL cipherlist for "export" or higher grade ciphers.  Ignored as  of  Postfix  3.8.   In  earlier
       Postfix   releases   this   defined   the   meaning   of   the  "export"  setting  in  smtpd_tls_ciphers,
       smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers,   smtp_tls_ciphers,   smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers,   lmtp_tls_ciphers,    and
       lmtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers.  You are strongly encouraged not to change this setting.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

tls_fast_shutdown_enable (default: yes)

       A workaround for implementations that hang Postfix while shutting down a TLS session, until Postfix times
       out.  With  this  enabled,  Postfix  will  not  wait  for the remote TLS peer to respond to a TLS 'close'
       notification. This behavior is recommended for TLSv1.0 and later.

tls_ffdhe_auto_groups (default: see postconf -d output)

       The prioritized list of finite-field Diffie-Hellman ephemeral (FFDHE) key exchange  groups  supported  by
       the  Postfix  SMTP  client  and server.  OpenSSL 3.0 adds support for FFDHE key agreement in TLS 1.3.  In
       OpenSSL  1.1.1,  TLS  1.3  was  only  supported   with   elliptic-curve   based   key   agreement.    The
       "tls_ffdhe_auto_groups"  parameter  makes  it  possible  to  configure  the list of FFDHE groups that the
       Postfix client or server will enable in OpenSSL 3.0 and up.  This parameter has no effect when Postfix is
       built against earlier OpenSSL versions.

       The default list of FFDHE groups that Postfix enables in OpenSSL 3.0 and up includes just  the  2048  and
       3072-bit  groups.   Stronger  FFDHE  groups perform poorly and EC groups are a much better choice for the
       same security level.  Postfix ignores group names that are unknown to OpenSSL, or that are known but  not
       yet  implemented.   The  FFDHE  groups  are  largely  a backup, in case some peer does not support EC key
       exchange, or EC key exchange needs to be disabled for some pressing reason.

       Setting this parameter empty disables FFDHE support in TLS 1.3.  Whether FFDHE key agreement  is  enabled
       in TLS 1.2 and earlier depends on whether any of the "kDHE" ciphers are included in the cipherlist.

       Conversely,  setting  "tls_eecdh_auto_curves"  empty disables TLS 1.3 EC key agreement in OpenSSL 3.0 and
       later.  Note that at least one of "tls_eecdh_auto_curves" and "tls_ffdhe_auto_groups" must be  non-empty,
       this  is  required  by  OpenSSL  3.0.  If both are inadvertently set empty, Postfix will fall back to the
       compiled-in defaults.

       All the default groups and EC curves should sufficiently strong to make "pruning"  the  defaults  unwise.
       At  a  minimum,  "X25519"  and "P-256" (a.k.a. "prime256v1") should be among the enabled EC curves, while
       "dhe2048" and "dhe3072" should be among the FFDHE groups.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.8 and later, when it is compiled and linked with  OpenSSL  3.0  or
       later.

tls_high_cipherlist (default: see postconf -d output)

       The  OpenSSL  cipherlist  for  "high"  grade  ciphers.  This defines the meaning of the "high" setting in
       smtpd_tls_ciphers,     smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers,     smtp_tls_ciphers,     smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers,
       lmtp_tls_ciphers, and lmtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers. You are strongly encouraged not to change this setting.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

tls_legacy_public_key_fingerprints (default: no)

       A  temporary  migration  aid  for  sites  that  use  certificate  public-key  fingerprints  with  Postfix
       2.9.0..2.9.5, which use an  incorrect  algorithm.  This  parameter  has  no  effect  on  the  certificate
       fingerprint support that is available since Postfix 2.2.

       Specify  "tls_legacy_public_key_fingerprints  =  yes" temporarily, pending a migration from configuration
       files  with  incorrect  Postfix  2.9.0..2.9.5  certificate  public-key  finger  prints,  to  the  correct
       fingerprints   used  by  Postfix  2.9.6  and  later.   To  compute  the  correct  certificate  public-key
       fingerprints, see TLS_README.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.9.6 and later.

tls_low_cipherlist (default: see postconf -d output)

       The OpenSSL cipherlist for "low" or higher grade ciphers.  Ignored as of Postfix 3.8.  In earlier Postfix
       releases this defined the meaning of the "low" setting in smtpd_tls_ciphers, smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers,
       smtp_tls_ciphers, smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers, lmtp_tls_ciphers, and lmtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers.  You  are
       strongly encouraged not to change this setting.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

tls_medium_cipherlist (default: see postconf -d output)

       The  OpenSSL  cipherlist  for  "medium" or higher grade ciphers. This defines the meaning of the "medium"
       setting in smtpd_tls_ciphers, smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers, smtp_tls_ciphers,  smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers,
       lmtp_tls_ciphers,  and  lmtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers.   This  is  the  default cipherlist for mandatory TLS
       encryption in the TLS client (with anonymous ciphers disabled when verifying server certificates).   This
       is  the default cipherlist for opportunistic TLS with Postfix releases after the middle of 2015.  You are
       strongly encouraged not to change this setting.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

tls_null_cipherlist (default: eNULL:!aNULL)

       The OpenSSL cipherlist for "NULL" grade ciphers that  provide  authentication  without  encryption.  This
       defines  the meaning of the "null" setting in smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers, smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers and
       lmtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers.  You are strongly encouraged not to change this setting.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

tls_preempt_cipherlist (default: no)

       With SSLv3 and later, use the Postfix SMTP  server's  cipher  preference  order  instead  of  the  remote
       client's cipher preference order.

       By  default, the OpenSSL server selects the client's most preferred cipher that the server supports. With
       SSLv3 and later, the server may choose its own most preferred cipher that is supported (offered)  by  the
       client. Setting "tls_preempt_cipherlist = yes" enables server cipher preferences.

       While  server cipher selection may in some cases lead to a more secure or performant cipher choice, there
       is some risk of interoperability issues. In the past, some SSL clients have listed lower priority ciphers
       that they did not implement correctly. If the server chooses a cipher that the client  prefers  less,  it
       may  select  a cipher whose client implementation is flawed. Most notably Windows 2003 Microsoft Exchange
       servers have flawed implementations of DES-CBC3-SHA,  which  OpenSSL  considers  stronger  than  RC4-SHA.
       Enabling  server  cipher-suite  selection  may create interoperability issues with Windows 2003 Microsoft
       Exchange clients.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later, in combination with OpenSSL 0.9.7 and later.

tls_random_bytes (default: 32)

       The number of bytes that tlsmgr(8) reads from $tls_random_source when (re)seeding  the  in-memory  pseudo
       random  number  generator  (PRNG)  pool.  The  default  of  32 bytes (256 bits) is good enough for 128bit
       symmetric keys.  If using EGD or a device file, a maximum of 255 bytes is read.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

tls_random_exchange_name (default: see postconf -d output)

       Name of the pseudo random number generator (PRNG) state file that is maintained by tlsmgr(8). The file is
       created when it does not exist, and its length is fixed at 1024 bytes.

       As of version 2.5, Postfix no longer uses root privileges when opening this file, and  the  default  file
       location  was  changed from ${config_directory}/prng_exch to ${data_directory}/prng_exch.  As a migration
       aid, an attempt to open the file under  a  non-Postfix  directory  is  redirected  to  the  Postfix-owned
       data_directory, and a warning is logged.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

tls_random_prng_update_period (default: 3600s)

       The  time between attempts by tlsmgr(8) to save the state of the pseudo random number generator (PRNG) to
       the file specified with $tls_random_exchange_name.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

tls_random_reseed_period (default: 3600s)

       The  maximal  time  between attempts by tlsmgr(8) to re-seed the in-memory pseudo random number generator
       (PRNG) pool from external sources.  The actual time between re-seeding attempts is calculated  using  the
       PRNG, and is between 0 and the time specified.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

tls_random_source (default: see postconf -d output)

       The external entropy source for the in-memory tlsmgr(8) pseudo random number generator  (PRNG)  pool.  Be
       sure  to  specify  a  non-blocking source.  If this source is not a regular file, the entropy source type
       must be prepended:  egd:/path/to/egd_socket for  a  source  with  EGD  compatible  socket  interface,  or
       dev:/path/to/device for a device file.

       Note: on OpenBSD systems specify dev:/dev/arandom when dev:/dev/urandom gives timeout errors.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

tls_server_sni_maps (default: empty)

       Optional  lookup  tables  that  map  names  received  from  remote  SMTP  clients via the TLS Server Name
       Indication (SNI) extension to the appropriate keys and certificate chains.  This parameter is implemented
       in the Postfix TLS library, and applies to both smtpd(8) and the SMTP server mode of tlsproxy(8).

       When this parameter is non-empty, the Postfix SMTP server enables SNI extension processing, and logs  SNI
       values  that  are invalid or don't match an entry in the specified tables.  When an entry does match, the
       SNI name is logged as part of the connection summary at log levels 1 and higher.

       The lookup key is either the verbatim SNI domain name or an ancestor domain prefixed with a leading  dot.
       For  internationalized  domains, the lookup key must be in IDNA 2008 A-label form (as required in the TLS
       SNI extension).

       The syntax of the lookup value is the same as with the  smtp_tls_chain_files  parameter  (see  there  for
       additional  details),  but  here  scoped to just TLS connections in which the client sends a matching SNI
       domain name.

       Example:

           /etc/postfix/main.cf:
               #
               # The indexed SNI table must be created with "postmap -F"
               #
               indexed = ${default_database_type}:${config_directory}/
               tls_server_sni_maps = ${indexed}sni

           /etc/postfix/sni:
               #
               # The example.com domain has both an RSA and ECDSA certificate
               # chain.  The chain files MUST start with the private key,
               # with the certificate chain next, starting with the leaf
               # (server) certificate, and then the issuer certificates.
               #
               example.com /etc/postfix/sni-chains/rsa2048.example.com.pem,
                           /etc/postfix/sni-chains/ecdsa-p256.example.com.pem
               #
               # The example.net domain has a wildcard certificate, and two
               # additional DNS names.  So its certificate chain is also used
               # with any subdomain, plus the additional names.
               #
               example.net /etc/postfix/sni-chains/example.net.pem
               .example.net /etc/postfix/sni-chains/example.net.pem
               example.info /etc/postfix/sni-chains/example.net.pem
               example.org /etc/postfix/sni-chains/example.net.pem

       Note that the SNI lookup tables should also have entries for the domains that correspond to  the  Postfix
       SMTP server's default certificate(s). This ensures that the remote SMTP client's TLS SNI extension gets a
       positive  response  when  it specifies one of the Postfix SMTP server's default domains, and ensures that
       the Postfix SMTP server will not log an SNI name mismatch for such a domain.  The Postfix  SMTP  server's
       default  certificates  are then only used when the client sends no SNI or when it sends SNI with a domain
       that the server knows no certificate(s) for.

       The mapping from an SNI domain name to a certificate chain is indirect.  In the input  source  files  for
       "cdb",  "hash",  "btree"  or other tables that are converted to on-disk indexed files via postmap(1), the
       value specified for each key is a list of filenames.  When postmap(1) is used with  the  -F  option,  the
       generated  table  stores  for  each lookup key the base64-encoded contents of the associated files.  When
       querying tables via postmap -Fq, the table value is decoded  from  base64,  yielding  the  original  file
       content, plus a new line.

       With  "regexp",  "pcre",  "inline",  "texthash",  "static"  and  similar  tables  that are interpreted at
       run-time, and don't have a separate source format, the table value is again a list files, that are loaded
       into memory when the table is opened.

       With tables whose content is managed outside of Postfix, such as LDAP, MySQL, PostgreSQL,  socketmap  and
       tcp,  the  value  must  be  a  concatenation of the desired PEM keys and certificate chains, that is then
       further encoded to yield a single-line base64 string.  Creation of such tables and  secure  storage  (the
       value includes private key material) are outside the responsibility of Postfix.

       With  "socketmap"  and  "tcp"  the  data  will  be transmitted in the clear, and there is no query access
       control, so these are generally unsuitable for storing  SNI  chains.   With  LDAP  and  SQL,  you  should
       restrict read access and use TLS to protect the sensitive data in transit.

       Typically  there  is  only  one  private  key  and  its  chain  of  certificates starting with the "leaf"
       certificate corresponding to that key,  and  continuing  with  the  appropriate  intermediate  issuer  CA
       certificates,  with  each  certificate  ideally  followed  by  its  issuer.   Servers  that have keys and
       certificates for more than one algorithm (e.g.  both an RSA key and an ECDSA key, or even RSA, ECDSA  and
       Ed25519)  can  use  multiple  chains  concatenated  together,  with  the  key  always  listed  before the
       corresponding certificates.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

tls_session_ticket_cipher (default: Postfix >= 3.0: aes-256-cbc, Postfix < 3.0: aes-128-cbc)

       Algorithm used to encrypt RFC5077 TLS session tickets.  This algorithm must use CBC mode, have a  128-bit
       block size, and must have a key length between 128 and 256 bits.  The default is aes-256-cbc.  Overriding
       the default to choose a different algorithm is discouraged.

       Setting  this parameter empty disables session ticket support in the Postfix SMTP server.  Another way to
       disable session ticket support is via the tls_ssl_options parameter.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

tls_ssl_options (default: empty)

       List or bit-mask of OpenSSL options to enable.

       The OpenSSL toolkit provides a set of options that applications can enable to tune the OpenSSL  behavior.
       Some  of  these  work  around  bugs  in  other  implementations  and  are on by default.  You can use the
       tls_disable_workarounds parameter to selectively disable some or all  of  the  bug  work-arounds,  making
       OpenSSL  more  strict  at  the  cost of non-interoperability with SSL clients or servers that exhibit the
       bugs.

       Other options are off by default, and typically enable or disable features rather than bug  work-arounds.
       These  may  be  turned  on  (with care) via the tls_ssl_options parameter.  The value is a white-space or
       comma separated list of named options chosen from the list below.  The names are not case-sensitive,  you
       can  use lower-case if you prefer.  The upper case values below match the corresponding macro name in the
       ssl.h header file with the SSL_OP_ prefix removed.  It is possible that your OpenSSL version includes new
       options added after your Postfix source code was last updated, in that case you can only  enable  one  of
       these via the hexadecimal syntax below.

       You should only enable features via the hexadecimal mask when the need to control the feature is critical
       (to  deal  with  a  new  vulnerability  or a serious interoperability problem).  Postfix DOES NOT promise
       backwards compatible behavior with respect to the mask bits.  A feature  enabled  via  the  mask  in  one
       release  may  be  enabled  by  other  means  in  a  later release, and the mask bit will then be ignored.
       Therefore, use of the hexadecimal mask is only a temporary measure until a new Postfix or OpenSSL release
       provides a better solution.

       If the value of the parameter is a hexadecimal long integer starting with "0x", the options corresponding
       to the bits specified in its value are enabled (see openssl/ssl.h and SSL_CTX_set_options(3)).   You  can
       only  enable  options  not already controlled by other Postfix settings.  For example, you cannot disable
       protocols or enable server cipher preference.  Do not  attempt  to  enable  all  features  by  specifying
       0xFFFFFFFF, this is unlikely to be a good idea.  Some bug work-arounds are also valid here, allowing them
       to be re-enabled if/when they're no longer enabled by default.  The supported values include:

       ENABLE_MIDDLEBOX_COMPAT
              Postfix >= 3.4. See SSL_CTX_set_options(3).

       LEGACY_SERVER_CONNECT
              See SSL_CTX_set_options(3).

       NO_TICKET
              Enabled  by default when needed in fully-patched Postfix >= 2.7.  Not needed at all for Postfix >=
              2.11, unless for some reason you do not want to support TLS  session  resumption.   Best  not  set
              explicitly.  See SSL_CTX_set_options(3).

       NO_COMPRESSION
              Disable  SSL  compression even if supported by the OpenSSL library.  Compression is CPU-intensive,
              and compression before encryption does not always improve security.

       NO_RENEGOTIATION
              Postfix >= 3.4.  This can reduce  opportunities  for  a  potential  CPU  exhaustion  attack.   See
              SSL_CTX_set_options(3).

       NO_SESSION_RESUMPTION_ON_RENEGOTIATION
              Postfix >= 3.4. See SSL_CTX_set_options(3).

       PRIORITIZE_CHACHA
              Postfix >= 3.4. See SSL_CTX_set_options(3).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.11 and later.

tls_wildcard_matches_multiple_labels (default: yes)

       Match multiple DNS labels with "*" in wildcard certificates.

       Some  mail  service  providers  prepend  the  customer domain name to a base domain for which they have a
       wildcard TLS certificate.  For example, the MX records for example.com hosted by example.net may be:

           example.com. IN MX 0 example.com.mx1.example.net.
           example.com. IN MX 0 example.com.mx2.example.net.

       and the TLS certificate may be for "*.example.net". The "*" then corresponds with multiple labels in  the
       mail  server  domain  name.  While multi-label wildcards are not widely supported, and are not blessed by
       any standard, there is little to be gained by disallowing their use in this context.

       Notes:

       •      In a certificate name, the "*" is special only when it is used as the first label.

       •      While  Postfix  (2.11  or  later)  can  match  "*"  with  multiple  domain  name   labels,   other
              implementations likely will not.

       •      Earlier Postfix implementations behave as if "tls_wildcard_matches_multiple_labels = no".

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.11 and later.

tlsmgr_service_name (default: tlsmgr)

       The name of the tlsmgr(8) service entry in master.cf. This service maintains TLS session caches and other
       information in support of TLS.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.11 and later.

tlsproxy_client_CAfile (default: $smtp_tls_CAfile)

       A  file  containing  CA certificates of root CAs trusted to sign either remote TLS server certificates or
       intermediate CA certificates.  See smtp_tls_CAfile for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

tlsproxy_client_CApath (default: $smtp_tls_CApath)

       Directory with PEM format Certification Authority certificates that the Postfix tlsproxy(8)  client  uses
       to verify a remote TLS server certificate. See smtp_tls_CApath for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

tlsproxy_client_cert_file (default: $smtp_tls_cert_file)

       File  with  the  Postfix  tlsproxy(8)  client  RSA  certificate in PEM format. See smtp_tls_cert_file for
       further details.  The preferred way to configure  tlsproxy  client  keys  and  certificates  is  via  the
       "tlsproxy_client_chain_files" parameter.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

tlsproxy_client_chain_files (default: $smtp_tls_chain_files)

       Files   with   the   Postfix   tlsproxy(8)  client  keys  and  certificate  chains  in  PEM  format.  See
       smtp_tls_chain_files for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

tlsproxy_client_dcert_file (default: $smtp_tls_dcert_file)

       File with the Postfix tlsproxy(8) client DSA certificate  in  PEM  format.  See  smtp_tls_dcert_file  for
       further details. DSA is obsolete and should not be used.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

tlsproxy_client_dkey_file (default: $smtp_tls_dkey_file)

       File  with  the  Postfix  tlsproxy(8)  client  DSA  private key in PEM format. See smtp_tls_dkey_file for
       further details. DSA is obsolete and should not be used.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

tlsproxy_client_eccert_file (default: $smtp_tls_eccert_file)

       File with the Postfix tlsproxy(8) client ECDSA certificate in PEM format.  See  smtp_tls_eccert_file  for
       further  details.  The  preferred  way  to  configure  tlsproxy  client  keys and certificates is via the
       "tlsproxy_client_chain_files" parameter.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

tlsproxy_client_eckey_file (default: $smtp_tls_eckey_file)

       File with the Postfix tlsproxy(8) client ECDSA private key in PEM  format.  See  smtp_tls_eckey_file  for
       further  details.   The  preferred  way  to  configure  tlsproxy  client keys and certificates is via the
       "tlsproxy_client_chain_files" parameter.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

tlsproxy_client_enforce_tls (default: $smtp_enforce_tls)

       Enforcement mode: require that SMTP  servers  use  TLS  encryption.   See  smtp_enforce_tls  for  further
       details. Use tlsproxy_client_security_level instead.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

tlsproxy_client_fingerprint_digest (default: $smtp_tls_fingerprint_digest)

       The  message  digest  algorithm  used  to  construct  remote  TLS  server  certificate  fingerprints. See
       smtp_tls_fingerprint_digest for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

tlsproxy_client_key_file (default: $smtp_tls_key_file)

       File with the Postfix tlsproxy(8) client RSA private key in PEM format. See smtp_tls_key_file for further
       details.  The  preferred  way  to  configure  tlsproxy  client  keys  and   certificates   is   via   the
       "tlsproxy_client_chain_files" parameter.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

tlsproxy_client_level (default: $smtp_tls_security_level)

       The  default  TLS  security  level  for  the  Postfix tlsproxy(8) client. See smtp_tls_security_level for
       further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 - 3.6.  It  was  renamed  to  tlsproxy_client_security_level  in
       Postfix 3.7.

tlsproxy_client_loglevel (default: $smtp_tls_loglevel)

       Enable  additional  Postfix tlsproxy(8) client logging of TLS activity. See smtp_tls_loglevel for further
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

tlsproxy_client_loglevel_parameter (default: smtp_tls_loglevel)

       The name of the parameter that provides the tlsproxy_client_loglevel value.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

tlsproxy_client_per_site (default: $smtp_tls_per_site)

       Optional lookup tables with the Postfix tlsproxy(8) client TLS usage policy by next-hop  destination  and
       by remote TLS server hostname.  See smtp_tls_per_site for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

tlsproxy_client_policy (default: $smtp_tls_policy_maps)

       Optional  lookup  tables with the Postfix tlsproxy(8) client TLS security policy by next-hop destination.
       See smtp_tls_policy_maps for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 - 3.6. It was renamed to tlsproxy_client_policy_maps in  Postfix
       3.7.

tlsproxy_client_policy_maps (default: $smtp_tls_policy_maps)

       Optional  lookup  tables with the Postfix tlsproxy(8) client TLS security policy by next-hop destination.
       See smtp_tls_policy_maps for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.7 and later. It was previously called tlsproxy_client_policy.

tlsproxy_client_scert_verifydepth (default: $smtp_tls_scert_verifydepth)

       The verification depth for remote TLS server certificates.  See  smtp_tls_scert_verifydepth  for  further
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

tlsproxy_client_security_level (default: $smtp_tls_security_level)

       The  default  TLS  security  level  for  the  Postfix tlsproxy(8) client. See smtp_tls_security_level for
       further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.7 and later. It was previously called tlsproxy_client_level.

tlsproxy_client_use_tls (default: $smtp_use_tls)

       Opportunistic mode: use TLS when a remote server announces TLS  support.  See  smtp_use_tls  for  further
       details. Use tlsproxy_client_security_level instead.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

tlsproxy_enforce_tls (default: $smtpd_enforce_tls)

       Mandatory  TLS:  announce  STARTTLS  support  to  remote  SMTP  clients, and require that clients use TLS
       encryption. See smtpd_enforce_tls for further details. Use tlsproxy_tls_security_level instead.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_service_name (default: tlsproxy)

       The name of the tlsproxy(8)  service  entry  in  master.cf.  This  service  performs  plaintext  <=>  TLS
       ciphertext conversion.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_CAfile (default: $smtpd_tls_CAfile)

       A  file  containing  (PEM  format)  CA certificates of root CAs trusted to sign either remote SMTP client
       certificates or intermediate CA certificates.  See smtpd_tls_CAfile for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_CApath (default: $smtpd_tls_CApath)

       A directory containing (PEM format) CA certificates of root CAs trusted to sign either remote SMTP client
       certificates or intermediate CA certificates. See smtpd_tls_CApath for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_always_issue_session_ids (default: $smtpd_tls_always_issue_session_ids)

       Force the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server to issue a TLS session id, even when TLS session caching  is  turned
       off. See smtpd_tls_always_issue_session_ids for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_ask_ccert (default: $smtpd_tls_ask_ccert)

       Ask a remote SMTP client for a client certificate. See smtpd_tls_ask_ccert for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_ccert_verifydepth (default: $smtpd_tls_ccert_verifydepth)

       The  verification depth for remote SMTP client certificates. A depth of 1 is sufficient if the issuing CA
       is listed in a local CA file. See smtpd_tls_ccert_verifydepth for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_cert_file (default: $smtpd_tls_cert_file)

       File with the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server RSA certificate in PEM format.  This file may also  contain  the
       Postfix  tlsproxy(8)  server private RSA key.  See smtpd_tls_cert_file for further details.  With Postfix
       >=  3.4  the  preferred  way  to  configure  tlsproxy  server  keys   and   certificates   is   via   the
       "tlsproxy_tls_chain_files" parameter.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_chain_files (default: $smtpd_tls_chain_files)

       Files   with   the   Postfix   tlsproxy(8)  server  keys  and  certificate  chains  in  PEM  format.  See
       smtpd_tls_chain_files for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.4 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_ciphers (default: $smtpd_tls_ciphers)

       The minimum TLS cipher grade that  the  Postfix  tlsproxy(8)  server  will  use  with  opportunistic  TLS
       encryption. See smtpd_tls_ciphers for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_dcert_file (default: $smtpd_tls_dcert_file)

       File  with  the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server DSA certificate in PEM format.  This file may also contain the
       Postfix  tlsproxy(8)  server  private  DSA  key.   DSA  is  obsolete  and  should  not  be   used.    See
       smtpd_tls_dcert_file for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_dh1024_param_file (default: $smtpd_tls_dh1024_param_file)

       File  with  DH parameters that the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server should use with non-export EDH ciphers. See
       smtpd_tls_dh1024_param_file for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_dh512_param_file (default: $smtpd_tls_dh512_param_file)

       File with DH parameters that the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server should use with export-grade EDH ciphers. See
       smtpd_tls_dh512_param_file for further details.  The default SMTP server cipher grade  is  "medium"  with
       Postfix  releases after the middle of 2015, and as a result export-grade cipher suites are by default not
       used.

       With Postfix >= 3.6 export-grade Diffie-Hellman key exchange is no longer supported, and  this  parameter
       is silently ignored.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_dkey_file (default: $smtpd_tls_dkey_file)

       File  with  the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server DSA private key in PEM format.  This file may be combined with
       the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server  DSA  certificate  file  specified  with  $smtpd_tls_dcert_file.   DSA  is
       obsolete and should not be used.  See smtpd_tls_dkey_file for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_eccert_file (default: $smtpd_tls_eccert_file)

       File with the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server ECDSA certificate in PEM format.  This file may also contain the
       Postfix  tlsproxy(8)  server  private  ECDSA  key.   See smtpd_tls_eccert_file for further details.  With
       Postfix >= 3.4 the preferred  way  to  configure  tlsproxy  server  keys  and  certificates  is  via  the
       "tlsproxy_tls_chain_files" parameter.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_eckey_file (default: $smtpd_tls_eckey_file)

       File with the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server ECDSA private key in PEM format.  This file may be combined with
       the  Postfix  tlsproxy(8)  server  ECDSA  certificate  file  specified  with $smtpd_tls_eccert_file.  See
       smtpd_tls_eckey_file for further details.  With Postfix >= 3.4 the preferred way  to  configure  tlsproxy
       server keys and certificates is via the "tlsproxy_tls_chain_files" parameter.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_eecdh_grade (default: $smtpd_tls_eecdh_grade)

       The  Postfix  tlsproxy(8)  server  security grade for ephemeral elliptic-curve Diffie-Hellman (EECDH) key
       exchange. See smtpd_tls_eecdh_grade for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_exclude_ciphers (default: $smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers)

       List of ciphers or cipher types to exclude from the tlsproxy(8) server cipher list at  all  TLS  security
       levels. See smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_fingerprint_digest (default: $smtpd_tls_fingerprint_digest)

       The   message   digest   algorithm   to   construct  remote  SMTP  client-certificate  fingerprints.  See
       smtpd_tls_fingerprint_digest for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_key_file (default: $smtpd_tls_key_file)

       File with the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server RSA private key in PEM format.  This file may be  combined  with
       the   Postfix   tlsproxy(8)  server  RSA  certificate  file  specified  with  $smtpd_tls_cert_file.   See
       smtpd_tls_key_file for further details.  With Postfix >= 3.4 the  preferred  way  to  configure  tlsproxy
       server keys and certificates is via the "tlsproxy_tls_chain_files" parameter.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_loglevel (default: $smtpd_tls_loglevel)

       Enable  additional  Postfix tlsproxy(8) server logging of TLS activity.  Each logging level also includes
       the information that is logged at a lower logging level. See smtpd_tls_loglevel for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_mandatory_ciphers (default: $smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers)

       The minimum TLS cipher grade that the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server will use with mandatory TLS  encryption.
       See smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers (default: $smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers)

       Additional  list  of  ciphers  or  cipher  types  to  exclude  from the tlsproxy(8) server cipher list at
       mandatory TLS security levels.  See smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_mandatory_protocols (default: $smtpd_tls_mandatory_protocols)

       The SSL/TLS protocols accepted by the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server with mandatory TLS  encryption.  If  the
       list    is    empty,    the   server   supports   all   available   SSL/TLS   protocol   versions.    See
       smtpd_tls_mandatory_protocols for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_protocols (default: $smtpd_tls_protocols)

       List of TLS protocols that the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server will exclude or include with opportunistic  TLS
       encryption. See smtpd_tls_protocols for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_req_ccert (default: $smtpd_tls_req_ccert)

       With  mandatory  TLS  encryption,  require a trusted remote SMTP client certificate in order to allow TLS
       connections to proceed.  See smtpd_tls_req_ccert for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_security_level (default: $smtpd_tls_security_level)

       The SMTP TLS security level for the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server; when a non-empty value is specified, this
       overrides the obsolete parameters smtpd_use_tls and smtpd_enforce_tls. See  smtpd_tls_security_level  for
       further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_session_cache_timeout (default: $smtpd_tls_session_cache_timeout)

       Obsolete  expiration time of Postfix tlsproxy(8) server TLS session cache information. Since the cache is
       shared with smtpd(8) and managed by tlsmgr(8), there is only one expiration  time  for  the  SMTP  server
       cache shared by all three services, namely smtpd_tls_session_cache_timeout.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_use_tls (default: $smtpd_use_tls)

       Opportunistic  TLS: announce STARTTLS support to remote SMTP clients, but do not require that clients use
       TLS encryption. See smtpd_use_tls for further details. Use tlsproxy_tls_security_level instead.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_watchdog_timeout (default: 10s)

       How much time a tlsproxy(8) process may take to process local or remote I/O before it is terminated by  a
       built-in   watchdog  timer.   This  is  a  safety  mechanism  that  prevents  tlsproxy(8)  from  becoming
       non-responsive due to a bug in Postfix  itself  or  in  system  software.   To  avoid  false  alarms  and
       unnecessary cache corruption this limit cannot be set under 10s.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later

trace_service_name (default: trace)

       The name of the trace service. This service is implemented by the bounce(8) daemon and maintains a record
       of mail deliveries and produces a mail delivery report when verbose delivery is requested with  "sendmail
       -v".

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

transport_delivery_slot_cost (default: $default_delivery_slot_cost)

       A  transport-specific override for the default_delivery_slot_cost parameter value, where transport is the
       master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       Note: transport_delivery_slot_cost parameters will not  show  up  in  "postconf"  command  output  before
       Postfix  version  2.9.   This  limitation  applies  to  many  parameters whose name is a combination of a
       master.cf service name and a built-in suffix (in this case: "_delivery_slot_cost").

transport_delivery_slot_discount (default: $default_delivery_slot_discount)

       A transport-specific override for the default_delivery_slot_discount parameter value, where transport  is
       the master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       Note:  transport_delivery_slot_discount  parameters  will not show up in "postconf" command output before
       Postfix version 2.9.  This limitation applies to many  parameters  whose  name  is  a  combination  of  a
       master.cf service name and a built-in suffix (in this case: "_delivery_slot_discount").

transport_delivery_slot_loan (default: $default_delivery_slot_loan)

       A  transport-specific override for the default_delivery_slot_loan parameter value, where transport is the
       master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       Note: transport_delivery_slot_loan parameters will not  show  up  in  "postconf"  command  output  before
       Postfix  version  2.9.   This  limitation  applies  to  many  parameters whose name is a combination of a
       master.cf service name and a built-in suffix (in this case: "_delivery_slot_loan").

transport_destination_concurrency_failed_cohort_limit (default:

       $default_destination_concurrency_failed_cohort_limit)
       A  transport-specific  override  for  the  default_destination_concurrency_failed_cohort_limit  parameter
       value, where transport is the master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       Note:  some  transport_destination_concurrency_failed_cohort_limit  parameters  will  not  show   up   in
       "postconf"  command  output before Postfix version 2.9.  This limitation applies to many parameters whose
       name  is  a  combination  of  a  master.cf  service  name  and  a  built-in   suffix   (in   this   case:
       "_destination_concurrency_failed_cohort_limit").

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

transport_destination_concurrency_limit (default: $default_destination_concurrency_limit)

       A  transport-specific  override  for  the  default_destination_concurrency_limit  parameter  value, where
       transport is the master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       Note: some transport_destination_concurrency_limit parameters will not  show  up  in  "postconf"  command
       output  before  Postfix  version  2.9.   This  limitation  applies  to  many  parameters  whose name is a
       combination   of   a   master.cf   service   name   and   a    built-in    suffix    (in    this    case:
       "_destination_concurrency_limit").

transport_destination_concurrency_negative_feedback (default:

       $default_destination_concurrency_negative_feedback)
       A transport-specific override for the default_destination_concurrency_negative_feedback parameter  value,
       where transport is the master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       Note:  some transport_destination_concurrency_negative_feedback parameters will not show up in "postconf"
       command output before Postfix version 2.9.  This limitation applies to many parameters whose  name  is  a
       combination    of    a    master.cf    service    name   and   a   built-in   suffix   (in   this   case:
       "_destination_concurrency_negative_feedback").

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

transport_destination_concurrency_positive_feedback (default:

       $default_destination_concurrency_positive_feedback)
       A  transport-specific override for the default_destination_concurrency_positive_feedback parameter value,
       where transport is the master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       Note: some transport_destination_concurrency_positive_feedback parameters will not show up in  "postconf"
       command  output  before  Postfix version 2.9.  This limitation applies to many parameters whose name is a
       combination   of   a   master.cf   service   name   and   a    built-in    suffix    (in    this    case:
       "_destination_concurrency_positive_feedback").

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

transport_destination_rate_delay (default: $default_destination_rate_delay)

       A  transport-specific override for the default_destination_rate_delay parameter value, where transport is
       the master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       Note: some transport_destination_rate_delay parameters will not show  up  in  "postconf"  command  output
       before  Postfix version 2.9.  This limitation applies to many parameters whose name is a combination of a
       master.cf service name and a built-in suffix (in this case: "_destination_rate_delay").

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

transport_destination_recipient_limit (default: $default_destination_recipient_limit)

       A  transport-specific  override  for  the  default_destination_recipient_limit  parameter  value,   where
       transport is the master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       Note: some transport_destination_recipient_limit parameters will not show up in "postconf" command output
       before  Postfix version 2.9.  This limitation applies to many parameters whose name is a combination of a
       master.cf service name and a built-in suffix (in this case: "_destination_recipient_limit").

transport_extra_recipient_limit (default: $default_extra_recipient_limit)

       A transport-specific override for the default_extra_recipient_limit parameter value, where  transport  is
       the master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       Note:  transport_extra_recipient_limit  parameters  will  not show up in "postconf" command output before
       Postfix version 2.9.  This limitation applies to many  parameters  whose  name  is  a  combination  of  a
       master.cf service name and a built-in suffix (in this case: "_extra_recipient_limit").

transport_initial_destination_concurrency (default: $initial_destination_concurrency)

       A transport-specific override for the initial_destination_concurrency parameter value, where transport is
       the master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       Note:  some  transport_initial_destination_concurrency  parameters will not show up in "postconf" command
       output before Postfix version  2.9.   This  limitation  applies  to  many  parameters  whose  name  is  a
       combination    of    a    master.cf    service    name   and   a   built-in   suffix   (in   this   case:
       "_initial_destination_concurrency").

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

transport_maps (default: empty)

       Optional lookup tables with mappings from recipient address  to  (message  delivery  transport,  next-hop
       destination).  See transport(5) for details.

       Specify  zero  or  more  "type:table"  lookup  tables,  separated  by whitespace or comma. Tables will be
       searched in the specified order until a match is found.  If you use this feature with  local  files,  run
       "postmap /etc/postfix/transport" after making a change.

       Pattern  matching  of  domain  names  is controlled by the presence or absence of "transport_maps" in the
       parent_domain_matches_subdomains parameter value.

       For safety reasons, as of Postfix 2.3 this feature  does  not  allow  $number  substitutions  in  regular
       expression maps.

       Examples:

       transport_maps = dbm:/etc/postfix/transport
       transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport

transport_minimum_delivery_slots (default: $default_minimum_delivery_slots)

       A  transport-specific override for the default_minimum_delivery_slots parameter value, where transport is
       the master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       Note: transport_minimum_delivery_slots parameters will not show up in "postconf"  command  output  before
       Postfix  version  2.9.   This  limitation  applies  to  many  parameters whose name is a combination of a
       master.cf service name and a built-in suffix (in this case: "_minimum_delivery_slots").

transport_recipient_limit (default: $default_recipient_limit)

       A transport-specific override for the default_recipient_limit parameter value,  where  transport  is  the
       master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       Note:  some  transport_recipient_limit  parameters  will  not show up in "postconf" command output before
       Postfix version 2.9.  This limitation applies to many  parameters  whose  name  is  a  combination  of  a
       master.cf service name and a built-in suffix (in this case: "_recipient_limit").

transport_recipient_refill_delay (default: $default_recipient_refill_delay)

       A  transport-specific override for the default_recipient_refill_delay parameter value, where transport is
       the master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       Note: transport_recipient_refill_delay parameters will not show up in "postconf"  command  output  before
       Postfix  version  2.9.   This  limitation  applies  to  many  parameters whose name is a combination of a
       master.cf service name and a built-in suffix (in this case: "_recipient_refill_delay").

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.4 and later.

transport_recipient_refill_limit (default: $default_recipient_refill_limit)

       A transport-specific override for the default_recipient_refill_limit parameter value, where transport  is
       the master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       Note:  transport_recipient_refill_limit  parameters  will not show up in "postconf" command output before
       Postfix version 2.9.  This limitation applies to many  parameters  whose  name  is  a  combination  of  a
       master.cf service name and a built-in suffix (in this case: "_recipient_refill_limit").

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.4 and later.

transport_retry_time (default: 60s)

       The  time  between  attempts  by  the  Postfix queue manager to contact a malfunctioning message delivery
       transport.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

transport_time_limit (default: $command_time_limit)

       A  transport-specific  override  for  the  command_time_limit  parameter  value,  where  transport is the
       master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix  that  specifies  the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

       Note:  transport_time_limit  parameters  will  not  show  up  in "postconf" command output before Postfix
       version 2.9.  This limitation applies to many parameters whose name  is  a  combination  of  a  master.cf
       service name and a built-in suffix (in this case: "_time_limit").

transport_transport_rate_delay (default: $default_transport_rate_delay)

       A  transport-specific  override  for  the default_transport_rate_delay parameter value, where the initial
       transport in the parameter name is the master.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       Specify a non-negative time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter  suffix  that  specifies
       the  time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time
       unit is s (seconds).

       Note: transport_transport_rate_delay parameters will not show up  in  "postconf"  command  output  before
       Postfix  version  2.9.   This  limitation  applies  to  many  parameters whose name is a combination of a
       master.cf service name and a built-in suffix (in this case: "_transport_rate_delay").

trigger_timeout (default: 10s)

       The time limit for sending a trigger to a Postfix daemon (for example, the pickup(8) or qmgr(8)  daemon).
       This time limit prevents programs from getting stuck when the mail system is under heavy load.

       Specify  a  non-zero  time value (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the
       time unit).  Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).  The default time unit
       is s (seconds).

undisclosed_recipients_header (default: see postconf -d output)

       Message header that the Postfix cleanup(8) server inserts when a message contains no To: or  Cc:  message
       header.  With  Postfix  2.8 and later, the default value is empty. With Postfix 2.4-2.7, specify an empty
       value to disable this feature.

       Example:

       # Default value before Postfix 2.8.
       # Note: the ":" and ";" are both required.
       undisclosed_recipients_header = To: undisclosed-recipients:;

unknown_address_reject_code (default: 450)

       The numerical response code when the Postfix SMTP server rejects a sender or  recipient  address  because
       its   domain   is   unknown.    This   is   one   of   the   possible   replies   from  the  restrictions
       reject_unknown_sender_domain and reject_unknown_recipient_domain.

       Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of RFC 5321.

unknown_address_tempfail_action (default: $reject_tempfail_action)

       The Postfix SMTP server's action  when  reject_unknown_sender_domain  or  reject_unknown_recipient_domain
       fail  due  to  a  temporary  error  condition.  Specify  "defer"  to defer the remote SMTP client request
       immediately. With the default "defer_if_permit" action, the Postfix SMTP server  continues  to  look  for
       opportunities to reject mail, and defers the client request only if it would otherwise be accepted.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

unknown_client_reject_code (default: 450)

       The  numerical  Postfix SMTP server response code when a client without valid address <=> name mapping is
       rejected by the reject_unknown_client_hostname restriction. The SMTP server always replies with 450  when
       the mapping failed due to a temporary error condition.

       Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of RFC 5321.

unknown_helo_hostname_tempfail_action (default: $reject_tempfail_action)

       The  Postfix  SMTP  server's  action  when  reject_unknown_helo_hostname  fails  due to a temporary error
       condition. Specify "defer" to defer  the  remote  SMTP  client  request  immediately.  With  the  default
       "defer_if_permit" action, the Postfix SMTP server continues to look for opportunities to reject mail, and
       defers the client request only if it would otherwise be accepted.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

unknown_hostname_reject_code (default: 450)

       The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when the hostname specified with the HELO or EHLO command
       is rejected by the reject_unknown_helo_hostname restriction.

       Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of RFC 5321.

unknown_local_recipient_reject_code (default: 550)

       The   numerical   Postfix   SMTP   server   response   code  when  a  recipient  address  is  local,  and
       $local_recipient_maps specifies a list of lookup tables that does not match the recipient.   A  recipient
       address is local when its domain matches $mydestination, $proxy_interfaces or $inet_interfaces.

       The  default  setting  is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to initially use 450 (try again later) so you
       have time to find out if your local_recipient_maps settings are OK.

       Example:

       unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 450

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

unknown_relay_recipient_reject_code (default: 550)

       The numerical Postfix SMTP server reply  code  when  a  recipient  address  matches  $relay_domains,  and
       relay_recipient_maps specifies a list of lookup tables that does not match the recipient address.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

unknown_virtual_alias_reject_code (default: 550)

       The  Postfix  SMTP  server  reply  code  when  a  recipient  address  matches $virtual_alias_domains, and
       $virtual_alias_maps specifies a list of lookup tables that does not match the recipient address.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

unknown_virtual_mailbox_reject_code (default: 550)

       The Postfix SMTP server reply  code  when  a  recipient  address  matches  $virtual_mailbox_domains,  and
       $virtual_mailbox_maps specifies a list of lookup tables that does not match the recipient address.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

unverified_recipient_defer_code (default: 450)

       The  numerical Postfix SMTP server response when a recipient address probe fails due to a temporary error
       condition.

       Unlike elsewhere in Postfix, you can specify 250 in order to accept the address anyway.

       Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of RFC 5321.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

unverified_recipient_reject_code (default: 450)

       The  numerical  Postfix  SMTP  server  response  when  a   recipient   address   is   rejected   by   the
       reject_unverified_recipient restriction.

       Unlike elsewhere in Postfix, you can specify 250 in order to accept the address anyway.

       Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of RFC 5321.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

unverified_recipient_reject_reason (default: empty)

       The  Postfix SMTP server's reply when rejecting mail with reject_unverified_recipient. Do not include the
       numeric SMTP reply code or the enhanced status code. By default, the  response  includes  actual  address
       verification details.

       Example:

       unverified_recipient_reject_reason = Recipient address lookup failed

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

unverified_recipient_tempfail_action (default: $reject_tempfail_action)

       The  Postfix  SMTP  server's  action  when  reject_unverified_recipient  fails  due  to a temporary error
       condition. Specify "defer" to defer  the  remote  SMTP  client  request  immediately.  With  the  default
       "defer_if_permit" action, the Postfix SMTP server continues to look for opportunities to reject mail, and
       defers the client request only if it would otherwise be accepted.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

unverified_sender_defer_code (default: 450)

       The  numerical  Postfix  SMTP  server  response code when a sender address probe fails due to a temporary
       error condition.

       Unlike elsewhere in Postfix, you can specify 250 in order to accept the address anyway.

       Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of RFC 5321.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

unverified_sender_reject_code (default: 450)

       The  numerical  Postfix  SMTP  server  response  code  when  a  recipient  address  is  rejected  by  the
       reject_unverified_sender restriction.

       Unlike elsewhere in Postfix, you can specify 250 in order to accept the address anyway.

       Do not change this unless you have a complete understanding of RFC 5321.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

unverified_sender_reject_reason (default: empty)

       The  Postfix  SMTP  server's  reply when rejecting mail with reject_unverified_sender. Do not include the
       numeric SMTP reply code or the enhanced status code. By default, the  response  includes  actual  address
       verification details.

       Example:

       unverified_sender_reject_reason = Sender address lookup failed

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

unverified_sender_tempfail_action (default: $reject_tempfail_action)

       The  Postfix SMTP server's action when reject_unverified_sender fails due to a temporary error condition.
       Specify "defer" to defer the remote SMTP client request immediately. With the  default  "defer_if_permit"
       action, the Postfix SMTP server continues to look for opportunities to reject mail, and defers the client
       request only if it would otherwise be accepted.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

use_srv_lookup (default: empty)

       Enables discovery for the specified service(s) using DNS SRV records. For example, with "use_srv_lookup =
       submission"  and  "relayhost  =  example.com:submission",  the  Postfix  SMTP client will look up DNS SRV
       records for _submission._tcp.example.com, and will relay email through  the  hosts  and  ports  that  are
       specified with those records. See RFC 2782 for details of the host selection process.

       Specify  zero  or  more  service  names separated by comma and/or whitespace. Any name in the services(5)
       database may be specified, though in practice only submission, submissions, and smtp make sense.

       When SRV record lookup is enabled with use_srv_lookup, you can enclose a domain name in "[]" to force  IP
       address lookup instead of SRV record lookup.

       Example  1:  MUA-to-MTA  submission  using  SRV  record  lookup  for  the "submission" service for domain
       "example.com". This uses the default SMTP delivery agent with STARTTLS, and  looks  up  SRV  records  for
       "_submission._tcp.example.com".

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
           use_srv_lookup = submission
           relayhost = example.com:submission
           smtp_tls_security_level = may
           ...see SASL_README for sasl configuration...

       Example  2:  MUA-to-MTA  submission  using  SRV  record  lookup  for the "submissions" service for domain
       "example.org". This uses a dedicated SMTP delivery agent (smtp-wraptls) with tls_wrappermode  turned  on,
       and looks up SRV records for "_submissions._tcp.example.org".

       Note:  specify  the  older name "smtps" instead of "submissions" when a provider has DNS SRV records like
       "_smtps._tcp.example.org" instead of "_submissions._tcp.example.org".

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
           use_srv_lookup = submissions
           default_transport = smtp-wraptls:example.org:submissions
           ...see SASL_README for sasl configuration...

       /etc/postfix/master.cf:
           smtp-wraptls   unix   ...   ...   ...   ...   ...   smtp
               -o { smtp_tls_wrappermode = yes }
               -o { smtp_tls_security_level = encrypt }

       Example 3: Sender-dependent selection for a combination of MUA-to-MTA submission services. This  combines
       examples   1  and  2  with  examples  of  how  to  disable  SRV  and  look  up  IP  address  records  for
       "smtp-relay.example.net" and "smtp-relay.other.example".  Again, specify the older name  "smtps"  instead
       of  "submissions"  when  a  provider  has  DNS  SRV  records  like  "_smtps._tcp.example.org"  instead of
       "_submissions._tcp.example.org".

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
           use_srv_lookup = submission, submissions
           sender_dependent_default_transport_maps = inline:{
               # Destinations that support SRV record lookup.
               { user1@example.com = smtp:example.com:submission }
               { user2@example.org = smtp-wraptls:example.org:submissions }
               # Use [destination] to force IP address lookups.
               { user3@example.net = smtp:[smtp-relay.example.net]:submission }
               { user4@other.example =
                     smtp-wraptls:[smtp-relay.other.example]:submissions } }
           ...see SASL_README for sasl configuration...

       Example 4: MTA-to-MTA traffic, using SRV record lookup for the SMTP service. This is useful  for  Postfix
       tests, and may be useful in environments where ports are dynamically assigned to servers.

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
           use_srv_lookup = smtp
           # Fall back to MX record lookup when SRV records are unavailable.
           #allow_srv_lookup_fallback = yes
           #ignore_srv_lookup_error = yes

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.8 and later.

verp_delimiter_filter (default: -=+)

       The  characters  Postfix accepts as VERP delimiter characters on the Postfix sendmail(1) command line and
       in SMTP commands.

       This feature is available in Postfix 1.1 and later.

virtual_alias_address_length_limit (default: 1000)

       The maximal length of an email address after virtual alias expansion.  This stops virtual aliasing  loops
       that increase the address length exponentially.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

virtual_alias_domains (default: $virtual_alias_maps)

       Postfix  is  the  final destination for the specified list of virtual alias domains, that is, domains for
       which all addresses are aliased to addresses in other local or remote domains. The SMTP server  validates
       recipient  addresses  with  $virtual_alias_maps and rejects non-existent recipients. See also the virtual
       alias domain class in the ADDRESS_CLASS_README file

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.  The  default  value  is  backwards  compatible  with
       Postfix version 1.1.

       The default value is $virtual_alias_maps so that you can keep all information about virtual alias domains
       in  one place.  If you have many users, it is better to separate information that changes more frequently
       (virtual address -> local or remote address mapping) from information that changes less  frequently  (the
       list of virtual domain names).

       Specify a list of host or domain names, "/file/name" or "type:table" patterns, separated by commas and/or
       whitespace.  A  "/file/name"  pattern is replaced by its contents; a "type:table" lookup table is matched
       when a table entry matches a host or domain name (the lookup result is ignored).  Continue long lines  by
       starting  the  next  line  with  whitespace. Specify "!pattern" to exclude a host or domain name from the
       list. The form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later.

       See also the VIRTUAL_README and ADDRESS_CLASS_README documents for further information.

       Example:

       virtual_alias_domains = virtual1.tld virtual2.tld

virtual_alias_expansion_limit (default: 1000)

       The maximal number of addresses that virtual alias expansion produces from each original recipient.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

virtual_alias_maps (default: $virtual_maps)

       Optional lookup tables that alias specific mail addresses or domains to other local or remote  addresses.
       The  table  format  and  lookups  are  documented  in  virtual(5).  For  an  overview  of Postfix address
       manipulations see the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.  The  default  value  is  backwards  compatible  with
       Postfix version 1.1.

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma. Tables will be searched
       in the specified order until a match is found.  Note: these lookups are recursive.

       If you use this feature with indexed files, run "postmap /etc/postfix/virtual" after changing the file.

       Examples:

       virtual_alias_maps = dbm:/etc/postfix/virtual
       virtual_alias_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/virtual

virtual_alias_recursion_limit (default: 1000)

       The  maximal  nesting depth of virtual alias expansion.  Currently the recursion limit is applied only to
       the left branch of the expansion graph, so the depth of the tree can in the worst case reach the  sum  of
       the expansion and recursion limits.  This may change in the future.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

virtual_delivery_status_filter (default: $default_delivery_status_filter)

       Optional  filter for the virtual(8) delivery agent to change the delivery status code or explanatory text
       of successful or unsuccessful deliveries.  See default_delivery_status_filter for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 3.0 and later.

virtual_destination_concurrency_limit (default: $default_destination_concurrency_limit)

       The maximal number of parallel deliveries to the  same  destination  via  the  virtual  message  delivery
       transport.  This limit is enforced by the queue manager. The message delivery transport name is the first
       field in the entry in the master.cf file.

virtual_destination_recipient_limit (default: $default_destination_recipient_limit)

       The maximal number of recipients per message for the virtual message delivery transport.  This  limit  is
       enforced by the queue manager. The message delivery transport name is the first field in the entry in the
       master.cf file.

       Setting  this parameter to a value of 1 changes the meaning of virtual_destination_concurrency_limit from
       concurrency per domain into concurrency per recipient.

virtual_gid_maps (default: empty)

       Lookup tables with the per-recipient group ID for virtual(8) mailbox delivery.

       This parameter is specific to the virtual(8) delivery agent.  It does not apply when  mail  is  delivered
       with a different mail delivery program.

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma. Tables will be searched
       in the specified order until a match is found.

       In  a  lookup  table, specify a left-hand side of "@domain.tld" to match any user in the specified domain
       that does not have a specific "user@domain.tld" entry.

       When a recipient address has an optional address extension (user+foo@domain.tld), the virtual(8) delivery
       agent looks up the full address first, and when the lookup fails, it  looks  up  the  unextended  address
       (user@domain.tld).

       Note  1: for security reasons, the virtual(8) delivery agent disallows regular expression substitution of
       $1 etc. in regular expression lookup tables, because that would open a security hole.

       Note 2: for security reasons, the virtual(8) delivery agent will silently  ignore  requests  to  use  the
       proxymap(8)  server.  Instead it will open the table directly. Before Postfix version 2.2, the virtual(8)
       delivery agent will terminate with a fatal error.

virtual_mailbox_base (default: empty)

       A prefix that the virtual(8) delivery agent prepends to all pathname results  from  $virtual_mailbox_maps
       table  lookups.   This  is  a safety measure to ensure that an out of control map doesn't litter the file
       system with mailboxes.  While virtual_mailbox_base could be set to "/", this setting isn't recommended.

       This parameter is specific to the virtual(8) delivery agent.  It does not apply when  mail  is  delivered
       with a different mail delivery program.

       Example:

       virtual_mailbox_base = /var/mail

virtual_mailbox_domains (default: $virtual_mailbox_maps)

       Postfix  is  the  final  destination  for  the  specified  list  of  domains;  mail  is delivered via the
       $virtual_transport mail delivery transport.  By default this is the Postfix  virtual(8)  delivery  agent.
       The   SMTP  server  validates  recipient  addresses  with  $virtual_mailbox_maps  and  rejects  mail  for
       non-existent recipients.  See also the virtual mailbox domain class in the ADDRESS_CLASS_README file.

       This parameter expects the same syntax as the mydestination configuration parameter.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.  The  default  value  is  backwards  compatible  with
       Postfix version 1.1.

virtual_mailbox_limit (default: 51200000)

       The maximal size in bytes of an individual virtual(8) mailbox or maildir file, or zero (no limit).

       This  parameter  is  specific to the virtual(8) delivery agent.  It does not apply when mail is delivered
       with a different mail delivery program.

virtual_mailbox_lock (default: see postconf -d output)

       How to lock a UNIX-style virtual(8) mailbox before attempting delivery.  For a  list  of  available  file
       locking methods, use the "postconf -l" command.

       This  parameter  is  specific to the virtual(8) delivery agent.  It does not apply when mail is delivered
       with a different mail delivery program.

       This setting  is  ignored  with  maildir  style  delivery,  because  such  deliveries  are  safe  without
       application-level locks.

       Note  1:  the  dotlock  method  requires  that  the  recipient  UID or GID has write access to the parent
       directory of the recipient's mailbox file.

       Note 2: the default setting of this parameter is system dependent.

virtual_mailbox_maps (default: empty)

       Optional lookup tables with all valid addresses in the domains that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma. Tables will be searched
       in the specified order until a match is found.

       In a lookup table, specify a left-hand side of "@domain.tld" to match any user in  the  specified  domain
       that does not have a specific "user@domain.tld" entry.

       With  the default "virtual_mailbox_domains = $virtual_mailbox_maps", lookup tables also need entries with
       a left-hand side of "domain.tld" to  satisfy  virtual_mailbox_domain  lookups  (the  right-hand  side  is
       required but will not be used).

       The  remainder of this text is specific to the virtual(8) delivery agent.  It does not apply when mail is
       delivered with a different mail delivery program.

       The virtual(8) delivery agent uses this table to look up the per-recipient mailbox or  maildir  pathname.
       If  the lookup result ends in a slash ("/"), maildir-style delivery is carried out, otherwise the path is
       assumed to specify a  UNIX-style  mailbox  file.   Note  that  $virtual_mailbox_base  is  unconditionally
       prepended to this path.

       When a recipient address has an optional address extension (user+foo@domain.tld), the virtual(8) delivery
       agent  looks  up  the  full  address first, and when the lookup fails, it looks up the unextended address
       (user@domain.tld).

       Note 1: for security reasons, the virtual(8) delivery agent disallows regular expression substitution  of
       $1 etc. in regular expression lookup tables, because that would open a security hole.

       Note  2:  for  security  reasons,  the virtual(8) delivery agent will silently ignore requests to use the
       proxymap(8) server. Instead it will open the table directly. Before Postfix version 2.2,  the  virtual(8)
       delivery agent will terminate with a fatal error.

virtual_maps (default: empty)

       Optional lookup tables with a) names of domains for which all addresses are aliased to addresses in other
       local or remote domains, and b) addresses that are aliased to addresses in other local or remote domains.
       Available  before  Postfix  version 2.0. With Postfix version 2.0 and later, this is replaced by separate
       controls: virtual_alias_domains and virtual_alias_maps.

virtual_minimum_uid (default: 100)

       The minimum user ID value that the virtual(8) delivery agent accepts as a result  from  $virtual_uid_maps
       table lookup.  Returned values less than this will be rejected, and the message will be deferred.

       This  parameter  is  specific to the virtual(8) delivery agent.  It does not apply when mail is delivered
       with a different mail delivery program.

virtual_transport (default: virtual)

       The default mail delivery transport and next-hop destination for final delivery to  domains  listed  with
       $virtual_mailbox_domains.  This information can be overruled with the transport(5) table.

       Specify  a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is the name of a mail delivery transport
       defined in master.cf.  The :nexthop destination is optional; its syntax is documented in the manual  page
       of the corresponding delivery agent.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

virtual_uid_maps (default: empty)

       Lookup tables with the per-recipient user ID that the virtual(8) delivery agent uses while writing to the
       recipient's mailbox.

       This  parameter  is  specific to the virtual(8) delivery agent.  It does not apply when mail is delivered
       with a different mail delivery program.

       Specify zero or more "type:name" lookup tables, separated by whitespace or comma. Tables will be searched
       in the specified order until a match is found.

       In a lookup table, specify a left-hand side of "@domain.tld" to match any user in  the  specified  domain
       that does not have a specific "user@domain.tld" entry.

       When a recipient address has an optional address extension (user+foo@domain.tld), the virtual(8) delivery
       agent  looks  up  the  full  address first, and when the lookup fails, it looks up the unextended address
       (user@domain.tld).

       Note 1: for security reasons, the virtual(8) delivery agent disallows regular expression substitution  of
       $1 etc. in regular expression lookup tables, because that would open a security hole.

       Note  2:  for  security  reasons,  the virtual(8) delivery agent will silently ignore requests to use the
       proxymap(8) server. Instead it will open the table directly. Before Postfix version 2.2,  the  virtual(8)
       delivery agent will terminate with a fatal error.

SEE ALSO

       postconf(1), Postfix configuration parameter maintenance
       master(5), Postfix daemon configuration maintenance

LICENSE

       The Secure Mailer license must be distributed with this software.

AUTHOR(S)

       Wietse Venema
       IBM T.J. Watson Research
       P.O. Box 704
       Yorktown Heights, NY 10598, USA

       Wietse Venema
       Google, Inc.
       111 8th Avenue
       New York, NY 10011, USA

       Viktor Dukhovni

                                                                                                     POSTCONF(5)